[DOCID: f:h6eas.txt]
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  

                  In the Senate of the United States,

                                                          July 9, 1998.
      Resolved, That the bill from the House of Representatives (H.R. 
6) entitled ``An Act to extend the authorization of programs under the 
Higher Education Act of 1965, and for other purposes.'', do pass with 
the following

                               AMENDMENT:

            Strike out all after the enacting clause and insert:

SECTION 1. SHORT TITLE; TABLE OF CONTENTS.

    (a) Short Title.--This Act may be cited as the ``Higher Education 
Amendments of 1998''.
    (b) Table of Contents.--The table of contents is as follows:

Sec. 1. Short title; table of contents.
Sec. 2. References.

                      TITLE I--GENERAL PROVISIONS

Sec. 101. General provisions.
Sec. 102. Federal control of education prohibited.
Sec. 103. National Advisory Committee on Institutional Quality and 
                            Integrity.
Sec. 104. Grants and recognition awards.
Sec. 105. Prior rights and obligations; recovery of payments.
Sec. 106. Technical and conforming amendments.

                  TITLE II--IMPROVING TEACHER QUALITY

Sec. 201. Improving teacher quality.

                      TITLE III--INSTITUTIONAL AID

Sec. 301. Transfers and redesignations.
Sec. 302. Findings.
Sec. 303. Strengthening institutions.
Sec. 304. Strengthening HBCU's.
Sec. 305. Endowment challenge grants.
Sec. 306. HBCU capital financing.
Sec. 307. Minority science and engineering improvement program.
Sec. 308. General provisions.

                      TITLE IV--STUDENT ASSISTANCE

  Part A--Grants to Students in Attendance at Institutions of Higher 
                               Education

Sec. 411. Repeals and redesignations.
Sec. 412. Federal Pell grants.
Sec. 413. TRIO programs.
Sec. 414. Connections program.
Sec. 415. Federal supplemental educational opportunity grants.
Sec. 416. Leveraging educational assistance partnership program.
Sec. 417. HEP and CAMP.
Sec. 418. Robert C. Byrd honors scholarship program.
Sec. 419. Child care access means parents in school.
Sec. 420. Learning anytime anywhere partnerships.

             Part B--Federal Family Education Loan Program

Sec. 421. Advances for reserve funds.
Sec. 422. Federal Student Loan Reserve Fund.
Sec. 423. Agency Operating Fund.
Sec. 424. Scope and duration of Federal loan insurance program.
Sec. 425. Applicable interest rates.
Sec. 426. Federal payments to reduce student interest costs.
Sec. 427. Voluntary flexible agreements with guaranty agencies.
Sec. 428. Federal PLUS loans.
Sec. 429. Federal consolidation loans.
Sec. 430. Requirements for disbursements of student loans.
Sec. 431. Default reduction program.
Sec. 432. Unsubsidized loans.
Sec. 433. Loan forgiveness for teachers.
Sec. 434. Loan forgiveness for child care providers.
Sec. 435. Notice to Secretary and payment of loss.
Sec. 436. Common forms and formats.
Sec. 437. Student loan information by eligible lenders.
Sec. 438. Definitions.
Sec. 439. Study of the effectiveness of cohort default rates for 
                            institutions with few student loan 
                            borrowers.
Sec. 440. Delegation of functions.
Sec. 440A. Special allowances.
Sec. 440B. Study of market-based mechanisms for determining student 
                            loan interest rates.

                  Part C--Federal Work-Study Programs

Sec. 441. Authorization of appropriations; community services.
Sec. 442. Grants for Federal work-study programs.
Sec. 443. Work colleges.

          Part D--William D. Ford Federal Direct Loan Program

Sec. 451. Selection of institutions.
Sec. 452. Terms and conditions.
Sec. 453. Contracts.
Sec. 454. Funds for administrative expenses.
Sec. 455. Loan cancellation for teachers.

                     Part E--Federal Perkins Loans

Sec. 461. Authorization of appropriations.
Sec. 462. Allocation of funds.
Sec. 463. Agreements with institutions of higher education.
Sec. 464. Terms of loans.
Sec. 465. Distribution of assets from student loan funds.
Sec. 466. Perkins Loan Revolving Fund.

                         Part F--Need Analysis

Sec. 471. Cost of attendance.
Sec. 472. Family contribution for dependent students.
Sec. 473. Family contribution for independent students without 
                            dependents other than a spouse.
Sec. 474. Regulations; updated tables and amounts.
Sec. 475. Simplified needs test; zero expected family contribution.
Sec. 476. Refusal or adjustment of loan certifications.
Sec. 477. Treatment of other financial assistance.

                       Part G--General Provisions

Sec. 481. Definition of institution of higher education.
Sec. 482. Master calendar.
Sec. 483. Forms and regulations.
Sec. 484. Student eligibility.
Sec. 485. Institutional refunds.
Sec. 486. Institutional and financial assistance information for 
                            students.
Sec. 487. National student loan data bank system.
Sec. 488. Training in financial aid services.
Sec. 489. Program participation agreements.
Sec. 490. Regulatory relief and improvement.
Sec. 490A. Distance education demonstration programs.
Sec. 490B. Advisory Committee on Student Financial Assistance.
Sec. 490C. Regional meetings and negotiated rulemaking.
Sec. 490D. Procedures for cancellations and deferments for eligible 
                            disabled veterans.

                    Part H--Program Integrity Triad

Sec. 491. State role and responsibilities.
Sec. 492. Accrediting agency recognition.
Sec. 493. Eligibility and certification procedures.
Sec. 494. Program review and data.

  Part I--Administrative Provisions for Delivery of Student Financial 
                               Assistance

Sec. 495. Performance-based organization for the delivery of Federal 
                            student financial assistance.
Sec. 496. Student Loan Ombudsman Office.

        TITLE V--GRADUATE AND POSTSECONDARY IMPROVEMENT PROGRAMS

Sec. 501. Repeals, transfers, and redesignations.
Sec. 502. Purpose.

               Part A--Jacob K. Javits Fellowship Program

Sec. 511. Award of fellowships.

         Part B--Graduate Assistance in Areas of National Need

Sec. 521. Graduate assistance in areas of national need.

                   Part C--Faculty Devlopment Program

Sec. 531. Faculty development program reauthorized.

                    Part D--Urban Community Service

Sec. 541. Urban community service.

      Part E--Fund for the Improvement of Postsecondary Education

Sec. 551. Fund for the improvement of postsecondary education.

    Part F--Higher Education Access for Students With Disabilities; 
           Hispanic-Serving Institutions; General Provisions

Sec. 561. Higher education access for students with disabilities; 
                            Hispanic-serving institutions; general 
                            provisions.

               TITLE VI--INTERNATIONAL EDUCATION PROGRAMS

Sec. 601. International and foreign language studies.
Sec. 602. Business and international education programs.
Sec. 603. Institute for International Public Policy.
Sec. 604. General provisions.

        TITLE VII--RELATED PROGRAMS AND AMENDMENTS TO OTHER ACTS

                   Part A--Indian Education Programs

Sec. 711. Tribally Controlled Community College Assistance Act of 1978.
Sec. 712. American Indian, Alaska Native, and Native Hawaiian culture 
                            and art development.
Sec. 713. Navajo Community College Act.

              Part B--Advanced Placement Incentive Program

Sec. 721. Advanced placement incentive program.

                Part C--United States Institute of Peace

Sec. 731. Authorities of the United States Institute of Peace.

               Part D--Community Scholarship Mobilization

Sec. 741. Short title.
Sec. 742. Findings.
Sec. 743. Definitions.
Sec. 744. Purpose, endowment grant authority.
Sec. 745. Grant agreement and requirements.
Sec. 746. Authorization of appropriations.

    Part E--Grants to States for Workplace and Community Transition 
               Training for Incarcerated Youth Offenders

Sec. 751. Grants to States for workplace and community transition 
                            training for incarcerated youth offenders.

                 Part F--Web-Based Education Commission

Sec. 753. Short title; definitions.
Sec. 754. Establishment of Web-Based Education Commission.
Sec. 755. Duties of the Commission.
Sec. 756. Powers of the Commission.
Sec. 757. Commission personnel matters.
Sec. 758. Termination of the Commission.
Sec. 759. Authorization of appropriations.

                     Part G--Education of the Deaf

Sec. 761. Short title.
Sec. 762. Elementary and secondary education programs.
Sec. 763. Agreement with Gallaudet University.
Sec. 764. Agreement for the National Technical Institute for the Deaf.
Sec. 765. Definitions.
Sec. 766. Gifts.
Sec. 767. Reports.
Sec. 768. Monitoring, evaluation, and reporting.
Sec. 769. Investments.
Sec. 770. International students.
Sec. 771. Research priorities.
Sec. 772. Authorization of appropriations.
Sec. 773. Commission on Education of the Deaf.

                            Part H--Repeals

Sec. 781. Repeals.

                         Part I--Miscellaneous

Sec. 791. Year 2000 requirements at the Department of Education.
Sec. 792. Grants to combat violent crimes against women on campuses.
Sec. 793. Authority to administer summer travel and work programs.
Sec. 794. Improving United States understanding of science, 
                            engineering, and technology in East Asia.
Sec. 795. Underground Railroad educational and cultural program
Sec. 796. GNMA guarantee fee.
Sec. 797. Protection of student speech and association rights.
Sec. 798. Binge drinking on college campuses.
Sec. 799. Sense of the Senate regarding higher education.
Sec. 799A. Sense of Congress regarding teacher education.
Sec. 799B. Liaison for proprietary institutions of higher education.
Sec. 799C. Expansion of educational opportunities for welfare 
                            recipients.
Sec. 799D. Alcohol or drug possession disclosure.
Sec. 799E. Release of conditions, covenants, and reversionary 
                            interests, Guam Community College 
                            conveyance, Barrigada, Guam.
Sec. 799F. Sense of Congress regarding good character.

SEC. 2. REFERENCES.

    Except as otherwise expressly provided, whenever in this Act an 
amendment or repeal is expressed in terms of an amendment to, or repeal 
of, a section or other provision, the reference shall be considered to 
be made to a section or other provision of the Higher Education Act of 
1965 (20 U.S.C. 1001 et seq.).

                      TITLE I--GENERAL PROVISIONS

SEC. 101. GENERAL PROVISIONS.

    (a) Repeal; Transfer and Redesignation.--The Act (20 U.S.C. 1001 et 
seq.) is amended--
            (1) by repealing title I (20 U.S.C. 1001 et seq.);
            (2) by repealing sections 1203, 1206, 1211, and 1212 (20 
        U.S.C. 1143, 1145a, 1145e, and 1145f);
            (3) by striking the heading for title XII (20 U.S.C. 1141 
        et seq.);
            (4) by inserting before title III (20 U.S.C. 1051 et seq.) 
        the following:

                    ``TITLE I--GENERAL PROVISIONS'';

            (5) by transferring sections 1201, 1202, 1204 (as 
        renumbered by Public Law 90-575), 1204 (as added by Public Law 
        96-374), 1205, 1207, 1208, 1209, 1210, and 1213 (20 U.S.C. 
        1141, 1142, 1144, 1144a, 1145, 1145b, 1145c, 1145d, 1145d-1, 
        and 1145g) to follow the heading for title I (as inserted by 
        paragraph (4)); and
            (6) by redesignating sections 1201, 1202, 1204 (as 
        renumbered by Public Law 90-575), 1204 (as added by Public Law 
        96-374), 1205, 1207, 1208, 1209, 1210, and 1213 as sections 
        101, 102, 103, 104, 105, 106, 107, 108, 109, and 110, 
        respectively.

SEC. 102. FEDERAL CONTROL OF EDUCATION PROHIBITED.

    Section 103 (as redesignated by section 101(a)(6)) (20 U.S.C. 1144) 
is amended by striking ``(b)''.

SEC. 103. NATIONAL ADVISORY COMMITTEE ON INSTITUTIONAL QUALITY AND 
              INTEGRITY.

    Section 105 (as redesignated by section 101(a)(6)) (20 U.S.C. 1145) 
is amended--
            (1) by striking the last sentence of subsection (a);
            (2) by redesignating subsections (c) through (f) as 
        subsections (d) through (g), respectively;
            (3) by inserting after subsection (b) the following:
    ``(c) Public Notice.--The Secretary shall--
            ``(1) annually publish in the Federal Register a list 
        containing the name of each member of the Committee and the 
        date of the expiration of the term of office of the member; and
            ``(2) publicly solicit nominations for each vacant position 
        or expiring term of office on the Committee.'';
            (4) in subsection (d) (as redesignated by paragraph (2))--
                    (A) by striking paragraph (6); and
                    (B) by redesignating paragraphs (7) and (8) as 
                paragraphs (6) and (7), respectively; and
            (5) in subsection (g) (as redesignated by paragraph (2)), 
        by striking ``1998'' and inserting ``2004''.

SEC. 104. GRANTS AND RECOGNITION AWARDS.

    Section 110 (as redesignated by section 101(a)(6)) (20 U.S.C. 
1145g) is amended by adding at the end the following:
    ``(e) Alcohol and Drug Abuse Prevention Grants.--
            ``(1) Program authority.--The Secretary may make grants to 
        institutions of higher education or consortia of such 
        institutions, and enter into contracts with such institutions, 
        consortia, and other organizations, to develop, implement, 
        operate, improve, and disseminate programs of prevention, and 
        education (including treatment-referral) to reduce and 
        eliminate the illegal use of drugs and alcohol and the violence 
        associated with such use. Such grants or contracts may also be 
        used for the support of a higher education center for alcohol 
        and drug abuse prevention that will provide training, technical 
        assistance, evaluation, dissemination, and associated services 
        and assistance to the higher education community as determined 
        by the Secretary and institutions of higher education.
            ``(2) Awards.--Grants and contracts shall be awarded under 
        paragraph (1) on a competitive basis.
            ``(3) Applications.--An institution of higher education, a 
        consortium of such institutions, or another organization that 
        desires to receive a grant or contract under paragraph (1) 
        shall submit an application to the Secretary at such time, in 
        such manner, and containing or accompanied by such information 
        as the Secretary may reasonably require by regulation.
            ``(4) Additional requirements.--
                    ``(A) Participation.--In awarding grants under this 
                subsection the Secretary shall make every effort to 
                ensure--
                            ``(i) the equitable participation of 
                        private and public institutions of higher 
                        education (including community and junior 
                        colleges); and
                            ``(ii) the equitable geographic 
                        participation of such institutions.
                    ``(B) Consideration.--In awarding grants and 
                contracts under this subsection the Secretary shall 
                give appropriate consideration to institutions of 
                higher education with limited enrollment.
            ``(5) Authorization of appropriations.--There are 
        authorized to be appropriated to carry out this subsection 
        $5,000,000 for fiscal year 1999 and such sums as may be 
        necessary for each of the 4 succeeding fiscal years.
    ``(f) National Recognition Awards.--
            ``(1) Purpose.--It is the purpose of this subsection to 
        provide models of innovative and effective alcohol prevention 
        programs in higher education and to focus national attention on 
        exemplary alcohol prevention efforts.
            ``(2) Awards.--
                    ``(A) In general.--The Secretary shall make 10 
                National Recognition Awards, on an annual basis, to 
                institutions of higher education that--
                            ``(i) have developed and implemented 
                        innovative and effective alcohol prevention 
                        programs; and
                            ``(ii) demonstrate in the application 
                        submitted under paragraph (3) that the 
                        institution has undertaken efforts designed to 
                        change the culture of college drinking 
                        consistent with the objectives described in 
                        paragraph (4)(B).
                    ``(B) Ceremony.--The awards shall be made at a 
                ceremony in Washington, D.C.
                    ``(C) Document.--The Secretary shall publish a 
                document describing the alcohol prevention programs of 
                institutions of higher education that receive the 
                awards under this subsection and disseminate the 
                document nationally to all public and private secondary 
                school guidance counselors for use by secondary school 
                juniors and seniors preparing to enter an institution 
                of higher education. The document shall be disseminated 
                not later than January 1 of each academic year.
                    ``(D) Amount and use.--Each institution of higher 
                education selected to receive an award under this 
                subsection shall receive an award in the amount of 
                $50,000. Such award shall be used for the maintenance 
                and improvement of the institution's alcohol prevention 
                program for the academic year following the academic 
                year for which the award is made.
            ``(3) Application.--
                    ``(A) In general.--Each institution of higher 
                education desiring an award under this subsection shall 
                submit an application to the Secretary at such time, in 
                such manner, and accompanied by such information as the 
                Secretary may require. Each such application shall 
                contain--
                            ``(i) a clear description of the goals and 
                        objectives of the alcohol program of the 
                        institution;
                            ``(ii) a description of program activities 
                        that focus on alcohol policy issues, policy 
                        development, modification, or refinement, 
                        policy dissemination and implementation, and 
                        policy enforcement;
                            ``(iii) a description of activities that 
                        encourage student and employee participation 
                        and involvement in activity development and 
                        implementation;
                            ``(iv) the objective criteria used to 
                        determine the effectiveness of the methods used 
                        in the program and the means used to evaluate 
                        and improve the program efforts; and
                            ``(v) a description of the activities to be 
                        assisted that meet the criteria described in 
                        subparagraph (C).
                    ``(B) Application review.--The Secretary shall 
                appoint a committee to review applications submitted 
                under this paragraph. The committee may include 
                representatives of Federal departments or agencies the 
                programs of which include alcohol abuse prevention and 
                education efforts, directors or heads (or their 
                representatives) of professional associations that 
                focus on alcohol abuse prevention efforts, and non-
                Federal scientists who have backgrounds in social 
                science evaluation and research methodology and in 
                education. Decisions of the committee shall be made 
                directly to the Secretary without review by any other 
                entity in the Department.
                    ``(C) Review criteria.--The committee described in 
                subparagraph (B) shall develop specific review criteria 
                for reviewing and evaluating applications submitted 
                under this paragraph. Such criteria shall include 
                whether the institution of higher education has 
                policies in effect that--
                            ``(i) prohibit alcoholic beverage 
                        sponsorship of athletic events, and prohibit 
                        alcoholic beverage advertising inside athletic 
                        facilities;
                            ``(ii) prohibit alcoholic beverage 
                        marketing on campus, which may include efforts 
                        to ban alcohol advertising in institutional 
                        publications or efforts to prohibit alcohol-
                        related advertisements at campus events;
                            ``(iii) establish or expand upon alcohol-
                        free living arrangements for all college 
                        students;
                            ``(iv) establish partnerships with 
                        community members and organizations to further 
                        alcohol prevention efforts on campus and the 
                        areas surrounding campus; and
                            ``(v) establish innovative communications 
                        programs involving students and faculty in an 
                        effort to educate students about alcohol-
                        related risks.
            ``(4) Eligibility.--
                    ``(A) In general.--In order to be eligible to 
                receive a National Recognition Award an institution of 
                higher education shall--
                            ``(i) offer an associate or baccalaureate 
                        degree;
                            ``(ii) have established an alcohol abuse 
                        prevention and education program;
                            ``(iii) nominate itself or be nominated by 
                        others, such as professional associations or 
                        student organizations, to receive the award; 
                        and
                            ``(iv) not have received an award under 
                        this subsection during the 5 academic years 
                        preceding the academic year for which the 
                        determination is made.
                    ``(B) Objectives.--In order to receive a National 
                Recognition Award an institution shall demonstrate in 
                the application submitted under paragraph (3) that the 
                institution has accomplished all of the following 
                objectives:
                            ``(i) The elimination of alcoholic beverage 
                        sponsorship of athletic events, and the 
                        elimination of alcoholic beverage advertising 
                        inside athletic facilities.
                            ``(ii) The elimination of alcoholic 
                        beverage marketing on campus that may include 
                        efforts to ban alcohol advertising in 
                        institutional publications or prohibit alcohol-
                        related advertisements at campus events.
                            ``(iii) The establishment or expansion of 
                        alcohol-free living arrangements for all 
                        college students.
                            ``(iv) The establishment of partnerships 
                        with community members and organizations to 
                        further alcohol prevention efforts on campus 
                        and the surrounding areas.
                            ``(v) The establishment of innovative 
                        communications programs involving students and 
                        faculty in an effort to educate students about 
                        alcohol-related risks.
            ``(5) Authorization of appropriations.--
                    ``(A) In general.--There is authorized to be 
                appropriated to carry out this subsection $750,000 for 
                fiscal year 1999.
                    ``(B) Availability.--Funds appropriated under 
                subparagraph (A) shall remain available until 
                expended.''.

SEC. 105. PRIOR RIGHTS AND OBLIGATIONS; RECOVERY OF PAYMENTS.

    Title I (20 U.S.C. 1001 et seq.) is amended by adding after section 
110 (as redesignated by section 101(a)(6)) the following:

``SEC. 111. PRIOR RIGHTS AND OBLIGATIONS.

    ``(a) Authorization of Appropriations.--
            ``(1) Pre-1987 parts c and d of title vii.--There are 
        authorized to be appropriated such sums as may be necessary for 
        fiscal year 1999 and for each of the 4 succeeding fiscal years 
        to pay obligations incurred prior to 1987 under parts C and D 
        of title VII, as such parts were in effect before the effective 
        date of the Higher Education Amendments of 1992.
            ``(2) Post-1992 and pre-1998 part c of title vii.--There 
        are authorized to be appropriated such sums as may be necessary 
        for fiscal year 1999 and for each of the 4 succeeding fiscal 
        years to pay obligations incurred prior to the date of 
        enactment of the Higher Education Amendments of 1998 under part 
        C of title VII, as such part was in effect during the period--
                    ``(A) after the effective date of the Higher 
                Education Amendments of 1992; and
                    ``(B) prior to the date of enactment of the Higher 
                Education Amendments of 1998.
    ``(b) Legal Responsibilities.--
            ``(1) Pre-1987 title vii.--All entities with continuing 
        obligations incurred under parts A, B, C, and D of title VII, 
        as such parts were in effect before the effective date of the 
        Higher Education Amendments of 1992, shall be subject to the 
        requirements of such part as in effect before the effective 
        date of the Higher Education Amendments of 1992.
            ``(2) Post-1992 and pre-1998 part c of title vii.--All 
        entities with continuing obligations incurred under part C of 
        title VII, as such part was in effect during the period--
                    ``(A) after the effective date of the Higher 
                Education Amendments of 1992; and
                    ``(B) prior to the date of enactment of the Higher 
                Education Amendments of 1998,
        shall be subject to the requirements of such part as such part 
        was in effect during such period.

``SEC. 112. RECOVERY OF PAYMENTS.

    ``(a) Public Benefit.--Congress declares that, if a facility 
constructed with the aid of a grant under part A of title VII as such 
part A was in effect prior to the date of enactment of the Higher 
Education Amendments of 1998, or part B of such title as such part B 
was in effect prior to the date of enactment of the Higher Education 
Amendments of 1992, is used as an academic facility for 20 years 
following completion of such construction, the public benefit accruing 
to the United States will equal in value the amount of the grant. The 
period of 20 years after completion of such construction shall 
therefore be deemed to be the period of Federal interest in such 
facility for the purposes of such title as so in effect.
    ``(b) Recovery Upon Cessation of Public Benefit.--If, within 20 
years after completion of construction of an academic facility which 
has been constructed, in part with a grant under part A of title VII as 
such part A was in effect prior to the date of enactment of the Higher 
Education Amendments of 1998, or part B of title VII as such part B was 
in effect prior to the date of enactment of the Higher Education 
Amendments of 1992--
            ``(1) the applicant under such parts as so in effect (or 
        the applicant's successor in title or possession) ceases or 
        fails to be a public or nonprofit institution, or
            ``(2) the facility ceases to be used as an academic 
        facility, or the facility is used as a facility excluded from 
        the term `academic facility' (as such term was defined under 
        title VII, as so in effect), unless the Secretary determines 
        that there is good cause for releasing the institution from its 
        obligation,
the United States shall be entitled to recover from such applicant (or 
successor) an amount which bears to the value of the facility at that 
time (or so much thereof as constituted an approved project or 
projects) the same ratio as the amount of Federal grant bore to the 
cost of the facility financed with the aid of such grant. The value 
shall be determined by agreement of the parties or by action brought in 
the United States district court for the district in which such 
facility is situated.
    ``(c) Prohibition on Use for Religion.--Notwithstanding the 
provisions of subsections (a) and (b), no project assisted with funds 
under title VII (as in effect prior to the date of enactment of the 
Higher Education Amendments of 1998) shall ever be used for religious 
worship or a sectarian activity or for a school or department of 
divinity.

``SEC. 113. STUDENT-RELATED DEBT STUDY REQUIRED.

    ``(a) In General.--The Secretary shall conduct a study that 
analyzes the distribution and increase in student-related debt in terms 
of--
            ``(1) demographic characteristics, such as race or 
        ethnicity, and family income;
            ``(2) type of institution and whether the institution is a 
        public or private institution;
            ``(3) loan source, such as Federal, State, institutional or 
        other, and, if the loan source is Federal, whether the loan is 
        or is not subsidized;
            ``(4) academic field of study;
            ``(5) parent loans, and whether the parent loans are 
        federally guaranteed, private, or property-secured such as home 
        equity loans; and
            ``(6) relation of student debt or anticipated debt to--
                    ``(A) students' decisions about whether and where 
                to enroll in college and whether or how much to borrow 
                in order to attend college;
                    ``(B) the length of time it takes students to earn 
                baccalaureate degrees;
                    ``(C) students' decisions about whether and where 
                to attend graduate school;
                    ``(D) graduates' employment decisions;
                    ``(E) graduates' burden of repayment as reflected 
                by the graduates' ability to save for retirement or 
                invest in a home; and
                    ``(F) students' future earnings.
    ``(b) Report.--After conclusion of the study required by subsection 
(a), the Secretary shall submit a final report regarding the findings 
of the study to the Committee on Labor and Human Resources of the 
Senate and the Committee on Education and the Workforce of the House of 
Representatives not later than 18 months after the date of enactment of 
the Higher Education Amendments of 1998.
    ``(c) Information.--After the study and report under this section 
are concluded, the Secretary shall determine which information 
described in subsection (a) would be useful for families to know and 
shall include such information as part of the comparative information 
provided to families about the costs of higher education under the 
provisions of section 486(a)(1).

``SEC. 114. STUDY OF FORECLOSED PROPERTY OR ASSETS.

    ``Not later than 90 days after the date of enactment of the Higher 
Education Amendments of 1998, the Comptroller General, in consultation 
with the Inspector General of the Department, shall submit a report to 
the Committee on Labor and Human Resources of the Senate and the 
Committee on Education and the Workforce of the House of 
Representatives that provides the following:
            ``(1) Descriptions of legislative changes that can be made 
        to strengthen laws governing the transfer of foreclosed 
        property or assets by the Department to individuals or their 
        agents that have had prior dealings with the Department. Such 
        descriptions shall address the transfer of property to 
        individuals or their agents who have been in positions of 
        management or oversight at postsecondary educational 
        institutions that have failed, or are failing, to make payments 
        to the Department on property loans, or defaulted on any 
        property or asset loan from a Federal agency.
            ``(2) Changes that can be implemented at the Department to 
        strengthen all rules and regulations governing the transfer of 
        foreclosed property or assets by the Department to individuals 
        or their agents as described in paragraph (1).

``SEC. 115. STATE REQUIREMENT.

    ``(a) In General.--Except as provided in subsection (b), each 
State, that has individuals who reside in the State and who receive 
financial assistance under this Act, shall provide an appropriate 
number of mail voter registration forms (as described in section 6(a) 
of the National Voter Registration Act (42 U.S.C. 1973gg-4(a))) to each 
eligible institution under section 487 in the State, not later than 60 
days before each date that is the last day to register to vote for a 
regularly scheduled--
            ``(1) election (as defined in section 301(1) of the Federal 
        Election Campaign Act of 1971 (2 U.S.C. 431(1)); or
            ``(2) election for Governor or other chief executive within 
        such State.
    ``(b) Nonapplicability to Certain States.--The requirement of 
subsection (a) shall not apply to a State which is described in section 
4(b) of the National Voter Registration Act (42 U.S.C. 1973gg-2(b)).

``SEC. 116. STUDY OF OPPORTUNITIES FOR PARTICIPATION IN ATHLETICS 
              PROGRAMS.

    ``(a) Study.--The Comptroller General shall conduct a study of the 
opportunities for participation in intercollegiate athletics. The study 
shall address issues including--
            ``(1) the extent to which the number of--
                    ``(A) secondary school athletic teams has increased 
                or decreased in the 20 years preceding 1998 (in 
                aggregate terms); and
                    ``(B) intercollegiate athletic teams has increased 
                or decreased in the 20 years preceding 1998 (in 
                aggregate terms) at 2-year and 4-year institutions of 
                higher education;
            ``(2) the extent to which participation by student-athletes 
        in secondary school and intercollegiate athletics has increased 
        or decreased in the 20 years preceding 1998 (in aggregate 
        terms);
            ``(3) over the 20-year period preceding 1998, a list of the 
        men's and women's secondary school and intercollegiate sports, 
        ranked in order of the sports most affected by increases or 
        decreases in levels of participation and numbers of teams (in 
        the aggregate);
            ``(4) all factors that have influenced campus officials to 
        add or discontinue sports teams at secondary schools and 
        institutions of higher education, including--
                    ``(A) institutional mission and priorities;
                    ``(B) budgetary pressures;
                    ``(C) institutional reforms and restructuring;
                    ``(D) escalating liability insurance premiums;
                    ``(E) changing student and community interest in a 
                sport;
                    ``(F) advancement of diversity among students;
                    ``(G) lack of necessary level of competitiveness of 
                the sports program;
                    ``(H) club level sport achieving a level of 
                competitiveness to make the sport a viable varsity 
                level sport;
                    ``(I) injuries or deaths; and
                    ``(J) conference realignment;
            ``(5) the actions that institutions of higher education 
        have taken when decreasing the level of participation in 
        intercollegiate sports, or the number of teams, in terms of 
        providing information, advice, scholarship maintenance, 
        counseling, advance warning, and an opportunity for student-
        athletes to be involved in the decisionmaking process;
            ``(6) the administrative processes and procedures used by 
        institutions of higher education when determining whether to 
        increase or decrease intercollegiate athletic teams or 
        participation by student-athletes;
            ``(7) the budgetary or fiscal impact, if any, of a decision 
        by an institution of higher education--
                    ``(A) to increase or decrease the number of 
                intercollegiate athletic teams or the participation of 
                student-athletes; or
                    ``(B) to be involved in a conference realignment; 
                and
            ``(8) the alternatives, if any, institutions of higher 
        education have pursued in lieu of eliminating, or severely 
        reducing the funding for, an intercollegiate sport, and the 
        success of such alternatives.
    ``(b) Report.--The Comptroller General shall submit a report 
regarding the results of the study to the Committee on Labor and Human 
Resources of the Senate and the Committee on Education and the 
Workforce of the House of Representatives.

``SEC. 117. SPECIAL RULE.

    ``Notwithstanding any other provision of law, the sum of financial 
assistance received under this Act and other Federal financial 
assistance for postsecondary education received by an individual shall 
not exceed the individual's cost of attendance as defined in section 
472, except that no individual shall have the amount of a Federal Pell 
Grant for which the individual is eligible reduced as a result of the 
application of this section.''.

SEC. 106. TECHNICAL AND CONFORMING AMENDMENTS.

    (a) Conforming Amendments Correcting References to Section 1201.--
            (1) Agriculture.--
                    (A) Student internship programs.--Section 922 of 
                the Federal Agriculture Improvement and Reform Act of 
                1996 (7 U.S.C. 2279c) is amended--
                            (i) in subsection (a)(1)(B)--
                                    (I) by striking ``1201'' and 
                                inserting ``101''; and
                                    (II) by striking ``(20 U.S.C. 
                                1141)''; and
                            (ii) in subsection (b)(1)--
                                    (I) by striking ``1201'' and 
                                inserting ``101''; and
                                    (II) by striking ``(20 U.S.C. 
                                1141)''.
                    (B) Agricultural sciences education.--Section 
                1417(h)(1)(A) of the National Agricultural Research, 
                Extension, and Teaching Policy Act of 1977 (7 U.S.C. 
                3152(h)(1)(A)) is amended--
                            (i) by striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting 
                        ``101(a)''; and
                            (ii) by striking ``(20 U.S.C. 1141(a))''.
            (2) Armed forces.--
                    (A) Science and mathematics education improvement 
                program.--Section 2193(c)(1) of title 10, United States 
                Code, is amended--
                            (i) by striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting 
                        ``101(a)''; and
                            (ii) by striking ``(20 U.S.C. 1141(a))''.
                    (B) Support of science, mathematics, and 
                engineering education.--Section 2199(2) of title 10, 
                United States Code, is amended--
                            (i) by striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting 
                        ``101(a)''; and
                            (ii) by striking ``(20 U.S.C. 1141(a))''.
                    (C) Allowable costs under defense contracts.--
                Section 841(c)(2) of the National Defense Authorization 
                Act for fiscal year 1994 (10 U.S.C. 2324 note) is 
                amended--
                            (i) by striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting 
                        ``101(a)''; and
                            (ii) by striking ``(20 U.S.C. 1141(a))''.
                    (D) Environmental restoration institutional grants 
                for training dislocated defense workers and young 
                adults.--Section 1333(i)(3) of the National Defense 
                Authorization Act for fiscal year 1994 (10 U.S.C. 2701 
                note) is amended--
                            (i) by striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting 
                        ``101(a)''; and
                            (ii) by striking ``(20 U.S.C. 1141(a))''.
                    (E) Environmental education opportunities 
                program.--Section 1334(k)(3) of the National Defense 
                Authorization Act for fiscal year 1994 (10 U.S.C. 2701 
                note) is amended--
                            (i) by striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting 
                        ``101(a)''; and
                            (ii) by striking ``(20 U.S.C. 1141(a))''.
                    (F) Environmental scholarship and fellowship 
                programs.--Section 4451(b)(1) of the National Defense 
                Authorization Act for 1993 (10 U.S.C. 2701 note) is 
                amended--
                            (i) by striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting 
                        ``101(a)''; and
                            (ii) by striking ``(20 U.S.C. 1141(a))''.
            (3) Application of antitrust laws to award of need-based 
        educational aid.--Section 568(c)(3) of the Improving America's 
        Schools Act of 1994 (15 U.S.C. 1 note) is amended--
                    (A) by striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting 
                ``101(a)''; and
                    (B) by striking ``(20 U.S.C. 1141(a))''.
            (4) Restrictions on former officers, employees, and elected 
        officials of the executive and legislative branches.--Section 
        207(j)(2)(B) of title 18, United States Code, is amended by 
        striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting ``101(a)''.
            (5) Education.--
                    (A) Higher education amendments of 1992.--Section 
                1(c) of the Higher Education Amendments of 1992 (20 
                U.S.C. 1001 note) is amended by striking ``1201'' and 
                inserting ``101''.
                    (B) Part f definitions.--Section 481 of the Higher 
                Education Act of 1965 (20 U.S.C. 1088) is amended--
                            (i) in subsection (a)--
                                    (I) in the matter preceding 
                                paragraph (1)(A), by striking 
                                ``1201(a)'' and inserting ``101(a)'';
                                    (II) in paragraph (1)(C), by 
                                striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting 
                                ``101(a)'';
                                    (III) in the first sentence of the 
                                matter preceding clause (i) of 
                                paragraph (2)(A), by striking 
                                ``1201(a)'' and inserting ``101(a)''; 
                                and
                                    (IV) in the matter following 
                                paragraph (2)(B)(ii), by striking 
                                ``1201(a)'' and inserting ``101(a)'';
                            (ii) in subsection (b)--
                                    (I) in the first sentence--
                                            (aa) in paragraph (2), by 
                                        striking ``1201(a)'' and 
                                        inserting ``101(a)''; and
                                            (bb) in paragraph (3), by 
                                        striking ``1201(a)'' and 
                                        inserting ``101(a)''; and
                                    (II) in the second sentence, by 
                                striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting 
                                ``101(a)''; and
                            (iii) in subsection (c)--
                                    (I) in the first sentence, by 
                                striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting 
                                ``101(a)''; and
                                    (II) in the second sentence, by 
                                striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting 
                                ``101(a)''.
                    (C) Treatment of branches.--Section 498(j)(2) of 
                the Higher Education Act of 1965 (20 U.S.C. 
                1099c(j)(2)) is amended by striking ``1201(a)(2)'' and 
                inserting ``101(a)(2)''.
                    (D) International education programs.--Section 
                631(a)(8) of the Higher Education Act of 1965 (20 
                U.S.C. 1132(a)(8)) is amended by striking ``1201(a)'' 
                each place it appears and inserting ``101(a)''.
                    (E) Dwight d. eisenhower leadership program.--
                Section 1081(d) of the Higher Education Act of 1965 (20 
                U.S.C. 1135f(d)) is amended by striking ``1201'' and 
                inserting ``101''.
                    (F) Disclosure requirements.--Section 
                429(d)(2)(B)(ii) of the General Education Provisions 
                Act (20 U.S.C. 1228c(d)(2)(B)(ii)) is amended by 
                striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting ``101(a)''.
                    (G) Harry s. truman scholarships.--Section 3(4) of 
                the Harry S. Truman Memorial Scholarship Act (20 U.S.C. 
                2002(4)) is amended by striking ``1201(a)'' and 
                inserting ``101(a)''.
                    (H) Tech-prep education.--Section 347(2)(A) of the 
                Carl D. Perkins Vocational and Applied Technology 
                Education Act (20 U.S.C. 2394e(2)(A)) is amended by 
                striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting ``101(a)''.
                    (I) Education for economic security.--Section 3(6) 
                of the Education for Economic Security Act (20 U.S.C. 
                3902(6)) is amended by striking ``1201(a)'' and 
                inserting ``101(a)''.
                    (J) James madison memorial fellowships.--Section 
                815 of the James Madison Memorial Fellowship Act (20 
                U.S.C. 4514) is amended--
                            (i) in paragraph (3), by striking 
                        ``1201(a)'' and inserting ``101(a)''; and
                            (ii) in paragraph (4), by striking 
                        ``1201(d) of the Higher Education Act of 1965'' 
                        and inserting ``14101 of the Elementary and 
                        Secondary Education Act of 1965''.
                    (K) Barry goldwater scholarships.--Section 1403(4) 
                of the Barry Goldwater Scholarship and Excellence in 
                Education Act (20 U.S.C. 4702(4)) is amended--
                            (i) by striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting 
                        ``101(a)''; and
                            (ii) by striking ``(20 U.S.C. 1141(a))''.
                    (L) Morris k. udall scholarships.--Section 4(6) of 
                the Morris K. Udall Scholarship and Excellence in 
                National Environmental and Native American Public 
                Policy Act of 1992 (20 U.S.C. 5602(6)) is amended by 
                striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting ``101(a)''.
                    (M) Bilingual education, and language enhancement 
                and acquisition.--Section 7501(4) of the Elementary and 
                Secondary Education Act of 1965 (20 U.S.C. 7601(4)) is 
                amended by striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting 
                ``101(a)''.
                    (N) General definitions.--Section 14101(17) of the 
                Elementary and Secondary Education Act of 1965 (20 
                U.S.C. 8801(17)) is amended by striking ``1201(a)'' and 
                inserting ``101(a)''.
                    (O) National education statistics.--Section 
                402(c)(3) of the National Education Statistics Act of 
                1994 (20 U.S.C. 9001(c)(3)) is amended by striking 
                ``1201(a)'' and inserting ``101(a)''.
            (6) Foreign relations.--
                    (A) Environment and sustainable development 
                exchange program.--Section 240(d) of the Foreign 
                Relations Authorization Act, Fiscal Years 1994 and 1995 
                (22 U.S.C. 2452 note) is amended by striking 
                ``1201(a)'' and inserting ``101(a)''.
                    (B) Samantha smith memorial exchange program.--
                Section 112(a)(8) of the Mutual Educational and 
                Cultural Exchange Act of 1961 (22 U.S.C. 2460(a)(8)) is 
                amended--
                            (i) by striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting 
                        ``101(a)''; and
                            (ii) by striking ``(20 U.S.C. 1141(a))''.
                    (C) Soviet-eastern european training.--Section 
                803(1) of the Soviet-Eastern European Research and 
                Training Act of 1983 (22 U.S.C. 4502(1)) is amended by 
                striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting ``101(a)''.
                    (D) Developing country scholarships.--Section 
                603(d) of the Foreign Relations Authorization Act, 
                Fiscal Years 1986 and 1987 (22 U.S.C. 4703(d)) is 
                amended by striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting 
                ``101(a)''.
            (7) Indians.--
                    (A) Snyder act.--The last paragraph of section 410 
                of the Act entitled ``An Act authorizing appropriations 
                and expenditures for the administration of Indian 
                Affairs, and for other purposes'', approved November 2, 
                1921 (25 U.S.C. 13) (commonly known as the Snyder Act) 
                is amended by striking ``1201'' and inserting ``101''.
                    (B) Tribally controlled community college 
                assistance.--Section 2(a)(5) of the Tribally Controlled 
                Community College Assistance Act (25 U.S.C. 1801(a)(5)) 
                is amended by striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting 
                ``101(a)''.
                    (C) Construction of new facilities.--Section 
                113(b)(2) of the Tribally Controlled Community College 
                Assistance Act (25 U.S.C. 1813(b)(2)) is amended--
                            (i) by striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting 
                        ``101(a)''; and
                            (ii) by striking ``(20 U.S.C. 1141(a))''.
                    (D) American indian teacher training.--Section 
                1371(a)(1)(B) of the Higher Education Amendments of 
                1992 (25 U.S.C. 3371(a)(1)(B)) is amended by striking 
                ``1201(a)'' and inserting ``101(a)''.
            (8) Labor.--
                    (A) Rehabilitation definitions.--Section 7(32) of 
                the Rehabilitation Act of 1973 (29 U.S.C. 706(32)) is 
                amended--
                            (i) by striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting 
                        ``101(a)''; and
                            (ii) by striking ``(20 U.S.C. 1141(a))''.
                    (B) State plans.--Section 101(a)(7)(A)(iv)(II) of 
                the Rehabilitation Act of 1973 (29 U.S.C. 
                721(a)(7)(A)(iv)(II)) is amended--
                            (i) by striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting 
                        ``101(a)''; and
                            (ii) by striking ``(20 U.S.C. 1141(a))''.
                    (C) JTPA definitions.--Section 4(12) of the Job 
                Training Partnership Act (29 U.S.C. 1503(12)) is 
                amended by striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting 
                ``101(a)''.
                    (D) Tuition charges.--Section 141(d)(3)(B) of the 
                Job Training Partnership Act (29 U.S.C. 1551(d)(3)(B)) 
                is amended--
                            (i) by striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting 
                        ``101(a)''; and
                            (ii) by striking ``(20 U.S.C. 1141(a))''.
            (9) Surface mining control.--Section 701(32) of the Surface 
        Mining Control and Reclamation Act of 1977 (30 U.S.C. 1291(32)) 
        is amended by striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting ``101(a)''.
            (10) Pollution prevention.--Section 112(a)(1) of the 
        Federal Water Pollution Control Act (33 U.S.C. 1262(a)(1)) is 
        amended by striking ``1201'' and inserting ``101''.
            (11) Postal service.--Section 3626(b)(3) of title 39, 
        United States Code, is amended--
                    (A) by striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting 
                ``101(a)''; and
                    (B) by striking ``(20 U.S.C. 1141(a))''.
            (12) Public health and welfare.--
                    (A) Scientific and technical education.--Section 
                3(g) of the Scientific and Advanced-Technology Act of 
                1992 (42 U.S.C. 1862i(g)) is amended--
                            (i) in paragraph (2)--
                                    (I) by striking ``1201(a)'' and 
                                inserting ``101(a)''; and
                                    (II) by striking ``(20 U.S.C. 
                                1141(a))''; and
                            (ii) in paragraph (3)--
                                    (I) by striking ``1201(a)'' and 
                                inserting ``101(a)''; and
                                    (II) by striking ``(20 U.S.C. 
                                1141(a))''.
                    (B) Older americans.--Section 102(32) of the Older 
                Americans Act of 1965 (42 U.S.C. 3002(32)) is amended--
                            (i) by striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting 
                        ``101(a)''; and
                            (ii) by striking ``(20 U.S.C. 1141(a))''.
                    (C) Justice system improvement.--Section 901(17) of 
                the Omnibus Crime Control and Safe Streets Act of 1968 
                (42 U.S.C. 3791(17)) is amended--
                            (i) by striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting 
                        ``101(a)''; and
                            (ii) by striking ``(20 U.S.C. 1141(a))''.
                    (D) Energy technology commercialization services 
                program.--Section 362(f)(5)(A) of the Energy Policy and 
                Conservation Act (42 U.S.C. 6322(f)(5)(A)) is amended--
                            (i) by striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting 
                        ``101(a)''; and
                            (ii) by striking ``(20 U.S.C. 1141(a))''.
                    (E) Environmental restoration and waste 
                management.--Section 3132(b)(1) of the National Defense 
                Authorization Act for Fiscal Years 1992 and 1993 (42 
                U.S.C. 7274e(b)(1)) is amended--
                            (i) by striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting 
                        ``101(a)''; and
                            (ii) by striking ``(20 U.S.C. 1141(a))''.
                    (F) Head start.--Section 649(c)(3) of the Head 
                Start Act (42 U.S.C. 9844(c)(3)) is amended--
                            (i) by striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting 
                        ``101(a)''; and
                            (ii) by striking ``(20 U.S.C. 1141(a))''.
                    (G) State dependent care development grants.--
                Section 670G(5) of the Child Care and Development Block 
                Grant Act of 1990 (42 U.S.C. 9877(5)) is amended by 
                striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting ``101(a)''.
                    (H) Instructional activities for low-income 
                youth.--The matter preceding subparagraph (A) of 
                section 682(b)(1) of the Community Services Block Grant 
                Act (42 U.S.C. 9910c(b)(1)) is amended by striking 
                ``1201(a)'' and inserting ``101(a)''.
                    (I) Drug abuse education.--Section 3601(7) of the 
                Anti-Drug Abuse Act of 1988 (42 U.S.C. 11851(7)) is 
                amended--
                            (i) by striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting 
                        ``101(a)''; and
                            (ii) by striking ``(20 U.S.C. 1141(a))''.
                    (J) National and community service.--Section 
                101(13) of the National and Community Service Act of 
                1990 (42 U.S.C. 12511(13)) is amended--
                            (i) by striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting 
                        ``101(a)''; and
                            (ii) by striking ``(20 U.S.C. 1141(a))''.
                    (K) Civilian community corps.--Section 166(6) of 
                the National and Community Service Act of 1990 (42 
                U.S.C. 12626(6)) is amended--
                            (i) by striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting 
                        ``101(a)''; and
                            (ii) by striking ``(20 U.S.C. 1141(a))''.
                    (L) Community schools youth services and 
                supervision grant program.--The definition of public 
                school in section 30401(b) of the Community Schools 
                Youth Services and Supervision Grant Program Act of 
                1994 (42 U.S.C. 13791(b)) is amended--
                            (i) by striking ``1201'' each place it 
                        appears and inserting ``101''; and
                            (ii) by striking ``(20 U.S.C. 1141(i))''.
                    (M) Police corps.--The definition of institution of 
                higher education in section 200103 of the Police Corps 
                Act (42 U.S.C. 14092) is amended--
                            (i) by striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting 
                        ``101(a)''; and
                            (ii) by striking ``(20 U.S.C. 1141(a))''.
                    (N) Law enforcement scholarship program.--The 
                definition of institution of higher education in 
                section 200202 of the Law Enforcement Scholarship and 
                Recruitment Act (42 U.S.C. 14111) is amended--
                            (i) by striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting 
                        ``101(a)''; and
                            (ii) by striking ``(20 U.S.C. 1141(a))''.
            (13) Telecommunications.--Section 223(h)(4) of the 
        Telecommunications Act of 1934 (47 U.S.C. 223(h)(4)) is 
        amended--
                    (A) by striking ``1201'' and inserting ``101''; and
                    (B) by striking ``(20 U.S.C. 1141)''.
            (14) War and national defense.--Section 808(3) of the David 
        L. Boren National Security Education Act of 1991 (50 U.S.C. 
        1908(3)) is amended--
                    (A) by striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting 
                ``101(a)''; and
                    (B) by striking ``(20 U.S.C. 1141(a))''.
    (b) Cross References.--The Act (20 U.S.C. 1001 et seq.) is 
amended--
            (1) in section 402A(c)(2) (20 U.S.C. 1070a-11(c)(2)), by 
        striking ``1210'' and inserting ``110'';
            (2) in section 481 (20 U.S.C. 1088)--
                    (A) in subsection (a)--
                            (i) in paragraph (1)--
                                    (I) in the matter preceding 
                                subparagraph (A), by striking 
                                ``1201(a)'' and inserting ``101(a)''; 
                                and
                                    (II) in subparagraph (C), by 
                                striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting 
                                ``101(a)''; and
                            (ii) in paragraph (2)--
                                    (I) in the matter preceding clause 
                                (i) of subparagraph (A), by striking 
                                ``1201(a)'' and inserting ``101(a)''; 
                                and
                                    (II) in the matter following clause 
                                (ii) of subparagraph (B), by striking 
                                ``1201(a)'' and inserting ``101(a)'';
                    (B) in subsection (b), by striking ``1201(a)'' each 
                place the term appears and inserting ``101(a)''; and
                    (C) in subsection (c), by striking ``1201(a)'' each 
                place the term appears and inserting ``101(a)'';
            (3) in section 485(f)(1)(I) (20 U.S.C. 1092(f)(1)(I)), by 
        striking ``1213'' and inserting ``111'';
            (4) in section 498(j)(2) (20 U.S.C. 1099c(j)(2)), by 
        striking ``1201(a)(2)'' and inserting ``101(a)(2)'';
            (5) in section 591(d)(2) (20 U.S.C. 1115(d)(2)), by 
        striking ``1201(a)'' and inserting ``101(a)'';
            (6) in section 631(a)(8) (20 U.S.C. 1132(a)(8))--
                    (A) by striking ``section 1201(a)'' each place the 
                term appears and inserting ``section 101(a)''; and
                    (B) by striking ``of 1201(a)'' and inserting ``of 
                section 101(a)''; and
            (7) in section 1081(d) (20 U.S.C. 1135f(d)), by striking 
        ``1201'' and inserting ``101(a)''.

                  TITLE II--IMPROVING TEACHER QUALITY

SEC. 201. IMPROVING TEACHER QUALITY.

    The Act (20 U.S.C. 1001) is amended by inserting after section 112 
(as added by section 105) the following:

                 ``TITLE II--IMPROVING TEACHER QUALITY

``SEC. 201. PURPOSES.

    ``The purpose of this title is to--
            ``(1) improve student achievement;
            ``(2) improve the quality of the current and future 
        teaching force by improving the preparation of prospective 
        teachers and enhancing professional development activities; and
            ``(3) hold institutions of higher education accountable for 
        preparing teachers who have the necessary teaching skills and 
        are highly competent in the academic content areas in which the 
        teachers plan to teach, including training in the effective 
        uses of technologies in the classroom.

                       ``PART A--TEACHER QUALITY

            ``Subpart 1--Teacher Quality Enhancement Grants

``SEC. 211. GRANTS AUTHORIZED.

    ``(a) In General.--The Secretary is authorized to award grants to 
States to enable the States to carry out the activities described in 
section 212. Each grant may be awarded for a period of not more than 5 
years.
    ``(b) State Designation.--
            ``(1) In general.--A State desiring a grant under this 
        subpart shall, consistent with State law, designate the chief 
        individual or entity in the State responsible for the State 
        supervision of education, to administer the activities assisted 
        under this subpart.
            ``(2) Consultation.--The individual or entity designated 
        under paragraph (1) shall consult with the Governor, State 
        board of education, or State educational agency, as 
        appropriate.
            ``(3) Construction.--Nothing in this subpart shall be 
        construed to negate or supersede the legal authority under 
        State law of any State agency, State entity, or State public 
        official over programs that are under the jurisdiction of the 
        agency, entity, or official.
    ``(c) Matching Requirement.--Each State receiving a grant under 
this subpart shall provide, from non-Federal sources, an amount equal 
to \1/2\ of the amount of the grant, in cash or in kind, to carry out 
the activities supported through the grant.

``SEC. 212. USE OF FUNDS.

    ``A State that receives a grant under this subpart shall use the 
grant funds to reform teacher preparation requirements, and to ensure 
that current and future teachers possess the necessary teaching skills 
and academic content knowledge in the subject areas in which the 
teachers are assigned to teach, by carrying out 1 or more of the 
following activities:
            ``(1) Reforms.--Implementing reforms that hold institutions 
        of higher education with teacher preparation programs 
        accountable for preparing teachers who are highly competent in 
        the academic content areas in which the teachers plan to teach, 
        which may include the use of rigorous subject matter competency 
        tests and the requirement that a teacher have an academic major 
        in the subject area, or related discipline, in which the 
        teacher plans to teach.
            ``(2) Certification or licensure requirements.--Reforming 
        teacher certification or licensure requirements to ensure that 
        new teachers have the necessary teaching skills and academic 
        content knowledge in the subject areas in which teachers are 
        assigned to teach.
            ``(3) Alternatives to traditional preparation for 
        teaching.--Providing prospective teachers alternatives to 
        traditional preparation for teaching through programs at 
        colleges of arts and sciences or at nonprofit educational 
        organizations.
            ``(4) Alternative routes.--Funding programs that establish, 
        expand, or improve alternative routes to State certification 
        for highly qualified individuals from other occupations and 
        recent college graduates with records of academic distinction, 
        including support during the initial teaching experience.
            ``(5) Recruitment; pay; removal.--Developing and 
        implementing effective mechanisms to ensure that schools are 
        able to effectively recruit highly qualified teachers, to 
        financially reward those teachers and principals whose students 
        have made significant progress toward high academic 
        performance, such as through performance-based compensation 
        systems and access to ongoing professional development 
        opportunities for teachers and administrators, and to remove 
        teachers who are not qualified.
            ``(6) Innovative efforts.--Development and implementation 
        of innovative efforts aimed at reducing the shortage of highly 
        qualified teachers in high poverty urban and rural areas, and 
        in school districts with disproportionately high numbers of 
        limited English proficient students, that may include the 
        recruitment of highly qualified individuals from other 
        occupations through alternative certification programs.
            ``(7) Social promotion.--Development and implementation of 
        efforts to address the problem of social promotion and to 
        prepare teachers to effectively address the issues raised by 
        ending the practice of social promotion.

``SEC. 213. COMPETITIVE AWARDS.

    ``(a) Annual Awards; Competitive Basis.--The Secretary shall award 
grants under this subpart annually and on a competitive basis.
    ``(b) Peer Review Panel.--The Secretary shall provide the 
applications submitted by States under section 214 to a peer review 
panel for evaluation. With respect to each application, the peer review 
panel shall initially recommend the application for funding or for 
disapproval.
    ``(c) Priority.--In recommending applications for funding to the 
Secretary, the panel shall give priority to applications from States 
that describe activities that--
            ``(1) include innovative reforms to hold institutions of 
        higher education with teacher preparation programs accountable 
        for preparing teachers who are highly competent in the academic 
        content areas in which the teachers plan to teach; and
            ``(2) involve the development of innovative efforts aimed 
        at reducing the shortage of highly qualified teachers in high 
        poverty urban and rural areas.

``SEC. 214. APPLICATIONS.

    ``(a) In General.--Each State desiring a grant under this subpart 
shall submit an application to the Secretary at such time, in such 
manner and accompanied by such information as the Secretary may 
require.
    ``(b) Content of Applications.--Such application shall include a 
description of how the State intends to use funds provided under this 
subpart.

           ``Subpart 2--Teacher Training Partnerships Grants

``SEC. 221. GRANTS AUTHORIZED.

    ``(a) In General.--The Secretary is authorized to award grants to 
teacher training partnerships to enable the partnerships to carry out 
the activities described in section 222. Each grant may be awarded for 
a period of not more than 5 years.
    ``(b) Definitions.--In this part:
            ``(1) Teacher training partnerships.--
                    ``(A) In general.--The term `teacher training 
                partnership' means a partnership that--
                            ``(i) shall include a school of arts and 
                        sciences, a school or program of education, a 
                        local educational agency, and a kindergarten 
                        through grade 12 school;
                            ``(ii) shall include a high need local 
                        educational agency or kindergarten through 
                        grade 12 school; and
                            ``(iii) may include a State educational 
                        agency, a pre-kindergarten program, a nonprofit 
                        educational organization, a business, or a 
                        teacher organization.
                    ``(B) High need.--A local educational agency or 
                kindergarten through grade 12 school shall be 
                considered high need for purposes of subparagraph 
                (A)(ii) if the agency or school serves an area within a 
                State in which there is--
                            ``(i) a large number of individuals from 
                        families with incomes below the poverty line;
                            ``(ii) a high percentage of teachers not 
                        teaching in the content area in which the 
                        teachers were trained to teach; or
                            ``(iii) a high teacher turnover rate.
            ``(2) Kindergarten through grade 12 school.--The term 
        `kindergarten through grade 12 school' means a school having 
        any one of the grades kindergarten through grade 12.
    ``(c) Priority.--In awarding grants under this subpart the 
Secretary shall give priority to partnerships that involve businesses.
    ``(d) Consideration.--In awarding grants under this subpart the 
Secretary shall take into consideration--
            ``(1) providing an equitable geographic distribution of the 
        grants throughout the United States; and
            ``(2) the proposed project's potential for creating 
        improvement and positive change.
    ``(e) Matching Funds.--Each partnership receiving a grant under 
this subpart shall provide, from sources other than this subpart, an 
amount equal to 25 percent of the grant in the first year, 35 percent 
in the second such year, and 50 percent in each succeeding such year, 
of the amount of the grant, in cash or in kind, to carry out the 
activities supported by the grant.
    ``(f) One-Time Award.--A partnership may receive a grant under this 
section only once.

``SEC. 222. USE OF FUNDS.

    ``(a) In General.--Grant funds under this part shall be used to--
            ``(1) coordinate with the activities of the Governor, State 
        board of education, and State educational agency, as 
        appropriate;
            ``(2) provide sustained and high quality preservice 
        clinical experiences including the mentoring of prospective 
        teachers by veteran teachers;
            ``(3) work with a school of arts and sciences to provide 
        increased academic study in a proposed teaching specialty area, 
        through activities such as--
                    ``(A) restructuring curriculum;
                    ``(B) changing core course requirements;
                    ``(C) increasing liberal arts focus;
                    ``(D) providing preparation for board 
                certification; and
                    ``(E) assessing and improving alternative 
                certification, including mentoring and induction 
                support;
            ``(4) substantially increasing interaction and 2-way 
        collaboration between--
                    ``(A) faculty at institutions of higher education; 
                and
                    ``(B) new and experienced teachers, principals, and 
                other administrators at elementary schools or secondary 
                schools;
            ``(5) prepare teachers to use technology effectively in the 
        classroom;
            ``(6) integrate reliable research-based teaching methods 
        into the curriculum;
            ``(7) broadly disseminate information on effective 
        practices used by the partnership; and
            ``(8) provide support, including preparation time, for 
        interaction between faculty at an institution of higher 
        education and classroom teachers.
    ``(b) Special Rule.--No individual member of a partnership shall 
retain more than 50 percent of the funds made available to the 
partnership under this subpart.
    ``(c) Construction.--Nothing in this part shall be construed to 
prohibit a teacher training partnership from using grant funds to 
coordinate with the activities of more than 1 Governor, State board of 
education, or State educational agency.

``SEC. 223. APPLICATIONS.

    ``Each teacher training partnership desiring a grant under this 
subpart shall submit an application to the Secretary at such time, in 
such manner, and accompanied by such information as the Secretary may 
require. Each such application shall--
            ``(1) describe the composition of the partnership and the 
        involvement of each partner in the development of the 
        application;
            ``(2) contain a needs assessment that includes an analysis 
        of the needs of all the partners with respect to teaching and 
        learning;
            ``(3) contain a resource assessment that includes--
                    ``(A) an analysis of resources available to the 
                partnership;
                    ``(B) a description of the intended use of the 
                grant funds;
                    ``(C) a description of how the partnership will 
                coordinate with other teacher training or professional 
                development programs, including Federal, State, local, 
                private, and other programs;
                    ``(D) a description of how the activities assisted 
                under this subpart are consistent with educational 
                reform activities that promote student achievement; and
                    ``(E) a description of the commitment of the 
                resources of the partnership to the activities assisted 
                under this subpart, including financial support, 
                faculty participation, and time commitments;
            ``(4) describe how the partnership will include the 
        participation of the schools, colleges, or departments of arts 
        and sciences within an institution of higher education to 
        ensure the integration of teaching techniques and content in 
        teaching preparation;
            ``(5) describe how the partnership will restructure and 
        improve teaching, teacher training, and development programs, 
        and how such systemic changes will contribute to increased 
        student achievement;
            ``(6) describe how the partnership will prepare teachers to 
        work with diverse student populations, including individuals 
        with disabilities and limited English proficient individuals;
            ``(7) describe how the partnership will prepare teachers to 
        use technology;
            ``(8) contain a dissemination plan regarding knowledge and 
        information with respect to effective teaching practices, and a 
        description of how such knowledge and information will be 
        implemented in elementary schools or secondary schools as well 
        as institutions of higher education;
            ``(9) describe the commitment of the partnership to 
        continue the activities assisted under this subpart without 
        grant funds provided under this subpart; and
            ``(10) describe how the partnership will involve and 
        include parents in the reform process.

                    ``Subpart 3--General Provisions

``SEC. 231. ACCOUNTABILITY AND EVALUATION.

    ``(a) Teacher Quality Enhancement Grants.--
            ``(1) Accountability report.--A State that receives a grant 
        under subpart 1 shall submit an annual accountability report to 
        the Secretary, the Committee on Labor and Human Resources of 
        the Senate, and the Committee on Education and the Workforce of 
        the House of Representatives. Such report shall include a 
        description of the degree to which the State, in using funds 
        provided under subpart 1, has made substantial progress in 
        meeting the following goals:
                    ``(A) Student achievement.--Increasing student 
                achievement for all students, as measured by increased 
                graduation rates, decreased dropout rates, or higher 
                scores on local, State or other assessments.
                    ``(B) Raising standards.--Raising the State 
                academic standards required to enter the teaching 
                profession, including, where appropriate, incentives to 
                incorporate the requirement of an academic major in the 
                subject, or related discipline, in which the teacher 
                plans to teach.
                    ``(C) Initial certification or licensure.--
                Increasing success in the passage rate for initial 
                State teacher certification or licensure, or increasing 
                numbers of highly qualified individuals being certified 
                or licensed as teachers through alternative programs.
                    ``(D) Core academic subjects.--(i) Increasing the 
                percentage of secondary school classes taught in core 
                academic subject areas by teachers--
                            ``(I) with academic majors in those areas 
                        or in a related field;
                            ``(II) who can demonstrate a high level of 
                        competence through rigorous academic subject 
                        area tests; or
                            ``(III) who can demonstrate high levels of 
                        competence through experience in relevant 
                        content areas.
                    ``(ii) Increasing the percentage of elementary 
                school classes taught by teachers--
                            ``(I) with academic majors in the arts and 
                        sciences; or
                            ``(II) who can demonstrate high levels of 
                        competence through experience in relevant 
                        content areas.
                    ``(E) Decreasing shortages for professional 
                development.--Decreasing shortages of qualified 
                teachers in poor urban and rural areas.
                    ``(F) Increasing opportunities.--Increasing 
                opportunities for enhanced and ongoing professional 
                development that improves the academic content 
                knowledge of teachers in the subject areas in which the 
                teachers are certified to teach or in which the 
                teachers are working toward certification to teach.
                    ``(G) Technology integration.--Increasing the 
                number of teachers prepared to integrate technology in 
                the classroom.
            ``(2) Teacher qualifications provided to parent upon 
        request.--Any local educational agency that benefits from the 
        activities assisted under subpart 1 shall make available, upon 
        request and in an understandable and uniform format, to any 
        parent of a student attending any school served by the local 
        educational agency, information regarding the qualifications of 
        the student's classroom teacher with regard to the subject 
        matter in which the teacher provides instruction. The local 
        educational agency shall inform parents that the parents are 
        entitled to receive the information upon request.
    ``(b) Teacher Training Partnership Evaluation Plan.--Each teacher 
training partnership receiving a grant under subpart 2 shall establish 
an evaluation plan that includes strong performance objectives 
established in negotiation with the Secretary at the time of the grant 
award. The plan shall include objectives and measures for--
            ``(1) increased student achievement for all students as 
        measured by increased graduation rates, decreased dropout 
        rates, or higher scores on local, State, or other assessments 
        for a year compared to student achievement as determined by the 
        rates or scores, as the case may be, for the year prior to the 
        year for which a grant under this part is received;
            ``(2) increased teacher retention in the first 3 years of a 
        teacher's career;
            ``(3) increased success in the passage rate for initial 
        State certification or licensure of teachers;
            ``(4) increased percentages of secondary school classes 
        taught in core academic subject areas by teachers--
                    ``(A) with academic majors in those areas or in a 
                related field;
                    ``(B) who can demonstrate a high level of 
                competence through rigorous academic subject area 
                tests; and
                    ``(C) increasing the percentage of elementary 
                school classes taught by teachers with academic majors 
                in the arts and sciences;
            ``(5) increased integration of technology in teacher 
        preparation and in classroom instruction;
            ``(6) restructuring or change of methodology courses to 
        reflect best practices learned from elementary schools, 
        secondary schools or other entities;
            ``(7) increased dissemination of information about 
        effective teaching strategies and practices; and
            ``(8) other effects of increased integration among members 
        of the partnership.

``SEC. 232. REVOCATION OF GRANT.

    ``Each State or teacher training partnership receiving a grant 
under this part shall report annually on progress toward meeting the 
purposes of this part, and the goals, objectives and measures described 
in section 231. If the Secretary, after consultation with the peer 
review panel described in section 213(b) determines that the State or 
partnership is not making substantial progress in meeting the purposes, 
goals, objectives and measures, as appropriate, by the end of the 
second year of the grant, the grant shall not be continued for the 
third year of the grant.

``SEC. 233. EVALUATION AND DISSEMINATION.

    ``The Secretary shall evaluate the activities funded under this 
part and report the Secretary's findings to the Committee on Labor and 
Human Resources of the Senate and the Committee on Education and the 
Workforce of the House of Representatives. The Secretary shall broadly 
disseminate successful practices developed by the States and teacher 
training partnerships under this part, and shall broadly disseminate 
information regarding such practices so developed that were found to be 
ineffective.

``SEC. 234. INTERNATIONAL STUDY AND REPORT.

    ``(a) Study.--The Secretary shall conduct a study through the 
National Center for Education Statistics regarding the ways teachers 
are trained and the extent to which teachers in the United States and 
other comparable countries are teaching in areas other than the 
teachers' field of study or expertise. The study will examine specific 
fields and will outline the nature and extent of the problem of out-of-
field teaching in the United States and in other countries that are 
considered comparable to the United States. The study shall include, at 
a minimum, all the countries that participated in the Third 
International Mathematics and Science Study (TIMSS).
    ``(b) Report.--The Secretary shall report to Congress regarding the 
results of the study described in subsection (a).

``SEC. 235. ACCOUNTABILITY FOR PROGRAMS THAT PREPARE TEACHERS.

    ``(a) Information Collection and Publication.--
            ``(1) Definitions.--
                    ``(A) Within six months of the date of enactment of 
                the Higher Education Amendments of 1998, the 
                Commissioner of the National Center for Education 
                Statistics, in consultation with States and 
                institutions of higher education, shall develop key 
                definitions and uniform methods of calculation for 
                terms related to the performance of elementary school 
                and secondary school teacher preparation programs.
                    ``(B) In complying with this section, the Secretary 
                and State shall ensure that fair and equitable methods 
                are used in reporting and that they protect the privacy 
                of individuals.
            ``(2) Information.--
                    ``(A) State report card on the quality of teacher 
                preparation.--States that receive funds under this Act 
                shall provide to the Secretary, within two years of 
                enactment of the Higher Education Amendments of 1998, 
                and annually thereafter, in a uniform and 
                comprehensible manner that conforms with the 
                definitions and methods established in subsection 
                (a)(1), a State report card on the quality of teacher 
                preparation, which shall include at least the 
                following:
                            ``(i) A description of the teacher 
                        certification and licensure assessments, and 
                        any other certification and licensure 
                        requirements, used by each State.
                            ``(ii) The standards and criteria that 
                        prospective teachers must meet in order to 
                        attain initial teacher licensing or 
                        certification and to be licensed to teach 
                        particular subjects or in particular grades 
                        within the State.
                            ``(iii) A description of the extent to 
                        which those assessments and requirements are 
                        aligned with the State's standards and 
                        assessments for students.
                            ``(iv) The percentage of teaching 
                        candidates who passed each of the assessments 
                        used by the State for licensure and 
                        certification, and the `cut score' on each 
                        assessment that determines whether a candidate 
                        has passed that assessment.
                            ``(v) The percentage of teaching candidates 
                        who passed each of the assessments used by the 
                        State for licensure and certification, 
                        disaggregated by the teacher preparation 
                        program in that State from which the teacher 
                        candidate received his or her most recent 
                        degree. States shall make these data available 
                        widely and publicly.
                            ``(vi) Information on the extent to which 
                        teachers in the State have been given waivers 
                        of State licensure or certification 
                        requirements, including the proportion of such 
                        teachers distributed across high and low 
                        poverty districts and across subject areas.
                            ``(vii) A description of each State's 
                        alternative routes to teacher certification, if 
                        any, and the percentage of teachers certified 
                        through alternative certification routes who 
                        pass State licensing assessments.
                            ``(viii) For each State, a description of 
                        proposed criteria for assessing the performance 
                        of teacher preparation programs within 
                        institutions of higher education, including but 
                        not limited to indicators of teacher candidate 
                        knowledge and skills as described in subsection 
                        (b)(1)(A).
                    ``(B) Report of the secretary on the quality of 
                teacher preparation.--The Secretary shall publish 
                annually and make widely available a report card on 
                teacher qualifications and preparation in the United 
                States, including all the information reported in 
                subparagraphs (A) (i)-(viii), beginning three years 
                after enactment of the Higher Education Amendments of 
                1998. The Secretary shall report to Congress a 
                comparison of States' efforts to improve teaching 
                quality. The Secretary shall also report on the 
                national mean and median scores on any standardized 
                test that is used in more than one State for teacher 
                licensure or certification. In the case of teacher 
                preparation programs with fewer than 10 graduates 
                taking any single initial teacher certification 
                assessment during any administration of such 
                assessment, the Secretary shall collect and publish 
                information with respect to an average pass rate on 
                State certification or licensure assessments taken over 
                3 years.
                    ``(C) Institutional report cards on the quality of 
                teacher preparation.--Each institution of higher 
                education that conducts a teacher preparation program 
                that enrolls students receiving Federal assistance 
                shall, not later than two years after the enactment of 
                the Higher Education Amendments of 1998, and annually 
                thereafter, report, in a uniform and comprehensible 
                manner, the following information to the State, and the 
                general public, including through publications such as 
                course catalogues and promotional materials sent to 
                potential applicants, high school guidance counselors, 
                and prospective employers of its program graduates, in 
                a manner that conforms with the definitions and methods 
                established under subsection (a)(1):
                            ``(i) For the most recent year for which 
                        the information is available, the passing rate 
                        of its graduates on the teacher certification 
                        and licensure assessments of the State in which 
                        it is located, but only for those students who 
                        took those assessments within three years of 
                        completing the program. A comparison of the 
                        program's pass rate with the State average pass 
                        rate shall be included as well. In the case of 
                        teacher preparation programs with fewer than 10 
                        graduates taking any single initial teacher 
                        certification assessment during any 
                        administration of such assessment, the 
                        institution shall collect and publish 
                        information with respect to an average pass 
                        rate on State certification or licensure 
                        assessments taken over 3 years.
                            ``(ii) The number of students in the 
                        program, the average number of hours of 
                        supervised practice teaching required for those 
                        in the program, and the faculty-student ratio 
                        in supervised practice teaching.
                            ``(iii) In States that approve or accredit 
                        teacher education programs, a statement of 
                        whether the institution's program is so 
                        approved or accredited.
                            ``(iv) Whether the program has been 
                        designated as low-performing by the State under 
                        subsection (b)(1)(B).
                In addition to the actions authorized in section 
                487(c), the Secretary may impose a fine not to exceed 
                $25,000 on a teacher preparation program for failure to 
                provide the information described in subsection 
                (a)(2)(B) in a timely or accurate manner.
    ``(b) Accountability.--
            ``(1) States receiving funding under this Act, shall 
        develop and implement, no later than three years after 
        enactment of the Higher Education Amendments of 1998, the 
        following teacher preparation program accountability measures 
        and publish the measures publicly and widely:
                    ``(A) A description of State criteria for 
                identifying low-performing teacher preparation programs 
                which may include a baseline pass rate on State 
                licensing assessments and other indicators of teacher 
                candidate knowledge and skill. States that do not 
                employ assessments as part of their criteria for 
                licensing or certification are not required to meet 
                this criterion until such time as the State initiates 
                the use of such assessments.
                    ``(B) Procedures for identifying low-performing 
                teacher preparation programs based on the criteria 
                developed by the State as required by subsection 
                (b)(1)(A), and publish a list of those programs.
                    ``(C) States that have, prior to enactment, already 
                conformed with subsections (b)(1) (A)-(B), need not 
                change their procedures, unless the State chooses to do 
                so.
            ``(2) Not later than four years after enactment of the 
        Higher Education Amendments of 1998, any teacher preparation 
        programs for which the State has withdrawn its approval or 
        terminated its financial support due to the low performance of 
        its teacher preparation program based on procedures described 
        in subsection (b)(1)--
                    ``(A) shall be ineligible for any funding for 
                professional development activities awarded by the 
                Department of Education; and
                    ``(B) shall not be permitted to accept or enroll 
                any student that receives aid under title IV of this 
                Act in its teacher preparation program.

``SEC. 236. AUTHORIZATION OF APPROPRIATIONS.

    ``There are authorized to be appropriated to carry out this part 
$300,000,000 for fiscal year 1999 and such sums as necessary for each 
of the 4 succeeding fiscal years, of which--
            ``(1) 50 percent shall be available for each fiscal year to 
        carry out subpart 1; and
            ``(2) 50 percent shall be available for each fiscal year to 
        carry out subpart 2.

        ``PART B--RECRUITING NEW TEACHERS FOR UNDERSERVED AREAS

``SEC. 251. STATEMENT OF PURPOSE.

    ``It is the purpose of this part to--
            ``(1) provide scholarships and, as necessary, support 
        services for students with high potential to become effective 
        teachers, particularly minority students;
            ``(2) increase the quality and number of new teachers 
        nationally; and
            ``(3) increase the ability of schools in underserved areas 
        to recruit a qualified teaching staff.

``SEC. 252. DEFINITIONS.

    ``In this part--
            ``(1) Eligible partnership.--
                    ``(A) In general.--The term `eligible partnership' 
                means a partnership consisting of--
                            ``(i) an institution of higher education 
                        that awards baccalaureate degrees and prepares 
                        teachers for their initial entry into the 
                        teaching profession; and
                            ``(ii) one or more local educational 
                        agencies that serve underserved areas.
                    ``(B) Additional partners.--Such a partnership may 
                also include--
                            ``(i) 2-year institutions of higher 
                        education that operate teacher preparation 
                        programs and maintain articulation agreements, 
                        with the institutions of higher education that 
                        award baccalaureate degrees for the transfer of 
                        credits in teacher preparation;
                            ``(ii) State agencies that have 
                        responsibility for policies related to teacher 
                        preparation and teacher certification or 
                        licensure; and
                            ``(iii) other public and private, nonprofit 
                        agencies and organizations that serve, or are 
                        located in, communities served by the local 
                        educational agencies in the partnership, and 
                        that have an interest in teacher recruitment, 
                        preparation, and induction.
            ``(2) Support services.--The term `support services' 
        means--
                    ``(A) academic advice and counseling;
                    ``(B) tutorial services;
                    ``(C) mentoring; and
                    ``(D) child care and transportation, if funding for 
                those services cannot be arranged from other sources.
            ``(3) Underserved area.--The term `underserved area' 
        means--
                    ``(A) the area served by the 3 local educational 
                agencies in the State that have the highest numbers of 
                children, ages 5 through 17, from families below the 
                poverty level (based on data satisfactory to the 
                Secretary); and
                    ``(B) the area served by any other local 
                educational agency in which the percentage of such 
                children is at least 20 percent, or the number of such 
                children is at least 10,000.

``SEC. 253. GRANT AUTHORITY AND CONDITIONS.

    ``(a) Grants Authorized.--
            ``(1) Grants.--
                    ``(A) In general.--From amounts appropriated under 
                section 262 the Secretary shall award grants, on a 
                competitive basis, to eligible partnerships to enable 
                the eligible partnerships to pay the Federal share of 
                the cost of carrying out the activities described in 
                section 255.
                    ``(B) Duration.--Each grant awarded under 
                subparagraph (A) shall be awarded for a period not to 
                exceed 5 years.
            ``(2) Continuing eligibility; review of progress.--The 
        Secretary shall--
                    ``(A) continue to make grant payments for the 
                second and succeeding years of a grant awarded under 
                this part, only after determining that the eligible 
                partnership is making satisfactory progress in carrying 
                out the activities under the grant; and
                    ``(B) conduct an intensive review of the eligible 
                partnerships's progress under the grant, with the 
                assistance of outside experts, before making grant 
                payments for the fourth year of the grant.
            ``(3) Maximum number.--No eligible partnership may receive 
        more than 2 grants under this subsection.
    ``(b) Matching Requirement.--
            ``(1) Federal share.--The Federal share of the cost of 
        activities carried out under a grant made under subsection (a) 
        shall not exceed--
                    ``(A) 70 percent of the cost in the first year of 
                the grant;
                    ``(B) 60 percent in the second year;
                    ``(C) 60 percent in the third year;
                    ``(D) 50 percent in the fourth year; and
                    ``(E) 50 percent in the fifth year and any 
                succeeding year (including each year of the second 
                grant, if any).
            ``(2) Non-federal share.--The non-Federal share of 
        activities carried out with a grant under subsection (a) may be 
        provided in cash or in kind, fairly evaluated, and may be 
        obtained from any non-Federal public or private source.
    ``(c) Planning Grants.--
            ``(1) In general.--The Secretary may award planning grants 
        to eligible partnerships that are not ready to implement 
        programs under subsection (a).
            ``(2) Duration.--Each planning grant shall be for a period 
        of not more than 1 year, which shall be in addition to the 
        period of any grant under subsection (a).
            ``(3) Requirement.--Any recipient of a planning grant under 
        this subsection that wishes to receive a grant under subsection 
        (a)(1) shall separately apply for a grant under that 
        subsection.

``SEC. 254. GRANT APPLICATIONS.

    ``(a) Applications Required.--Any eligible partnership desiring to 
receive a grant under this part shall submit an application to the 
Secretary at such time, in such form, and containing such information 
as the Secretary may require.
    ``(b) Application Contents.--Each application for a grant under 
section 253(a) shall include--
            ``(1) a designation of the institution or agency, within 
        the eligible partnership, that will serve as the fiscal agent 
        for the grant;
            ``(2) information on the quality of the teacher preparation 
        program of the institution of higher education participating in 
        the eligible partnership and how the eligible partnership will 
        ensure, through improvements in the eligible partnership's 
        teacher preparation practices or other appropriate strategies, 
        that scholarship recipients will receive high-quality 
        preparation;
            ``(3) a description of the assessment the members of the 
        eligible partnership have undertaken--
                    ``(A) to determine--
                            ``(i) the most critical needs of the local 
                        educational agencies, particularly the needs of 
                        schools in high-poverty areas, for new teachers 
                        (which may include teachers in particular 
                        subject areas or at certain grade levels); and
                            ``(ii) how the project carried out under 
                        the grant will address those needs; and
                    ``(B) that reflects the input of all significant 
                entities in the community (including organizations 
                representing teachers and parents) that have an 
                interest in teacher recruitment, preparation, and 
                induction;
            ``(4) a description of the project the eligible partnership 
        will carry out with the grant, including information 
        regarding--
                    ``(A) the recruitment and outreach efforts the 
                eligible partnership will undertake to publicize the 
                availability of scholarships and other assistance under 
                the program;
                    ``(B)(i) the number and types of students that the 
                eligible partnership will serve under the program, 
                which may include education paraprofessionals seeking 
                to achieve full teacher certification or licensure; 
                teachers whom the partner local educational agencies 
                have hired under emergency certification or licensure 
                procedures; or former military personnel, mid-career 
                professionals, or AmeriCorps or Peace Corps volunteers, 
                who desire to enter teaching; and
                    ``(ii) the criteria that the eligible partnership 
                will use in selecting the students, including criteria 
                to determine whether individuals have the capacity to 
                benefit from the program, complete teacher 
                certification requirements, and become effective 
                teachers;
                    ``(C) the activities the eligible partnership will 
                carry out under the grant, including a description of, 
                and justification for, any support services the 
                institution of higher education participating in the 
                eligible partnership will offer to participating 
                students;
                    ``(D) the number and funding range of the 
                scholarships the institution will provide to students; 
                and
                    ``(E) the procedures the institution will establish 
                for entering into, and enforcing, agreements with 
                scholarship recipients regarding the recipients' 
                fulfillment of the service commitment described in 
                section 259;
            ``(5) a description of how the institution will use funds 
        provided under the grant only--
                    ``(A) to increase the number of students--
                            ``(i) with high potential to be effective 
                        teachers;
                            ``(ii) participating in the institution's 
                        teacher preparation programs; or
                            ``(iii) in the particular type or types of 
                        preparation programs that the grant will 
                        support; or
                    ``(B) to increase the number of graduates, who are 
                minority individuals, with high potential to be 
                effective teachers;
            ``(6) a description of the commitments, by the local 
        educational agencies participating in the partnership, to hire 
        qualified scholarship recipients in the schools served by the 
        agencies and in the subject areas or grade levels for which the 
        scholarship recipients will be trained, and a description of 
        the actions the participating institution of higher education, 
        the participating local educational agencies, and the other 
        partners will take to facilitate the successful transition of 
        the recipients into teaching; and
            ``(7) a description of the eligible partnership's plan for 
        institutionalizing the activities the partnership is carrying 
        out under this part, so that the activities will continue once 
        Federal funding ceases.

``SEC. 255. USES OF FUNDS.

    ``(a) In General.--Each eligible partnership receiving a grant 
under section 523(a) shall use the grant funds for the following:
            ``(1) Scholarships.--Scholarships to help students pay the 
        costs of tuition, room, board, and other expenses of completing 
        a teacher preparation program.
            ``(2) Support services.--Support services, if needed to 
        enable scholarship recipients to complete postsecondary 
        education programs.
            ``(3) Followup services.--Followup services provided to 
        former scholarship recipients during the recipients' first 3 
        years of teaching.
            ``(4) Payments.--Payments to partner local educational 
        agencies, if needed to enable the agencies to permit 
        paraprofessional staff to participate in teacher preparation 
        programs (such as the cost of release time for the staff).
            ``(5) Additional courses.--If appropriate, and if no other 
        funds are available for, paying the costs of additional courses 
        taken by former scholarship recipients during the recipients' 
        initial 3 years of teaching.
    ``(b) Planning Grants.--A recipient of a planning grant under 
section 253(c) shall use the grant funds for the costs of planning for 
the implementation of a grant under section 253(a).

``SEC. 256. SELECTION OF APPLICANTS.

    ``(a) Peer Review.--The Secretary, using a peer review process, 
shall select eligible partnerships to receive funding under this part 
on the basis of--
            ``(1) the quality of the teacher preparation program 
        offered by the institution participating in the partnership;
            ``(2) the quality of the program carried out under the 
        application; and
            ``(3) the capacity of the partnership to carry out the 
        grant successfully.
    ``(b) Criteria.--
            ``(1) In general.--In awarding grants under section 253(a), 
        the Secretary shall seek to ensure that--
                    ``(A) in the aggregate, eligible partnerships carry 
                out a variety of approaches to preparing new teachers; 
                and
                    ``(B) there is an equitable geographic distribution 
                of the grants.
            ``(2) Special consideration.--In addition to complying with 
        paragraph (1), the Secretary shall give special consideration 
        to--
                    ``(A) applications most likely to result in the 
                preparation of increased numbers of individuals with 
                high potential for effective teaching who are minority 
                individuals;
                    ``(B) applications from partnerships that have as 
                members of the partnerships historically Black colleges 
                and universities, Hispanic-serving institutions, and 
                Tribal Colleges and Universities; or
                    ``(C) applications from partnerships that propose 
                to carry out programs that use innovative means, 
                including technology, to recruit for participation in 
                the activities assisted under the programs students who 
                are Native Hawaiian, Alaska Native, or Native American 
                Pacific Islander.
    ``(c) Second Five-Year Grants.--In selecting eligible partnerships 
to receive second year grant payments under this part, the Secretary 
shall give a preference to eligible partnerships whose projects have 
resulted in--
            ``(1) the placement and retention of a substantial number 
        of high-quality graduates in teaching positions in underserved, 
        high-poverty schools;
            ``(2) the adoption of effective programs that meet the 
        teacher preparation needs of high-poverty urban and rural 
        areas; and
            ``(3) effective partnerships with elementary schools and 
        secondary schools that are supporting improvements in student 
        achievement.

``SEC. 257. DURATION AND AMOUNT OF ASSISTANCE; RELATION TO OTHER 
              ASSISTANCE.

    ``(a) Duration of Assistance.--No individual may receive 
scholarship assistance under this part--
            ``(1) for more than 5 years of postsecondary education; and
            ``(2) unless that individual satisfies the requirements of 
        section 484(a)(5).
    ``(b) Amount of Assistance.--No individual may receive a 
scholarship awarded under this part that exceeds the cost of 
attendance, as defined in section 472, at the institution of higher 
education the individual is attending.
    ``(c) Relation to Other Assistance.--A scholarship awarded under 
this part--
            ``(1) shall not be reduced on the basis of the individual's 
        receipt of other forms of Federal student financial assistance; 
        and
            ``(2) shall be regarded as other financial assistance 
        available to the student, within the meaning of sections 471(3) 
        and 480(j)(1), in determining the student's eligibility for 
        grant, loan, or work assistance under title IV.

``SEC. 258. SCHOLARSHIP CONDITIONS.

    ``(a) In General.--A recipient of a scholarship under this part 
shall continue to receive the scholarship assistance only as long as 
the recipient is--
            ``(1) enrolled as a full-time student and pursuing a course 
        of study leading to teacher certification, unless the recipient 
        is working in a public school (as a paraprofessional, or as a 
        teacher under emergency credentials) while participating in the 
        program; and
            ``(2) maintaining satisfactory progress as determined by 
        the institution of higher education participating in the 
        partnership.
    ``(b) Special Rule. Each eligible partnership shall modify the 
application of section 257(a)(1) and of subsection (a)(1) to the extent 
necessary to accommodate the rights of individuals with disabilities 
under section 504 of the Rehabilitation Act of 1973.

``SEC. 259. SERVICE REQUIREMENTS.

    ``(a) Requirement.--Each eligible partnership receiving a grant 
under this part shall enter into an agreement, with each student to 
whom the partnership awards a scholarship under this part, providing 
that a scholarship recipient who completes a teacher preparation 
program under this part shall, within 7 years of completing that 
program, teach full-time for at least 5 years in a high-poverty school 
in an underserved geographic area or repay the amount of the 
scholarship, under the terms and conditions established by the 
Secretary.
    ``(b) Regulations. The Secretary shall prescribe regulations 
relating to the requirements of subsection (a), including any 
provisions for waiver of those requirements.

``SEC. 260. EVALUATION.

    ``The Secretary shall provide for an evaluation of the program 
carried out under this part, which shall asses such issues as--
            ``(1) whether institutions participating in the eligible 
        partnerships are successful in preparing scholarship recipients 
        to teach to high State and local standards;
            ``(2) whether scholarship recipients are successful in 
        completing teacher preparation programs, becoming fully 
        certified teachers, and obtaining teaching positions in 
        underserved areas, and whether the recipients continue teaching 
        in those areas over a period of years;
            ``(3) the national impact of the program in assisting local 
        educational agencies in underserved areas to recruit, prepare, 
        and retain diverse, high-quality teachers in the areas in which 
        the agencies have the greatest needs;
            ``(4) the long-term impact of the grants on teacher 
        preparation programs conducted by institutions of higher 
        education participating in the eligible partnership and on the 
        institutions' relationships with their partner local 
        educational agencies and other members of the partnership; and
            ``(5) the relative effectiveness of different approaches 
        for preparing new teachers to teach in underserved areas, 
        including their effectiveness in preparing new teachers to 
        teach to high content and performance standards.

``SEC. 261. NATIONAL ACTIVITIES.

    ``The Secretary may reserve not more than 5 percent of the funds 
appropriated for this part for any fiscal year for--
            ``(1) peer review of applications;
            ``(2) conducting the evaluation required under section 260; 
        and
            ``(3) technical assistance.

``SEC. 262. AUTHORIZATION OF APPROPRIATIONS.

    ``There are authorized to be appropriated to carry out this part 
$37,000,000 for fiscal year 1999 and such sums as may be necessary for 
each of the 4 succeeding fiscal years.''.

                      TITLE III--INSTITUTIONAL AID

SEC. 301. TRANSFERS AND REDESIGNATIONS.

    (a) In General.--Title III (20 U.S.C. 1051 et seq.) is amended--
            (1) by redesignating part D as part F;
            (2) by redesignating sections 351, 352, 353, 354, 356, 357, 
        358, and 360 (20 U.S.C. 1066, 1067, 1068, 1069, 1069b, 1069c, 
        1069d, and 1069f) as sections 391, 392, 393, 394, 395, 396, 
        397, and 398, respectively;
            (3) by transferring part B of title VII (20 U.S.C. 1132c et 
        seq.) to title III to follow part C of title III (20 U.S.C. 
        1065 et seq.), and redesignating such part B as part D;
            (4) by redesignating sections 721 through 728 (20 U.S.C. 
        1132c and 1132c-7) as sections 341 through 348, respectively;
            (5) by transferring subparts 1 and 3 of part B of title X 
        (20 U.S.C. 1135b et seq. and 1135d et seq.) to title III to 
        follow part D of title III (as redesignated by paragraph (3)), 
        and redesignating such subpart 3 as subpart 2;
            (6) by inserting after part D of title III (as redesignated 
        by paragraph (3)) the following:

           ``PART E--MINORITY SCIENCE IMPROVEMENT PROGRAM'';

            (7) by redesignating sections 1021 through 1024 (20 U.S.C. 
        1135b and 1135b-3), and sections 1041, 1042, 1043, 1044, 1046, 
        and 1047 (20 U.S.C. 1135d, 1135d-1, 1135d-2, 1135d-3, 1135d-5, 
        and 1135d-6) as sections 351 through 354, and sections 361, 
        362, 363, 364, 365, and 366, respectively; and
            (8) by repealing section 366 (as redesignated by paragraph 
        (7)) (20 U.S.C. 1135d-6).
    (b) Conforming Amendment.--Section 361 (as redesignated by 
subsection (a)(7)) (20 U.S.C. 1135d) is amended--
            (1) in paragraph (1), by inserting ``and'' after the 
        semicolon;
            (2) in paragraph (2), by striking ``; and'' and inserting a 
        period; and
            (3) by striking paragraph (3).
    (c) Cross References.--Title III (20 U.S.C. 1051 et seq.) is 
amended--
            (1) in section 311(b) (20 U.S.C. 1057(b)), by striking 
        ``360(a)(1)'' and inserting ``398(a)(1)'';
            (2) in section 312 (20 U.S.C. 1058)--
                    (A) in subsection (b)(1)(B), by striking ``352(b)'' 
                and inserting ``392(b)''; and
                    (B) in subsection (c)(2), by striking ``352(a)'' 
                and inserting ``392(a)'';
            (3) in section 313(b) (20 U.S.C. 1059(b)), by striking 
        ``354(a)(1)'' and inserting ``394(a)(1)'';
            (4) in section 342 (as redesignated by subsection (a)(4)) 
        (20 U.S.C. 1132c-1)--
                    (A) in paragraph (3), by striking ``723(b)'' and 
                inserting ``343(b)'';
                    (B) in paragraph (4), by striking ``723'' and 
                inserting ``343'';
                    (C) in the matter preceding subparagraph (A) of 
                paragraph (5), by striking ``724(b)'' and inserting 
                ``344(b)'';
                    (D) in paragraph (8), by striking ``725(1)'' and 
                inserting ``345(1)''; and
                    (E) in paragraph (9), by striking ``727'' and 
                inserting ``347'';
            (5) in section 343 (as redesignated by subsection (a)(4)) 
        (20 U.S.C. 1132c-2)--
                    (A) in subsection (a), by striking ``724'' and 
                inserting ``344''; and
                    (B) in subsection (b)--
                            (i) in the matter preceding paragraph (1), 
                        by striking ``725(1) and 726'' and inserting 
                        ``345(1) and 346'';
                            (ii) in paragraph (10), by striking ``724'' 
                        and inserting ``344''; and
                            (iii) in subsection (d), by striking 
                        ``723(c)(1)'' and inserting ``343(c)(1)'';
            (6) in section 345(2) (as redesignated by subsection 
        (a)(4)) (20 U.S.C. 1132c-4(2)), by striking ``723'' and 
        inserting ``343'';
            (7) in section 348 (as redesignated by subsection (a)(4)) 
        (20 U.S.C. 1132c-7), by striking ``725(1)'' and inserting 
        ``345(1)'';
            (8) in section 353(a) (as redesignated by subsection 
        (a)(7)) (20 U.S.C. 1135b-2(a))--
                    (A) in paragraph (1), by striking ``1046(6)'' and 
                inserting ``365(6)'';
                    (B) in paragraph (2), by striking ``1046(7)'' and 
                inserting ``365(7)'';
                    (C) in paragraph (3), by striking ``1046(8)'' and 
                inserting ``365(8)''; and
                    (D) in paragraph (4), by striking ``1046(9)'' and 
                inserting ``365(9)'';
            (9) in section 361(1) (as redesignated by subsection 
        (a)(7)) (20 U.S.C. 1135d(1)), by striking ``1046(3)'' and 
        inserting ``365(3)'';
            (10) in section 362(a) (as redesignated by subsection 
        (a)(7)) (20 U.S.C. 1135d-1(a))--
                    (A) in the matter preceding paragraph (1), by 
                striking ``1041'' and inserting ``361''; and
                    (B) in paragraph (1), by striking ``1021(b)'' and 
                inserting ``351(b)''; and
            (11) in section 391(b)(6) (as redesignated by subsection 
        (a)(2)), by striking ``357'' and inserting ``396''.

SEC. 302. FINDINGS.

    Section 301(a) (20 U.S.C. 1051(a)) is amended--
            (1) by redesignating paragraphs (3) through (7) as 
        paragraphs (4) through (8), respectively; and
            (2) by inserting after paragraph (2) the following:
            ``(3) in order to be competitive and provide a high-quality 
        education for all, institutions of higher education should 
        improve their technological capacity and make effective use of 
        technology;''.

SEC. 303. STRENGTHENING INSTITUTIONS.

    (a) Grants.--Section 311 (20 U.S.C. 1057) is amended--
            (1) in subsection (b)(3)(D), by inserting ``, including 
        high technology equipment,'' after ``equipment''; and
            (2) by adding at the end the following:
    ``(c) Endowment Fund.--
            ``(1) In general.--An eligible institution may use not more 
        than 20 percent of the grant funds provided under this part to 
        establish or increase an endowment fund at such institution.
            ``(2) Matching requirement.--In order to be eligible to use 
        grant funds in accordance with paragraph (1), the eligible 
        institution shall provide matching funds, in an amount equal to 
        the Federal funds used in accordance with paragraph (1), for 
        the establishment or increase of the endowment fund.
            ``(3) Comparability.--The provisions of part C, regarding 
        the establishment or increase of an endowment fund, that the 
        Secretary determines are not inconsistent with this subsection, 
        shall apply to funds used under paragraph (1).''.
    (b) Duration of Grant.--Section 313 (20 U.S.C. 1059) is amended by 
adding at the end the following:
    ``(d) Wait-Out-Period.--Each eligible institution that received a 
grant under this part for a 5-year period shall not be eligible to 
receive an additional grant under this part until 2 years after the 
date on which the 5-year grant period terminates.
    (c) American Indian Tribally Controlled Colleges and 
Universities.--Section 316 (20 U.S.C. 1059c) is amended to read as 
follows:

``SEC. 316. AMERICAN INDIAN TRIBALLY CONTROLLED COLLEGES AND 
              UNIVERSITIES.

    ``(a) Program Authorized.--The Secretary shall provide grants and 
related assistance to American Indian Tribal Colleges and Universities 
to enable such institutions to improve and expand their capacity to 
serve Indian students.
    ``(b) Definitions.--In this section:
            ``(1) Indian.--The term `Indian' has the meaning given the 
        term in section 2 of the Tribally Controlled College or 
        University Assistance Act of 1978.
            ``(2) Indian tribe.--The term `Indian tribe' has the 
        meaning given the term in section 2 of the Tribally Controlled 
        College or University Assistance Act of 1978.
            ``(3) Tribal college or university.--The term `Tribal 
        College or University' has the meaning give the term `tribally 
        controlled college or university' in section 2 of the Tribally 
        Controlled College or University Assistance Act of 1978, and 
        includes an institution listed in the Equity in Educational 
        Land Grant Status Act of 1994.
            ``(4) Institution of higher education.--The term 
        `institution of higher education' means an institution of 
        higher education as defined in section 1201(a), except that 
        paragraph (2) of such section shall not apply.
    ``(c) Authorized Activities.--
            ``(1) In general.--Grants awarded under this section shall 
        be used by Tribal Colleges or Universities to assist such 
        institutions to plan, develop, undertake, and carry out 
        activities to improve and expand such institutions' capacity to 
        serve Indian students.
            ``(2) Examples of authorized activities.--The activities 
        described in paragraph (1) may include--
                    ``(A) purchase, rental, or lease of scientific or 
                laboratory equipment for educational purposes, 
                including instructional and research purposes;
                    ``(B) construction, maintenance, renovation, and 
                improvement in classrooms, libraries, laboratories, and 
                other instructional facilities, including purchase or 
                rental of telecommunications technology equipment or 
                services;
                    ``(C) support of faculty exchanges, faculty 
                development, and faculty fellowships to assist in 
                attaining advanced degrees in the faculty's field of 
                instruction;
                    ``(D) academic instruction in disciplines in which 
                American Indians are underrepresented;
                    ``(E) purchase of library books, periodicals, and 
                other educational materials, including 
                telecommunications program material;
                    ``(F) tutoring, counseling, and student service 
                programs designed to improve academic success;
                    ``(G) funds management, administrative management, 
                and acquisition of equipment for use in strengthening 
                funds management;
                    ``(H) joint use of facilities, such as laboratories 
                and libraries;
                    ``(I) establishing or improving a development 
                office to strengthen or improve contributions from 
                alumni and the private sector;
                    ``(J) establishing or enhancing a program of 
                teacher education designed to qualify students to teach 
                in elementary schools or secondary schools, with a 
                particular emphasis on teaching American Indian 
                children and youth, that shall include, as part of such 
                program, preparation for teacher certification;
                    ``(K) establishing community outreach programs that 
                encourage American Indian elementary school and 
                secondary school students to develop the academic 
                skills and the interest to pursue postsecondary 
                education;
                    ``(L) other activities proposed in the application 
                submitted pursuant to subsection (d) that--
                            ``(i) contribute to carrying out the 
                        activities described in subparagraphs (A) 
                        through (K); and
                            ``(ii) are approved by the Secretary as 
                        part of the review and acceptance of such 
                        application.
            ``(3) Endowment fund.--
                    ``(A) In general.--A Tribal College or University 
                may use not more than 20 percent of the grant funds 
                provided under this section to establish or increase an 
                endowment fund at the institution.
                    ``(B) Matching requirement.--In order to be 
                eligible to use grant funds in accordance with 
                subparagraph (A), the Tribal College or University 
                shall provide matching funds, in an amount equal to the 
                Federal funds used in accordance with subparagraph (A), 
                for the establishment or increase of the endowment 
                fund.
                    ``(C) Comparability.--The provisions of part C 
                regarding the establishment or increase of an endowment 
                fund, that the Secretary determines are not 
                inconsistent with this paragraph, shall apply to funds 
                used under subparagraph (A).
    ``(d) Application Process.--
            ``(1) Institutional eligibility.--To be eligible to receive 
        assistance under this section, a Tribal College or University 
        shall be an institution that--
                    ``(A) is an eligible institution under section 
                312(b);
                    ``(B) is eligible to receive assistance under the 
                Tribally Controlled College or University Assistance 
                Act of 1978; or
                    ``(C) is eligible to receive funds under the Equity 
                in Educational Land Grant Status Act of 1994.
            ``(2) Application.--Any Tribal College or University 
        desiring to receive assistance under this section shall submit 
        an application to the Secretary at such time, and in such 
        manner, as the Secretary may by regulation reasonably require. 
        Each such application shall include--
                    ``(A) a 5-year plan for improving the assistance 
                provided by the Tribal College or University to Indian 
                students, increasing the rates at which Indian 
                secondary school students enroll in higher education, 
                and increasing overall postsecondary retention rates 
                for Indian students; and
                    ``(B) such enrollment data and other information 
                and assurances as the Secretary may require to 
                demonstrate compliance with subparagraph (A) or (B) of 
                paragraph (1).
            ``(3) Special rule.--For the purposes of this part, no 
        Tribal College or University that is eligible for and receives 
        funds under this section may concurrently receive other funds 
        under this part or part B.''.
    (d) Alaska Native and Native Hawaiian-Serving Institutions.--Part A 
of title III (20 U.S.C. 1057 et seq.) is amended by adding at the end 
the following:

``SEC. 317. ALASKA NATIVE AND NATIVE HAWAIIAN-SERVING INSTITUTIONS.

    ``(a) Program Authorized.--The Secretary shall provide grants and 
related assistance to Alaska Native-serving institutions and Native 
Hawaiian-serving institutions to enable such institutions to improve 
and expand their capacity to serve Alaska Natives and Native Hawaiians.
    ``(b) Definitions.--For the purpose of this section--
            ``(1) the term `Alaska Native' has the meaning given the 
        term in section 9308 of the Elementary and Secondary Education 
        Act of 1965;
            ``(2) the term `Alaska Native-serving institution' means an 
        institution of higher education that--
                    ``(A) is an eligible institution under section 
                312(b); and
                    ``(B) at the time of application, has an enrollment 
                of undergraduate students that is at least 20 percent 
                Alaska Native students;
            ``(3) the term `Native Hawaiian' has the meaning given the 
        term in section 9212 of the Elementary and Secondary Education 
        Act of 1965; and
            ``(4) the term `Native Hawaiian-serving institution' means 
        an institution of higher education which--
                    ``(A) is an eligible institution under section 
                312(b); and
                    ``(B) at the time of application, has an enrollment 
                of undergraduate students that is at least 10 percent 
                Native Hawaiian students.
    ``(c) Authorized Activities.--
            ``(1) Types of activities authorized.--Grants awarded under 
        this section shall be used by Alaska Native-serving 
        institutions and Native Hawaiian-serving institutions to assist 
        such institutions to plan, develop, undertake, and carry out 
        programs.
            ``(2) Examples of authorized activities.--Such programs may 
        include--
                    ``(A) purchase, rental, or lease of scientific or 
                laboratory equipment for educational purposes, 
                including instructional and research purposes;
                    ``(B) renovation and improvement in classroom, 
                library, laboratory, and other instructional 
                facilities;
                    ``(C) support of faculty exchanges, and faculty 
                development and faculty fellowships to assist in 
                attaining advanced degrees in their field of 
                instruction;
                    ``(D) curriculum development and academic 
                instruction;
                    ``(E) purchase of library books, periodicals, 
                microfilm, and other educational materials;
                    ``(F) funds and administrative management, and 
                acquisition of equipment for use in strengthening funds 
                management;
                    ``(G) joint use of facilities such as laboratories 
                and libraries; and
                    ``(H) academic tutoring and counseling programs and 
                student support services.
    ``(d) Application Process.--
            ``(1) Institutional eligibility.--Each Alaska Native-
        serving institution and Native Hawaiian-serving institution 
        desiring to receive assistance under this section shall submit 
        to the Secretary such enrollment data as may be necessary to 
        demonstrate that it is an Alaska Native-serving institution or 
        a Native Hawaiian-serving institution as defined in subsection 
        (b), along with such other information and data as the 
        Secretary may by regulation require.
            ``(2) Applications.--Any institution which is determined by 
        the Secretary to be an Alaska Native-serving institution or a 
        Native Hawaiian-serving institution may submit an application 
        for assistance under this section to the Secretary. Such 
        application shall include--
                    ``(A) a 5-year plan for improving the assistance 
                provided by the Alaska Native-serving institution or 
                the Native Hawaiian-serving institution to Alaska 
                Native or Native Hawaiian students; and
                    ``(B) such other information and assurance as the 
                Secretary may require.
    ``(e) Special Rule.--For the purposes of this section, no Alaska 
Native-serving institution or Native Hawaiian-serving institution which 
is eligible for and receives funds under this section may concurrently 
receive other funds under this part or part B.''.

SEC. 304. STRENGTHENING HBCU'S.

    (a) Grants.--Section 323 (20 U.S.C. 1062) is amended--
            (1) by redesignating subsection (b) as subsection (c); and
            (2) by inserting after subsection (a) the following:
    ``(b) Endowment Fund.--
            ``(1) In general.--An institution may use not more than 20 
        percent of the grant funds provided under this part to 
        establish or increase an endowment fund at the institution.
            ``(2) Matching requirement.--In order to be eligible to use 
        grant funds in accordance with paragraph (1), the eligible 
        institution shall provide matching funds, in an amount equal to 
        the Federal funds used in accordance with paragraph (1), for 
        the establishment or increase of the endowment fund.
            ``(3) Comparability.--The provisions of part C regarding 
        the establishment or increase of an endowment fund, that the 
        Secretary determines are not inconsistent with this subsection, 
        shall apply to funds used under paragraph (1).''.
    (b) Professional or Graduate Institutions.--Section 326 (20 U.S.C. 
1063b) is amended--
            (1) in subsection (a)--
                    (A) in paragraph (2), by striking ``$500,000'' and 
                inserting ``$1,000,000''; and
                    (B) by adding at the end of paragraph (2) the 
                following: ``If a grant of less than $1,000,000 is made 
                under this section, matching funds provided from non-
                Federal sources are not required. If a grant equal to 
                or in excess of $1,000,000 is made under this section, 
                matching funds provided from non-Federal sources are 
                required only with respect to the amount of the grant 
                that exceeds $1,000,000.''; and
            (2) in subsection (d)(2), by striking ``$500,000'' and 
        inserting ``$1,000,000''.
            (3) in subsection (e)(1)--
                    (A) in subparagraph (E), by inserting ``, and any 
                Tuskegee University qualified graduate program'' before 
                the semicolon;
                    (B) in subparagraph (F), by inserting ``, and any 
                Xavier University qualified graduate program'' before 
                the semicolon;
                    (C) in subparagraph (G), by inserting ``, and any 
                Southern University qualified graduate program'' before 
                the semicolon;
                    (D) in subparagraph (H), by inserting ``, and any 
                Texas Southern University qualified graduate program'' 
                before the semicolon;
                    (E) in subparagraph (I), by inserting ``, and any 
                Florida A&M University qualified graduate program'' 
                before the semicolon;
                    (F) in subparagraph (J), by inserting ``, and any 
                North Carolina Central University qualified graduate 
                program'' before the semicolon;
                    (G) in subparagraph (O), by striking ``and'' after 
                the semicolon.
                    (H) in subparagraph (P)--
                            (i) by inserting ``University'' after 
                        ``State''; and
                            (ii) by striking the period and inserting a 
                        semicolon; and
                    (I) by adding at the end the following:
                    ``(Q) Norfolk State University qualified graduate 
                program; and
                    ``(R) Tennessee State University qualified graduate 
                program.'';
            (4) in subsection (f)--
                    (A) in paragraph (1), by striking ``$12,000,000'' 
                and inserting ``$15,000,000'';
                    (B) in paragraph (2)--
                            (i) in the matter preceding subparagraph 
                        (A), by striking ``$12,000,000'' and inserting 
                        ``$15,000,000 but not in excess of 
                        $28,000,000'';
                            (ii) in subparagraph (A), by striking 
                        ``$500,000'' and inserting ``$1,000,000''; and
                            (iii) in subparagraph (B)--
                                    (I) by striking ``(A) through (P)'' 
                                and inserting ``(Q) and (R)''; and
                                    (II) by striking the period and 
                                inserting ``; and
                    (C) by adding at the end the following:
            ``(3) any amount appropriated in excess of $28,000,000 
        shall be available for the purpose of making grants to 
        institutions or programs described in subparagraphs (A) through 
        (R), on a competitive basis and through a peer review process 
        that takes into consideration--
                    ``(A) the ability of the institution to match 
                Federal funds with non-Federal funds;
                    ``(B) the number of students enrolled in the 
                institution or program for which funds are sought;
                    ``(C) the percentage of students enrolled in the 
                institution or program for which funds are sought who 
                are eligible for need-based student aid;
                    ``(D) the percentage of students enrolled in the 
                institution or program for which funds are sought who 
                complete their degrees within a reasonable period of 
                time as determined by the Secretary; and
                    ``(E) the quality of the proposal.''; and
            (5) by adding at the end the following:
    ``(g) Special Rule.--No institution or program described in 
subsection (e)(1) that received a grant under this section for fiscal 
year 1998 and that is eligible to receive a grant under this section in 
a subsequent fiscal year shall receive a grant under this section in 
any subsequent fiscal year in an amount that is less than the grant 
amount received for fiscal year 1996 or 1997, whichever is greater, 
unless--
            ``(1) the amount appropriated for the subsequent fiscal 
        year is not sufficient to provide grants under this section to 
        all such institutions or programs; or
            ``(2) the institution or program cannot provide sufficient 
        matching funds to meet the requirements of this section.''.

SEC. 305. ENDOWMENT CHALLENGE GRANTS.

    Paragraph (2) of section 331(b) (20 U.S.C. 1065(b)) is amended by 
striking subparagraphs (B) and (C) and inserting the following:
    ``(B) The Secretary may make a grant under this part to an eligible 
institution in any fiscal year if the institution--
            ``(i) applies for a grant in an amount not exceeding 
        $500,000; and
            ``(ii) has deposited in the eligible institution's 
        endowment fund established under this section an amount which 
        is equal to \1/2\ of the amount of such grant.
    ``(C) An eligible institution of higher education that is awarded a 
grant under subparagraph (B) shall not be eligible to receive an 
additional grant under subparagraph (B) until 10 years after the date 
on which the grant period terminates.''.

SEC. 306. HBCU CAPITAL FINANCING.

    (a) Definition.--Section 342(5) (as redesignated by section 
301(a)(4)) (20 U.S.C. 1132c-1(5)) is amended--
            (1) by redesignating subparagraphs (B), (C), and (D) as 
        subparagraphs (C), (F), and (G);
            (2) by inserting after subparagraph (A) the following:
                    ``(B) a facility for the administration of an 
                educational program, or a student center or student 
                union, except that not more than 5 percent of the loan 
                proceeds provided under this part may be used for the 
                facility, center or union if the facility, center or 
                union is owned, leased, managed, or operated by a 
                private business, that, in return for such use, makes a 
                payment to the eligible institution;'';
            (3) by inserting after subparagraph (C) (as redesignated by 
        paragraph (1)) the following:
                    ``(D) a maintenance, storage, or utility facility 
                that is essential to the operation of a facility, a 
                library, a dormitory, equipment, instrumentation, a 
                fixture, real property or an interest therein, 
                described in this paragraph;
                    ``(E) a facility designed to provide primarily 
                outpatient health care for students or faculty;''; and
            (4) in subparagraph (G) (as redesignated by paragraph (2)), 
        by striking ``(C)'' and inserting ``(F)''.
    (b) Full Faith and Credit.--Section 343 (as redesignated by section 
301(a)(4)) (20 U.S.C. 1132c-2) is amended by adding at the end the 
following:
    ``(e) Notwithstanding any other provision of law, the Secretary may 
sell a qualified bond guaranteed under this part to any party that 
offers terms that the Secretary determines are in the best interest of 
the eligible institution.''.

SEC. 307. MINORITY SCIENCE AND ENGINEERING IMPROVEMENT PROGRAM.

    (a) Minority Science Improvement Program Findings.--Subpart 1 of 
part E of title III (as redesignated by paragraphs (6) and (7) of 
section 301) (20 U.S.C. 1135b et seq.) is amended by inserting after 
the subpart heading the following:

``SEC. 350. FINDINGS.

    ``Congress makes the following findings:
            ``(1) It is incumbent on the Federal Government to support 
        the technological and economic competitiveness of the United 
        States by improving and expanding the scientific and 
        technological capacity of the United States. More and better 
        prepared scientists, engineers, and technical experts are 
        needed to improve and expand such capacity.
            ``(2) As the Nation's population becomes more diverse, it 
        is important that the educational and training needs of all 
        Americans are met. Underrepresentation of minorities in science 
        and technological fields diminishes our Nation's 
        competitiveness by impairing the quantity of well prepared 
        scientists, engineers, and technical experts in these fields.
            ``(3) Despite significant limitations in resources, 
        minority institutions provide an important educational 
        opportunity for minority students, particularly in science and 
        engineering fields. Aid to minority institutions is a good way 
        to address the underrepresentation of minorities in science and 
        technological fields.
            ``(4) There is a strong Federal interest in improving 
        science and engineering programs at minority institutions as 
        such programs lag behind in program offerings and in student 
        enrollment compared to such programs at other institutions of 
        higher education.''.
    (b) Definitions.--Section 365(4) (as redesignated by section 
301(a)(7)) (20 U.S.C. 1135d-5(4)) is amended by inserting 
``behavioral,'' after ``physical,''.

SEC. 308. GENERAL PROVISIONS.

    (a) Applications.--Paragraph (1) of section 391(b) (as redesignated 
by section 301(a)(2)) (20 U.S.C. 1066(b)) is amended by inserting ``, D 
or E'' after ``part C''.
    (b) Application Review Process.--Section 393 (as redesignated by 
section 301(a)(2)) (20 U.S.C. 1068) is amended by adding at the end the 
following:
    ``(d) Exclusion.--The provisions of this section shall not apply to 
applications submitted under part D.''.
    (c) Waivers.--Paragraph (2) of section 395(b) (as redesignated by 
section 301(a)(2)) (20 U.S.C. 1069b(b)) is amended by striking ``title 
IV, VII, or VIII'' and inserting ``part D or title IV''.
    (d) Authorization of Appropriations.--Section 398(a) (as 
redesignated by section 301(a)(2)) (20 U.S.C. 1069f) is amended--
            (1) in paragraph (1)--
                    (A) in subparagraph (A), by striking ``1993'' and 
                inserting ``1999'';
                    (B) in subparagraph (B)--
                            (i) in clause (i), by striking 
                        ``$45,000,000 for fiscal year 1993'' and 
                        inserting ``$5,000,000 for fiscal year 1999'';
                            (ii) by striking clause (ii); and
                            (iii) by striking ``(B)(i) There'' and 
                        inserting ``(B) There''; and
                    (C) by adding at the end the following:
            ``(C) There are authorized to be appropriated to carry out 
        section 317, $5,000,000 for fiscal year 1999 and such sums as 
        may be necessary for each of the 4 succeeding fiscal years.'';
            (2) in paragraph (2)--
                    (A) in subparagraph (A), by striking ``1993'' and 
                inserting ``1999''; and
                    (B) in subparagraph (B), by striking ``$20,000,000 
                for fiscal year 1993'' and inserting ``$30,000,000 for 
                fiscal year 1999'';
            (3) in paragraph (3), by striking ``$50,000,000 for fiscal 
        year 1993'' and inserting ``$10,000,000 for fiscal year 1999''; 
        and
            (4) by adding at the end the following:
            ``(4) Part d.--There are authorized to be appropriated to 
        carry out part D, $110,000 for fiscal year 1999, and such sums 
        as may be necessary for each of the 4 succeeding fiscal years.
            ``(5) Part e.--There are authorized to be appropriated to 
        carry out part E, $10,000,000 for fiscal year 1999, and such 
        sums as may be necessary for each of the 4 succeeding fiscal 
        years.''.

                      TITLE IV--STUDENT ASSISTANCE

  PART A--GRANTS TO STUDENTS IN ATTENDANCE AT INSTITUTIONS OF HIGHER 
                               EDUCATION

SEC. 411. REPEALS AND REDESIGNATIONS.

    Part A of title IV (20 U.S.C. 1070 et seq.) is amended--
            (1) in subpart 2 (20 U.S.C. 1070a-11), by repealing 
        chapters 3 through 8 (20 U.S.C. 1070a-31 et seq. and 1070a-81 
        et seq.); and
            (2) by repealing subpart 8 (20 U.S.C. 1070f).

SEC. 412. FEDERAL PELL GRANTS.

    (a) Amendment to Subpart Heading.--The heading for subpart 1 of 
part A of title IV (20 U.S.C. 1070a et seq.) is amended by striking 
``Basic Educational Opportunity Grants'' and inserting ``Federal Pell 
Grants''.
    (b) Federal Pell Grants.--Section 401 (20 U.S.C. 1070a) is 
amended--
            (1) in the section heading, by striking ``basic educational 
        opportunity grants'' and inserting ``federal pell grants'';
            (2) in subsection (a)(1)--
                    (A) in the first sentence, by striking ``shall, 
                during the period beginning July 1, 1972, and ending 
                September 30, 1998,'' and inserting ``, for each fiscal 
                year through fiscal year 2004, shall''; and
                    (B) in the second sentence, by inserting ``until 
                such time as the Secretary determines and publishes in 
                the Federal Register with an opportunity for comment, 
                an alternative payment system that provides payments to 
                institutions in an accurate and timely manner,'' after 
                ``pay eligible students'';
            (3) in subsection (b)--
                    (A) in paragraph (2)(A), by striking clauses (i) 
                through (v), and inserting the following:
                            ``(i) $5,000 for academic year 1999-2000;
                            ``(ii) $5,200 for academic year 2000-2001;
                            ``(iii) $5,400 for academic year 2001-2002;
                            ``(iv) $5,600 for academic year 2002-2003; 
                        and
                            ``(v) $5,800 for academic year 2003-
                        2004.'';
                    (B) by amending paragraph (3) to read as follows:
            ``(3) For any academic year for which an appropriation Act 
        provides a maximum basic grant in an amount in excess of 
        $2,400, the amount of a student's basic grant shall equal 
        $2,400 plus--
                    ``(A) one-half of the amount by which such maximum 
                basic grant exceeds $2,400; plus
                    ``(B) the lesser of--
                            ``(i) the remaining one-half of such 
                        excess; or
                            ``(ii) the sum of the student's tuition, 
                        fees, and if the student has dependent care 
                        expenses (as described in section 472(8) or 
                        disability-related expenses (as described in 
                        section 472(9)), an allowance determined by the 
                        institution for such expenses.'';
                    (C) in paragraph (5), by striking ``$400, except'' 
                and all that follows through ``grant of $400'' and 
                insert ``$200''; and
                    (D) in paragraph (6)--
                            (i) by redesignating subparagraphs (A) and 
                        (B) as clauses (i) and (ii), respectively;
                            (ii) by inserting ``(A)'' after the 
                        paragraph designation; and
                            (iii) by adding at the end the following:
                    ``(B) The Secretary shall promulgate regulations 
                implementing this paragraph.''; and
            (4) in subsection (c)--
                    (A) by amending paragraph (1) to read as follows: 
                ``(1)(A) Except as provided in subparagraph (B), the 
                period during which a student may receive a basic grant 
                shall be the period, required for the completion of the 
                first undergraduate baccalaureate course of study 
                pursued by the student at the institution at which the 
                student is in attendance, that does not exceed 150 
                percent of the period normally required by a full-time 
                student (or the equivalent period, in the case of a 
                part-time student) to complete the course of study at 
                the institution, as determined by the institution.
                    ``(B)(i) A student may receive basic grants under 
                this subpart for a period that exceeds the period 
                described in subparagraph (A) or clause (ii) to the 
                extent the institution in which the student is enrolled 
                determines necessary to accommodate the rights of 
                students with disabilities under section 504 of the 
                Rehabilitation Act of 1973.
                    ``(ii) Notwithstanding subsection (a)(1), the 
                Secretary may allow, on a case-by-case basis, a student 
                to receive a basic grant if the student--
                            ``(I) is carrying at least \1/2\ the normal 
                        full-time work load for the course of study the 
                        student is pursuing, as determined by the 
                        institution of higher education; and
                            ``(II) is enrolled or accepted for 
                        enrollment in a postbaccalaureate program that 
                        does not lead to a graduate degree, and in 
                        courses required by a State in order for the 
                        student to receive a professional certification 
                        or licensing credential that is required for 
                        employment as a teacher in an elementary school 
                        or secondary school in that State,
                except that this subparagraph shall not apply to a 
                student who is enrolled in an institution of higher 
                education that offers a baccalaureate degree in 
                education.''; and
                    (B) in paragraph (2)--
                            (i) by striking ``Nothing'' and inserting 
                        ``(A) Except as provided in subparagraph (B), 
                        nothing'';
                            (ii) by striking ``or, in the case'' and 
                        all that follows through ``or skills''; and
                            (iii) by adding at the end the following:
                    ``(B)(i) A student may receive a basic grant to 
                attend English language instruction that is a separate 
                course of instruction only if--
                            ``(I) not less than a minimum percentage of 
                        the students enrolled in the course complete 
                        the course;
                            ``(II) students enrolled in the course are 
                        required to take an independently administered 
                        standardized test of English language 
                        proficiency upon completion of the course; and
                            ``(III) not less than a minimum percentage 
                        of the students enrolled in the course achieve 
                        a passing score on that test.
                    ``(ii) The Secretary shall promulgate regulations 
                that specify the minimum percentage of students who 
                complete the course of instruction, 1 or more 
                standardized tests of English proficiency, the minimum 
                percentage of students who must achieve a passing score 
                on the tests, and such other requirements as the 
                Secretary determines are necessary to implement clause 
                (i).''.

SEC. 413. TRIO PROGRAMS.

    (a) Program Authority.--Section 402A (20 U.S.C. 1070a-11) is 
amended--
            (1) in subsection (b)(3)--
                    (A) in subparagraph (A), by striking ``$170,000 for 
                fiscal year 1993'' and inserting ``$190,000 for each 
                fiscal year'';
                    (B) in subparagraph (B), by striking ``$180,000 for 
                fiscal year 1994'' and inserting ``$200,000 for each 
                fiscal year''; and
                    (C) in subparagraph (C), by striking ``$190,000 for 
                fiscal year 1995'' and inserting ``$210,000 for each 
                fiscal year'';
            (2) in subsection (c)(6), by amending the last sentence to 
        read as follows: ``The Secretary shall permit a Director of a 
        program assisted under this chapter to also administer 1 or 
        more additional programs for disadvantaged students operated by 
        the sponsoring entity regardless of the funding source of such 
        additional program.'';
            (3) in subsection (f), by striking ``$650,000,000 for 
        fiscal year 1993'' and inserting ``$700,000,000 for fiscal year 
        1999''; and
            (4) in subsection (g), by adding at the end the following:
            ``(4) Waiver.--The Secretary may waive the service 
        requirements in subparagraph (A) or (B) of paragraph (3) if the 
        Secretary determines the application of the service 
        requirements to a veteran will defeat the purpose of a program 
        under this chapter.''.
    (b) Talent Search.--(1) Amendment to section 402b(b)(5).--Section 
402B(b)(5) (20 U.S.C. 1070a-12(b)(5)) is amended by inserting ``, or 
activities designed to acquaint individuals from disadvantaged 
backgrounds with careers in which the individuals are particularly 
underrepresented'' before the semicolon.
    (2) Amendment to section 402b(b)(9).--Section 402B(b)(9) (20 U.S.C. 
1070a-12(b)(9)) is amended by inserting ``or counselors'' after 
``teachers''.
    (c) Upward Bound.--Section 402C (20 U.S.C. 1070a-13) is amended--
            (1) in subsection (b)--
                    (A) in paragraph (9)--
                            (i) by inserting ``or counselors'' after 
                        ``teachers''; and
                            (ii) by striking ``and'' after the 
                        semicolon;
                    (B) by redesignating paragraph (10) as paragraph 
                (11);
                    (C) by inserting after paragraph (9) the following:
            ``(10) work-study positions where youth participating in 
        the project are exposed to careers requiring a postsecondary 
        degree; and''; and
                    (D) in paragraph (11) (as redesignated by 
                subparagraph (B)), by striking ``(9)'' and inserting 
                ``(10)''; and
            (2) in subsection (e), by striking ``and not in excess of 
        $40 per month during the remaining period of the year.'' and 
        inserting ``except that youth participating in a work-study 
        position under subsection (b)(10) may be paid a stipend of $300 
        per month during June, July, and August. Youths participating 
        in a project proposed to be carried out under any application 
        may be paid stipends not in excess of $40 per month during the 
        remaining period of the year.''.
    (d) Student Support Services.--Paragraph (6) of section 402D(c) (20 
U.S.C. 1070a-14(c)(6)) is amended to read as follows:
            ``(6) consider, in addition to such other criteria as the 
        Secretary may prescribe, the institution's effort, and where 
        applicable past history, in--
                    ``(A) providing sufficient financial assistance to 
                meet the full financial need of each student at the 
                institution; and
                    ``(B) maintaining the loan burden of each such 
                student at a manageable level.''.
    (e) Staff Development Activities.--Section 402G(a) (20 U.S.C. 
1070a-17(a)) is amended by inserting ``participating in,'' after 
``leadership personnel employed in,''.
    (f) Evaluation and Dissemination.--Section 402H (20 U.S.C. 1070a-
18) is amended to read as follows:

``SEC. 402H. EVALUATIONS AND GRANTS FOR PROJECT IMPROVEMENT AND 
              DISSEMINATION PARTNERSHIP PROJECTS.

    ``(a) Evaluations.--
            ``(1) In general.--For the purpose of improving the 
        effectiveness of the programs and projects assisted under this 
        subpart, the Secretary may make grants to or enter into 
        contracts with institutions of higher education and other 
        public and private institutions and organizations to evaluate 
        the effectiveness of the programs and projects assisted under 
        this subpart.
            ``(2) Practices.--The evaluations described in paragraph 
        (1) shall identify institutional, community, and program or 
        project practices that are particularly effective in enhancing 
        the access of low-income individuals and first-generation 
        college students to postsecondary education, the preparation of 
        the individuals and students for postsecondary education, and 
        the success of the individuals and students in postsecondary 
        education.
    ``(b) Grants.--The Secretary may award grants to institutions of 
higher education or other private and public institutions and 
organizations, that are carrying out a program or project assisted 
under this subpart prior to the date of enactment of the Higher 
Education Amendments of 1998, to enable the institutions and 
organizations to expand and leverage the success of such programs or 
projects by working in partnership with other institutions, community-
based organizations, or combinations of such institutions and 
organizations, that are not receiving assistance under this subpart and 
are serving low-income students and first generation college students, 
in order to--
            ``(1) disseminate and replicate best practices of programs 
        or projects assisted under this subpart; and
            ``(2) provide technical assistance regarding programs and 
        projects assisted under this subpart.
    ``(c) Results.--In order to improve overall program or project 
effectiveness, the results of evaluations and grants described in this 
section shall be disseminated by the Secretary to similar programs or 
projects assisted under this subpart, as well as other individuals 
concerned with postsecondary access for and retention of low-income 
individuals and first-generation college students.''.

SEC. 414. CONNECTIONS PROGRAM.

    Chapter 2 of subpart 2 of part A of title IV (20 U.S.C. 1070a-21 et 
seq.) is amended to read as follows:

                    ``CHAPTER 2--CONNECTIONS PROGRAM

``SEC. 404A. EARLY INTERVENTION AND COLLEGE AWARENESS PROGRAM 
              AUTHORIZED.

    ``(a) In General.--The Secretary is authorized, in accordance with 
the requirements of this chapter, to establish a program that--
            ``(1) encourages eligible entities to provide or maintain a 
        guarantee to eligible low-income students who obtain a 
        secondary school diploma (or its recognized equivalent), of the 
        financial assistance necessary to permit the students to attend 
        an institution of higher education; and
            ``(2) supports eligible entities in providing--
                    ``(A) additional counseling, mentoring, academic 
                support, outreach, and supportive services to 
                elementary, middle, and secondary school students who 
                are at risk of dropping out of school; and
                    ``(B) information to students and their parents 
                about the advantages of obtaining a postsecondary 
                education and their college financing options.

    ``(b) Awards.--
            ``(1) In general.--The Secretary may award grants to 
        eligible entities to carry out the program authorized under 
        subsection (a).
            ``(2) Priority.--In making the awards described in 
        paragraph (1), the Secretary shall--
                    ``(A) give priority to eligible entities that--
                            ``(i) carried out, prior to the date of 
                        enactment of the Higher Education Amendments of 
                        1998, successful educational opportunity 
                        programs; and
                            ``(ii) have a prior, demonstrated 
                        commitment to early intervention leading to 
                        college access through collaboration and 
                        replication of successful strategies; and
                    ``(B) ensure that students served under this 
                chapter prior to the date of enactment of the Higher 
                Education Amendments of 1998 continue to receive 
                service through the completion of secondary school.
    ``(c) Definitions.--For the purposes of this chapter, the term 
`eligible entity' means--
            ``(1) a State; or
            ``(2) a partnership consisting of--
                    ``(A) 1 or more local educational agencies acting 
                on behalf of--
                            ``(i) 1 or more public schools; and
                            ``(ii) the public secondary schools that 
                        students from the schools described in clause 
                        (i) would normally attend;
                    ``(B) 1 or more degree granting institutions of 
                higher education; and
                    ``(C) at least 2 community organizations or 
                entities, such as businesses, professional 
                associations, community-based organizations, 
                philanthropic organizations, State agencies, 
                institutions or agencies sponsoring programs authorized 
                under subpart 4, or other public or private agencies or 
                organizations.
    ``(d) Coordination.--Each eligible entity shall ensure that the 
activities assisted under this chapter are, to the extent practicable, 
coordinated with, and complement and enhance--
            ``(1) services under this chapter provided by other 
        eligible entities serving the same school district or State; 
        and
            ``(2) related services under other Federal or non-Federal 
        programs.

``SEC. 404B. ELIGIBILITY ENTITY PLANS.

    ``(a) Plan Required for Eligibility.--
            ``(1) In general.--In order for an eligible entity to 
        qualify for a grant under this chapter, the eligible entity 
        shall submit to the Secretary a plan for carrying out the 
        program under this chapter. Such plan shall provide for the 
        conduct of both a scholarship component in accordance with 
        section 404D and an early intervention component in accordance 
        with section 404C.
            ``(2) Contents.--Each plan submitted pursuant to paragraph 
        (1) shall be in such form, contain or be accompanied by such 
        information or assurances, and be submitted at such time as the 
        Secretary may require by regulation. Each such plan shall--
                    ``(A) describe the activities for which assistance 
                under this chapter is sought; and
                    ``(B) provide such additional assurances as the 
                Secretary determines necessary to ensure compliance 
                with the requirements of this chapter.
    ``(b) Matching Requirement.--
            ``(1) In general.--The Secretary shall not approve a plan 
        submitted under subsection (a) unless such plan--
                    ``(A) provides that the eligible entity will 
                provide, from State, local, institutional, or private 
                funds, not less than \1/2\ the cost of the program, 
                which matching funds may be provided in cash or in 
                kind;
                    ``(B) specifies the methods by which such share of 
                the costs will be paid; and
                    ``(C) includes provisions designed to ensure that 
                funds provided under this chapter shall supplement and 
                not supplant funds expended for existing programs.
            ``(2) Special rule.--The Secretary may change the share of 
        the costs required to be provided under paragraph (1)(A) for 
        eligible entities defined in section 402A(c)(2).
    ``(c) Methods for Complying With Matching Requirement.--An eligible 
entity may count toward the share of the costs required by subsection 
(b)(1)(A)--
            ``(1) the amount of the grants paid to students from State, 
        local, institutional, or private funds under this chapter;
            ``(2) the amount of tuition, fees, room or board waived or 
        reduced for recipients of grants under this chapter; and
            ``(3) the amount expended on documented, targeted, long-
        term mentoring and counseling provided by volunteers or paid 
        staff of nonschool organizations, including businesses, 
        religious organizations, community groups, postsecondary 
        educational institutions, nonprofit and philanthropic 
        organizations, and other organizations.
    ``(d) Cohort Approach.--
            ``(1) In general.--The Secretary may require that eligible 
        entities--
                    ``(A) provide services under this chapter to at 
                least 1 grade level of students, beginning not later 
                than 7th grade, in a participating public school that 
                has a 7th grade and in which at least 50 percent of the 
                students enrolled are eligible for free or reduced-
                price lunch (or, if an eligible entity determines that 
                it would promote the effectiveness of a project, an 
                entire grade level of students, beginning not later 
                than the 7th grade, who reside in public housing as 
                defined in section 3(b)(1) of the United States Housing 
                Act of 1937); and
                    ``(B) ensure that the services are provided through 
                the 12th grade to students in the participating grade 
                level.
            ``(2) Coordination requirement.--In order for the Secretary 
        to require the cohort approach described in paragraph (1), the 
        Secretary shall, where applicable, ensure that the cohort 
        approach is done in coordination and collaboration with 
        existing early intervention programs and does not duplicate the 
        services already provided to a school or community.

``SEC. 404C. EARLY INTERVENTION.

    ``(a) Services.--
            ``(1) In order to receive a grant under this chapter, an 
        eligible entity shall demonstrate to the satisfaction of the 
        Secretary, in the plan submitted under section 404B, that the 
        eligible entity will provide comprehensive mentoring, 
        counseling, outreach, and supportive services to students 
        participating in programs under this chapter who are enrolled 
        in any of the grades preschool through grade 12. Such 
        counseling shall include financial aid counseling that 
        provides--
                    ``(A) information regarding the opportunities for 
                financial assistance under this title; and
                    ``(B) activities or information regarding--
                            ``(i) fostering and improving parent 
                        involvement in promoting postsecondary 
                        information regarding the advantages of a 
                        college education, academic admission 
                        requirements, and the need to take college 
                        preparation courses;
                            ``(ii) admissions and achievement tests; 
                        and
                            ``(iii) application procedures.
                    ``(2) Methods.--The eligible entity shall 
                demonstrate in such plan, pursuant to regulations of 
                the Secretary, the methods by which the eligible entity 
                will target services on priority students.
    ``(b) Uses of Funds.--
            ``(1) In general.--The Secretary shall, by regulation, 
        establish criteria for determining whether comprehensive 
        mentoring, counseling, outreach, and supportive services 
        programs may be used to meet the requirements of subsection 
        (a).
            ``(2) Allowable providers.--For those eligible entities 
        defined in section 404A(c)(1), the activities required by 
        subsection (a) may be provided by service providers such as 
        community-based organizations, schools, institutions of higher 
        education, public and private agencies, nonprofit and 
        philanthropic organizations, businesses, institutions and 
        agencies sponsoring programs authorized under subpart 4 of this 
        part, and other organizations the State deems appropriate.
            ``(3) Permissible activities.--Examples of activities that 
        meet the requirements of subsection (a) include the following:
                    ``(A) Providing eligible students in preschool 
                through grade 12 with a continuing system of mentoring 
                and advising that--
                            ``(i) is coordinated with the Federal and 
                        State community service initiatives; and
                            ``(ii) may include such support services as 
                        after school and summer tutoring, assistance in 
                        obtaining summer jobs, career mentoring, and 
                        academic counseling.
                    ``(B) Requiring each student to enter into an 
                agreement under which the student agrees to achieve 
                certain academic milestones, such as completing a 
                prescribed set of courses and maintaining satisfactory 
                academic progress described in section 484(c), in 
                exchange for receiving tuition assistance for a period 
                of time to be established by each State.
                    ``(C) Activities designed to ensure secondary 
                school completion and college enrollment of at-risk 
                children, including identification of at-risk children, 
                after school and summer tutoring, assistance in 
                obtaining summer jobs, academic counseling, volunteer 
                and parent involvement, providing former or current 
                scholarship recipients as mentor or peer counselors, 
                skills assessment, providing access to rigorous core 
                courses that reflect challenging academic standards, 
                personal counseling, family counseling and home visits, 
                staff development, and programs and activities 
                described in this subparagraph that are specially 
                designed for students of limited English proficiency.
                    ``(D) Summer programs for individuals planning to 
                attend an institution of higher education in the next 
                academic year that--
                            ``(i) are carried out at an institution of 
                        higher education that also has programs of 
                        academic year supportive services for 
                        disadvantaged students through projects 
                        authorized under section 402D or through 
                        comparable projects funded by the State or 
                        other sources;
                            ``(ii) provide for the participation of the 
                        individuals who are eligible for assistance 
                        under section 402D or who are eligible for 
                        comparable programs funded by the State;
                            ``(iii)(I) provide summer instruction in 
                        remedial, developmental or supportive courses;
                            ``(II) provide such summer services as 
                        counseling, tutoring, or orientation; and
                            ``(III) provide grant aid to the 
                        individuals to cover the individuals' summer 
                        costs for books, supplies, living costs, and 
                        personal expenses; and
                            ``(iv) provide the individuals with 
                        financial aid during each academic year the 
                        individuals are enrolled at the participating 
                        institution after the summer program.
                    ``(E) Requiring eligible students to meet other 
                standards or requirements as the State determines 
                necessary to meet the purposes of this section.
    ``(c) Priority Students.--In administering the early intervention 
component, the eligible entity shall treat as priority students any 
student in preschool through grade 12 who is eligible--
            ``(1) to be counted under section 1005(c) of the Elementary 
        and Secondary Education Act of 1965;
            ``(2) for free or reduced price meals pursuant to the 
        National School Lunch Act; or
            ``(3) for assistance pursuant to part A of title IV of the 
        Social Security Act.

``SEC. 404D. SCHOLARSHIP COMPONENT.

    ``(a) In General.--
            ``(1) States.--In order to receive a grant under this 
        chapter, an eligible entity described in section 404A(c)(1) 
        shall establish or maintain a financial assistance program that 
        awards grants to students in accordance with the requirements 
        of this section. The Secretary shall encourage the eligible 
        entity to ensure that the tuition assistance provided pursuant 
        to this section is available to an eligible student for use at 
        any institution of higher education.
            ``(2) Partnerships.--An eligible entity described in 
        section 404A(c)(2) may award scholarships to eligible students.
    ``(b) Grant Amounts.--The maximum amount of the grant that an 
eligible student shall be eligible to receive under this section shall 
be established by the State. The minimum amount of the grant for each 
fiscal year shall not be less than the lesser of--
            ``(1) 75 percent of the average cost of attendance for an 
        in-State student, in a 4-year program of instruction, at public 
        institutions of higher education in such State, as determined 
        in accordance with regulations prescribed by the Secretary; or
            ``(2) the maximum Federal Pell Grant funded under section 
        401 for such fiscal year.
    ``(c) Relation to Other Assistance.--Tuition assistance provided 
under this chapter shall not be considered for the purpose of awarding 
Federal grant assistance under this title, except that in no case shall 
the total amount of student financial assistance awarded to a student 
under this title exceed such student's total cost of attendance.
    ``(d) Eligible Students.--A student eligible for assistance under 
this section is a student who--
            ``(1) is less than 22 years old at time of first grant 
        award under this section;
            ``(2) receives a secondary school diploma or its recognized 
        equivalent on or after January 1, 1993;
            ``(3) is enrolled or accepted for enrollment in a program 
        of undergraduate instruction at an institution of higher 
        education that is located within the State's boundaries, except 
        that, at the State's option, an eligible entity may offer grant 
        program portability for recipients who attend institutions of 
        higher education outside such State; and
            ``(4) who participated in the early intervention component 
        required under section 404C.
    ``(e) Priority.--The Secretary shall ensure that each eligible 
entity places a priority on awarding scholarships to students who will 
receive a Federal Pell Grant for the academic year for which the 
scholarship is awarded under this section.
    ``(f) Special Rule.--An eligible entity may consider students who 
have successfully participated in programs funded under chapter 1 of 
this subpart to have met the requirements of subsection (d)(4).

``SEC. 404E. 21ST CENTURY SCHOLAR CERTIFICATES.

    ``(a) Authority.--The Secretary, using funds appropriated under 
section 404G, not to exceed $200,000 annually--
            ``(1) shall ensure that certificates, to be known as 21st 
        Century Scholar Certificates, are provided to all students 
        participating in programs under this chapter; and
            ``(2) may, as practicable, ensure that such certificates 
        are provided to all students in grades 6 through 12 who attend 
        schools at which at least 50 percent of the students enrolled 
        are eligible for a free or reduced price lunch.
    ``(b) Information Required.--A 21st Century Scholar Certificate 
shall be personalized for each student and indicate the amount of 
Federal financial aid for college which a student may be eligible to 
receive.

``SEC. 404F. EVALUATION AND REPORT.

    ``(a) Evaluation.--Each eligible entity receiving a grant under 
this chapter shall biennially evaluate the early intervention program 
assisted under this chapter in accordance with the standards described 
in subsection (b) and shall submit to the Secretary a copy of such 
evaluation. The evaluation shall permit service providers to track 
eligible student progress during the period such students are 
participating in the program assisted under this section and shall be 
consistent with the standards developed by the Secretary pursuant to 
subsection (b).
    ``(b) Evaluation Standards.--The Secretary shall prescribe 
standards for the evaluation described in subsection (a). Such 
standards shall--
            ``(1) provide for input from eligible entities and service 
        providers; and
            ``(2) ensure that data protocols and procedures are 
        consistent and uniform.
    ``(c) Federal Evaluation.--In order to evaluate and improve the 
impact of the program assisted under this chapter, the Secretary shall, 
with funds appropriated under section 404G, make grants to, and enter 
into contracts and cooperative agreements with public and private 
institutions and organizations, to evaluate the effectiveness of the 
program and, as appropriate, disseminate the results of the evaluation.
    ``(d) Report.--The Secretary shall biennially report to Congress on 
the activities assisted under this chapter and the evaluations 
conducted pursuant to this section.

``SEC. 404G. APPROPRIATIONS.

    ``There are authorized to be appropriated to carry out this chapter 
$200,000,000 for fiscal year 1999 and such sums as may be necessary for 
each of the 4 succeeding fiscal years.''.

SEC. 415. FEDERAL SUPPLEMENTAL EDUCATIONAL OPPORTUNITY GRANTS.

    (a) Authorization of Appropriations.--Section 413A(b) (20 U.S.C. 
1070b) is amended by striking ``$675,000,000 for fiscal year 1993'' and 
inserting ``$700,000,000 for fiscal year 1999''.
    (b) Use of Funds for Less-Than-Full-Time Students.--Subsection (d) 
of section 413C (20 U.S.C. 1070b-2) is amended to read as follows:
    ``(d) Use of Funds for Less-Than-Full-Time Students.--If the 
institution's allocation under this subpart is directly or indirectly 
based in part on the financial need demonstrated by students who are 
independent students or attending the institution on less than a full-
time basis, a reasonable proportion of the allocation shall be made 
available to such students.''.
    (c) Carryover, Carryback, and Reallocation.--Subpart 3 of part A of 
title IV (20 U.S.C. 1070b et seq.) is amended by adding at the end the 
following:

``SEC. 413E. CARRYOVER, CARRYBACK, AND REALLOCATION.

    ``(a) Carryover Authority.--Of the sums made available to an 
eligible institution under this subpart for a fiscal year, not more 
than 10 percent may, at the discretion of the institution, remain 
available for expenditure during the succeeding fiscal year to carry 
out the program under this subpart.
    ``(b) Carryback Authority.--Of the sums made available to an 
eligible institution under this subpart for a fiscal year, not more 
than 10 percent may, at the discretion of the institution, be used by 
the institution for expenditure for the fiscal year preceding the 
fiscal year for which the sums were appropriated.
    ``(c) Reallocation.--Any of the sums made available to an eligible 
institution under this subpart for a fiscal year that are not needed by 
the institution to award supplemental grants during that fiscal year, 
that the institution does not wish to use during the succeeding fiscal 
year as authorized in subsection (a), and that the institution does not 
wish to use for the preceding fiscal year as authorized in subsection 
(b), shall be made available to the Secretary for reallocation under 
section 413D(e) until the end of the second fiscal year after the 
fiscal year for which such sums were appropriated.''.

SEC. 416. LEVERAGING EDUCATIONAL ASSISTANCE PARTNERSHIP PROGRAM.

    (a) Amendment to Subpart Heading.--
            (1) In general.--The heading for subpart 4 of part A of 
        title IV (20 U.S.C. 1070c et seq.) is amended to read as 
        follows:

 ``Subpart 4--Leveraging Educational Assistance Partnership Program''.

            (2) Conforming amendments.--Subpart 4 of part A of title IV 
        (20 U.S.C. 1070c et seq.) is amended--
                    (A) in section 415B(b) (20 U.S.C. 1070c-1(b)), by 
                striking ``State student grant incentive'' and 
                inserting ``leveraging educational assistance 
                partnership''; and
                    (B) in the heading for section 415C (20 U.S.C. 
                1070c-2), by striking ``state student incentive grant'' 
                and inserting ``leveraging educational assistance 
                partnership''.
    (b) Authorization of Appropriations.--Section 415A(b) (20 U.S.C. 
1070c(b)) is amended--
            (1) in paragraph (1), by striking ``1993'' and inserting 
        ``1999'';
            (2) by redesignating paragraph (2) as paragraph (3); and
            (3) by inserting after paragraph (1) the following:
            ``(2) Reservation.--For any fiscal year for which the 
        amount appropriated under paragraph (1) exceeds $35,000,000, 
        the excess shall be available to carry out section 415E.''.
    (c) Special Leveraging Educational Assistance Partnership 
Program.--Subpart 4 of part A of title IV (20 U.S.C. 1070c et seq.) is 
amended--
            (1) by redesignating section 415E as 415F;
            (2) by inserting after section 415D the following:

``SEC. 415E. SPECIAL LEVERAGING EDUCATIONAL ASSISTANCE PARTNERSHIP 
              PROGRAM.

    ``(a) In General.--From amounts reserved under section 415A(b)(2) 
for each fiscal year, the Secretary shall--
            ``(1) make allotments among States in the same manner as 
        the Secretary makes allotments among States under section 415B; 
        and
            ``(2) award grants to States, from allotments under 
        paragraph (1), to enable the States to pay the Federal share of 
        the cost of the authorized activities described in subsection 
        (c).
    ``(b) Applicability Rule.--The provisions of this subpart which are 
not inconsistent with this section shall apply to the program 
authorized by this section.
    ``(c) Authorized Activities.--Each State receiving a grant under 
this section may use the grant funds for--
            ``(1) increasing the dollar amount of grants awarded under 
        section 415B to eligible students who demonstrate financial 
        need;
            ``(2) carrying out transition programs from secondary 
        school to postsecondary education for eligible students who 
        demonstrate financial need;
            ``(3) making funds available for community service work-
        study activities for eligible students who demonstrate 
        financial need;
            ``(4) creating a postsecondary scholarship program for 
        eligible students who demonstrate financial need and wish to 
        enter teaching;
            ``(5) creating a scholarship program for eligible students 
        who demonstrate financial need and wish to enter a program of 
        study leading to a degree in mathematics, computer science, or 
        engineering;
            ``(6) carrying out early intervention programs, mentoring 
        programs, and career education programs for eligible students 
        who demonstrate financial need; and
            ``(7) awarding merit or academic scholarships to eligible 
        students who demonstrate financial need.
    ``(d) Maintenance of Effort Requirement.--Each State receiving a 
grant under this section for a fiscal year shall provide the Secretary 
an assurance that the aggregate amount expended per student or the 
aggregate expenditures by the State, from funds derived from non-
Federal sources, for the authorized activities described in subsection 
(c) for the preceding fiscal year were not less than the amount 
expended per student or the aggregate expenditures by the State for the 
activities for the second preceding fiscal year.
    ``(e) Federal Share.--The Federal share of the cost of the 
authorized activities described in subsection (c) for any fiscal year 
shall be 33\1/3\ percent.''; and
            (3) by adding at the end the following:

``SEC. 415G. FEDERAL-STATE RELATIONSHIPS; STATE AGREEMENTS.

    ``(a) In General.--Any State that desires to receive assistance 
under this subpart shall enter into an agreement with the Secretary 
pursuant to subsection (b) setting forth the terms and conditions for 
the relationship between the Federal Government and that State for the 
purposes set forth under this subpart.
    ``(b) Contents.--
            ``(1) In general.--Such agreement shall consist of 
        assurances by the State, including a description of the means 
        to be used by the State to fulfill the assurances, that--
                    ``(A) the State will provide for such methods of 
                administration as are necessary for the proper and 
                efficient administration of the program under this 
                subpart in keeping with the purposes set forth under 
                this subpart;
                    ``(B) the State will provide for such fiscal 
                control and fund accounting procedures as may be 
                necessary to ensure proper disbursement of, and 
                accounting for, Federal funds paid to the State under 
                this subpart;
                    ``(C) the State will follow policies and practices 
                of administration that will ensure that non-Federal 
                funds will not be supplanted by Federal funds, and that 
                equitable and appropriate criteria will be used in 
                evaluation of applications or proposals for grants 
                under this subpart; and
                    ``(D) the State has a comprehensive planning or 
                policy formulation process that--
                            ``(i) considers the relation between State 
                        administration of the program under this 
                        subpart, and administration of similar State 
                        programs or processes;
                            ``(ii) encourages State policies designed 
                        to consider effects on declining enrollments on 
                        all sectors of postsecondary education in the 
                        State;
                            ``(iii) considers the postsecondary 
                        education needs of unserved and underserved 
                        individuals within the State, including 
                        individuals beyond the traditional college age;
                            ``(iv) considers the resources of 
                        institutions, organizations, or agencies (both 
                        public and private) within the State capable of 
                        providing postsecondary educational 
                        opportunities in the State; and
                            ``(v) provides for direct, equitable, and 
                        active participation in the comprehensive 
                        planning or policy formulation process or 
                        processes of representatives of institutions of 
                        higher education (including community colleges, 
                        proprietary institutions, and independent 
                        colleges and universities), students, other 
                        providers of postsecondary education services, 
                        and the general public in the State.
            ``(2) Special rule.--Participation under paragraph 
        (1)(D)(v) shall, consistent with State law, be achieved through 
        membership on State planning commissions, State advisory 
        councils, or other State entities established by the State to 
        conduct federally assisted comprehensive planning or policy 
        formulation.
    ``(c) Special Rule.--The information and assurances provided by a 
State in accordance with subparagraphs (A), (B), and (C) of subsection 
(b)(1), and regulations issued by the Secretary related directly to 
such assurances, shall be satisfactory for the purposes of, and shall 
be considered in lieu of, any comparable requirements for information 
and assurances in any program under this subpart.
    ``(d) Agreement Duration; Compliance.--
            ``(1) Agreement duration.--An agreement of a State shall 
        remain in effect subject to modification as changes in 
        information or circumstances require.
            ``(2) Compliance.--Whenever the Secretary, after reasonable 
        notice and opportunity for a hearing has been given to the 
        State, finds that there is a failure to comply substantially 
        with the assurances required in subparagraph (A), (B), or (C) 
        of subsection (b)(1), the Secretary shall notify the State that 
        the State is no longer eligible to participate in the program 
        under this subpart until the Secretary is satisfied that there 
        is no longer any such failure to comply.
    ``(e) Special Rules.--
            ``(1) Entities entering into agreements.--For the purpose 
        of this section, the selection of the State entity or entities 
        authorized to act on behalf of the State for the purpose of 
        entering into an agreement with the Secretary shall be in 
        accordance with the State law of each individual State with 
        respect to the authority to make legal agreements between the 
        State and the Federal Government.
            ``(2) Construction.--
                    ``(A) State structure.--Nothing in this section 
                shall be construed to authorize the Secretary to 
                require any State to adopt, as a condition for entering 
                into an agreement, or for participation in a program 
                under this subpart, a specific State organizational 
                structure for achieving participation in the planning, 
                or administration of programs, or for statewide 
                planning, coordination, governing, regulating, or 
                administering of postsecondary education agencies, 
                institutions, or programs in the State.
                    ``(B) State authority.--Nothing in this section 
                shall be construed as a limitation on the authority of 
                any State to adopt a State organizational structure for 
                postsecondary education agencies, institutions, or 
                programs that is appropriate to the needs, traditions, 
                and circumstances of that State, or as a limitation on 
                the authority of a State entering into an agreement 
                pursuant to this section to modify the State 
                organizational structure at any time subsequent to 
                entering into such an agreement.''.
    (d) Technical and Conforming Amendments.--
            (1) Purpose.--Subsection (a) of section 415A (20 U.S.C. 
        1070c(a)) is amended to read as follows:
    ``(a) Purpose of Subpart.--It is the purpose of this subpart to 
make incentive grants available to States to assist States in--
            ``(1) providing grants to--
                    ``(A) eligible students attending institutions of 
                higher education or participating in programs of study 
                abroad that are approved for credit by institutions of 
                higher education at which such students are enrolled; 
                and
                    ``(B) eligible students for campus-based community 
                service work-study; and
            ``(2) carrying out the activities described in section 
        415F.''.
            (2) Allotment.--Section 415B(a)(1) (20 U.S.C. 1070c-
        1(a)(1)) is amended by inserting ``and not reserved under 
        section 415A(b)(2)'' after ``415A(b)(1)''.

SEC. 417. HEP AND CAMP.

    Section 418A(g) (20 U.S.C. 1070d-2(g)) is amended--
            (1) in paragraph (1), by striking ``$15,000,000 for fiscal 
        year 1993'' and inserting ``$25,000,000 for fiscal year 1999''; 
        and
            (2) in paragraph (2), by striking ``$5,000,000 for fiscal 
        year 1993'' and inserting ``$10,000,000 for fiscal year 1999''.

SEC. 418. ROBERT C. BYRD HONORS SCHOLARSHIP PROGRAM.

    Section 419K (20 U.S.C. 1070d-41) is amended by striking 
``$10,000,000 for fiscal year 1993'' and inserting ``$45,000,000 for 
fiscal year 1999''.

SEC. 419. CHILD CARE ACCESS MEANS PARENTS IN SCHOOL.

    Part A of title IV (20 U.S.C. 1070 et seq.) is amended by inserting 
after subpart 6 (20 U.S.C. 1070d-31 et seq.) the following:

         ``Subpart 7--Child Care Access Means Parents in School

``SEC. 419N. CHILD CARE ACCESS MEANS PARENTS IN SCHOOL.

    ``(a) Purpose.--The purpose of this section is to support the 
participation of low-income parents in postsecondary education through 
the provision of campus-based child care services.
    ``(b) Program Authorized.--
            ``(1) Authority.--The Secretary may award grants to 
        institutions of higher education to assist the institutions in 
        providing campus-based child care services primarily to low-
        income students.
            ``(2) Amount of grants.--
                    ``(A) In general.--The amount of a grant awarded to 
                an institution of higher education under this section 
                for a fiscal year shall not exceed 1 percent of the 
                total amount of all Federal Pell Grant funds awarded to 
                students enrolled at the institution of higher 
                education for the preceding fiscal year.
                    ``(B) Minimum.--A grant under this section shall be 
                awarded in an amount that is not less than $10,000.
            ``(3) Duration; renewal; and payments.--
                    ``(A) Duration.--The Secretary shall award a grant 
                under this section for a period of 3 years.
                    ``(B) Renewal.--A grant under this section may be 
                renewed for a period of 3 years.
                    ``(C) Payments.--Subject to subsection (e)(2), the 
                Secretary shall make annual grant payments under this 
                section.
            ``(4) Eligible institutions.--An institution of higher 
        education shall be eligible to receive a grant under this 
        section for a fiscal year if the total amount of all Federal 
        Pell Grant funds awarded to students enrolled at the 
        institution of higher education for the preceding fiscal year 
        equals or exceeds $350,000.
            ``(5) Use of funds.--Grant funds under this section shall 
        be used by an institution of higher education to support or 
        establish a campus-based child care program primarily serving 
        the needs of low-income students enrolled at the institution of 
        higher education. Grant funds under this section may be used to 
        provide before and after school services to the extent 
        necessary to enable low-income students enrolled at the 
        institution of higher education to pursue postsecondary 
        education.
            ``(6) Construction.--Nothing in this section shall be 
        construed to prohibit an institution of higher education that 
        receives grant funds under this section from serving the child 
        care needs of the community served by the institution.
            ``(7) Definition of low-income student.--For the purpose of 
        this section, the term ``low-income student'' means a student 
        who is eligible to receive a Federal Pell Grant for the fiscal 
        year for which the determination is made.
    ``(c) Applications.--An institution of higher education desiring a 
grant under this section shall submit an application to the Secretary 
at such time, in such manner, and accompanied by such information as 
the Secretary may require. Each application shall--
            ``(1) demonstrate that the institution is an eligible 
        institution described in subsection (b)(4);
            ``(2) specify the amount of funds requested;
            ``(3) demonstrate the need of low-income students at the 
        institution for campus-based child care services by including 
        in the application--
                    ``(A) information regarding student demographics;
                    ``(B) an assessment of child care capacity on or 
                near campus;
                    ``(C) information regarding the existence of 
                waiting lists for existing child care;
                    ``(D) information regarding additional needs 
                created by concentrations of poverty or by geographic 
                isolation; and
                    ``(E) other relevant data;
            ``(4) contain a description of the activities to be 
        assisted, including whether the grant funds will support an 
        existing child care program or a new child care program;
            ``(5) identify the resources, including technical expertise 
        and financial support, the institution will draw upon to 
        support the child care program and the participation of low-
        income students in the program, such as accessing social 
        services funding, using student activity fees to help pay the 
        costs of child care, using resources obtained by meeting the 
        needs of parents who are not low-income students, and accessing 
        foundation, corporate or other institutional support, and 
        demonstrate that the use of the resources will not result in 
        increases in student tuition;
            ``(6) contain an assurance that the institution will meet 
        the child care needs of low-income students through the 
        provision of services, or through a contract for the provision 
        of services;
            ``(7) describe the extent to which the child care program 
        will coordinate with the institution's early childhood 
        education curriculum, to the extent the curriculum is 
        available, to meet the needs of the students in the early 
        childhood education program at the institution, and the needs 
        of the parents and children participating in the child care 
        program assisted under this section;
            ``(8) in the case of an institution seeking assistance for 
        a new child care program--
                    ``(A) provide a timeline, covering the period from 
                receipt of the grant through the provision of the child 
                care services, delineating the specific steps the 
                institution will take to achieve the goal of providing 
                low-income students with child care services;
                    ``(B) specify any measures the institution will 
                take to assist low-income students with child care 
                during the period before the institution provides child 
                care services; and
                    ``(C) include a plan for identifying resources 
                needed for the child care services, including space in 
                which to provide child care services, and technical 
                assistance if necessary;
            ``(9) contain an assurance that any child care facility 
        assisted under this section will meet the applicable State or 
        local government licensing, certification, approval, or 
        registration requirements; and
            ``(10) contain a plan for any child care facility assisted 
        under this section to become accredited within 3 years of the 
        date the institution first receives assistance under this 
        section.
    ``(d) Priority.--The Secretary shall give priority in awarding 
grants under this section to institutions of higher education that 
submit applications describing programs that--
            ``(1) leverage significant local or institutional 
        resources, including in-kind contributions, to support the 
        activities assisted under this section; and
            ``(2) utilize a sliding fee scale for child care services 
        provided under this section in order to support a high number 
        of low-income parents pursuing postsecondary education at the 
        institution.
    ``(e) Reporting Requirements; Continuing Eligibility.--
            ``(1) Reporting requirements.--
                    ``(A) Reports.--Each institution of higher 
                education receiving a grant under this section shall 
                report to the Secretary 18 months, and 36 months, after 
                receiving the first grant payment under this section.
                    ``(B) Contents.--The report shall include--
                            ``(i) data on the population served under 
                        this section;
                            ``(ii) information on campus and community 
                        resources and funding used to help low-income 
                        students access child care services;
                            ``(iii) information on progress made toward 
                        accreditation of any child care facility; and
                            ``(iv) information on the impact of the 
                        grant on the quality, availability, and 
                        affordability of campus-based child care 
                        services.
            ``(2) Continuing eligibility.--The Secretary shall make the 
        third annual grant payment under this section to an institution 
        of higher education only if the Secretary determines, on the 
        basis of the 18-month report submitted under paragraph (1), 
        that the institution is making a good faith effort to ensure 
        that low-income students at the institution have access to 
        affordable, quality child care services.
    ``(f) Construction.--No funds provided under this section shall be 
used for construction, except for minor renovation or repair to meet 
applicable State or local health or safety requirements.
    ``(g) Authorization of Appropriations.--There are authorized to be 
appropriated to carry out this section $60,000,000 for fiscal year 1999 
and such sums as may be necessary for each of the 4 succeeding fiscal 
years.''.

SEC. 420. LEARNING ANYTIME ANYWHERE PARTNERSHIPS.

    Part A of title IV (20 U.S.C. 1070 et seq.) is amended further by 
adding at the end the following:

          ``Subpart 9--Learning Anytime Anywhere Partnerships

``SEC. 420D. FINDINGS.

    ``Congress makes the following findings:
            ``(1) The nature of postsecondary education delivery is 
        changing, and new technology and other related innovations can 
        provide promising education opportunities for individuals who 
        are currently not being served, particularly for individuals 
        without easy access to traditional campus-based postsecondary 
        education or for whom traditional courses are a poor match with 
        education or training needs.
            ``(2) Individuals, including individuals seeking basic or 
        technical skills or their first postsecondary experience, 
        individuals with disabilities, dislocated workers, individuals 
        making the transition from welfare-to-work, and individuals who 
        are limited by time and place constraints can benefit from 
        nontraditional, noncampus-based postsecondary education 
        opportunities and appropriate support services.
            ``(3) The need for high-quality, nontraditional, 
        technology-based education opportunities is great, as is the 
        need for skill competency credentials and other measures of 
        educational progress and attainment that are valid and widely 
        accepted, but neither need is likely to be adequately addressed 
        by the uncoordinated efforts of agencies and institutions 
        acting independently and without assistance.
            ``(4) Partnerships, consisting of institutions of higher 
        education, community organizations, or other public or private 
        agencies or organizations, can coordinate and combine 
        institutional resources--
                    ``(A) to provide the needed variety of education 
                options to students; and
                    ``(B) to develop new means of ensuring 
                accountability and quality for innovative education 
                methods.

``SEC. 420E. PURPOSE; PROGRAM AUTHORIZED.

    ``(a) Purpose.--It is the purpose of this subpart to enhance the 
delivery, quality, and accountability of postsecondary education and 
career-oriented lifelong learning through technology and related 
innovations.
    ``(b) Program Authorized.--
            ``(1) Grants.--
                    ``(A) In general.--The Secretary may, from funds 
                appropriated under section 420J make grants to, or 
                enter into contracts or cooperative agreements with, 
                eligible partnerships to carry out the authorized 
                activities described in section 420G.
                    ``(B) Duration.--Grants under this subpart shall be 
                awarded for periods that do not exceed 5 years.
            ``(2) Definition of eligible partnership.--For purposes of 
        this subpart, the term `eligible partnership' means a 
        partnership consisting of 2 or more independent agencies, 
        organizations, or institutions. The agencies, organizations, or 
        institutions may include institutions of higher education, 
        community organizations, and other public and private 
        institutions, agencies, and organizations.

``SEC. 420F. APPLICATION.

    ``(a) Requirement.--An eligible partnership desiring to receive a 
grant under this subpart shall submit an application to the Secretary, 
in such form and containing such information, as the Secretary may 
require.
    ``(b) Contents.--Each application shall include--
            ``(1) the name of each partner and a description of the 
        responsibilities of the partner, including the designation of a 
        nonprofit organization as the fiscal agent for the partnership;
            ``(2) a description of the need for the project, including 
        a description of how the project will build on any existing 
        services and activities;
            ``(3) a listing of human, financial (other than funds 
        provided under this subpart), and other resources that each 
        member of the partnership will contribute to the partnership, 
        and a description of the efforts each member of the partnership 
        will make in seeking additional resources; and
            ``(4) a description of how the project will operate, 
        including how funds awarded under this subpart will be used to 
        meet the purpose of this subpart.

``SEC. 420G. AUTHORIZED ACTIVITIES.

    ``Funds awarded to an eligible partnership under this subpart shall 
be used to--
            ``(1) develop and assess model distance learning programs 
        or innovative educational software;
            ``(2) develop methodologies for the identification and 
        measurement of skill competencies;
            ``(3) develop and assess innovative student support 
        services; or
            ``(4) support other activities that are consistent with the 
        purpose of this subpart.

``SEC. 420H. MATCHING REQUIREMENT.

    ``Federal funds shall provide not more than 50 percent of the cost 
of a project under this subpart. The non-Federal share of project costs 
may be in cash or in kind, fairly evaluated, including services, 
supplies, or equipment.

``SEC. 420I. PEER REVIEW.

    ``The Secretary shall use a peer review process to review 
applications under this subpart and to make recommendations for funding 
under this subpart to the Secretary.

``SEC. 420J. AUTHORIZATION OF APPROPRIATIONS.

    ``There are authorized to be appropriated to carry out this subpart 
$30,000,000 for fiscal year 1999 and such sums as may be necessary for 
each of the 4 succeeding fiscal years.''.

             PART B--FEDERAL FAMILY EDUCATION LOAN PROGRAM

SEC. 421. ADVANCES FOR RESERVE FUNDS.

    Section 422 (20 U.S.C. 1072) is amended--
            (1) in subsection (c)--
                    (A) in paragraph (6)(B)(i), by striking ``written'' 
                and inserting ``written, electronic''; and
                    (B) in paragraph (7)(A), by striking ``during the 
                transition from the Federal Family Education Loan 
                Program under this part to the Federal Direct Student 
                Loan Program under part D of this title'';
            (2) in the matter preceding subparagraph (A) of subsection 
        (g)(1), by striking ``or the program authorized by part D of 
        this title'' each place the term appears; and
            (3) by adding at the end the following:
    ``(i) Additional Recall of Reserves for Fiscal Years 1999, 2000, 
2001, and 2002.--
            ``(1) In general.--Notwithstanding any other provision of 
        law and subject to paragraph (4), the Secretary shall recall 
        $21,250,000 for each of the fiscal years 1999, 2000, 2001, and 
        2002 from reserve funds held in the Federal Student Loan 
        Reserve Funds established under section 422A by guaranty 
        agencies.
            ``(2) Deposit.--Funds recalled by the Secretary under this 
        subsection shall be deposited in the Treasury.
            ``(3) Required share.--The Secretary shall require each 
        guaranty agency to return reserve funds under paragraph (1) 
        annually on the basis of \1/4\ of the agency's required share. 
        For purposes of this paragraph, a guaranty agency's required 
        share shall be determined as follows:
                    ``(A) Equal percentage.--The Secretary shall 
                require each guaranty agency to return an equal 
                percentage reduction in the amount of reserve funds 
                held by the agency on September 30, 1996.
                    ``(B) Calculation.--The equal percentage reduction 
                shall be the percentage obtained by dividing--
                            ``(i) $85,000,000, by
                            ``(ii) the total amount of all guaranty 
                        agencies' reserve funds held on September 30, 
                        1996.
                    ``(C) Special rule.--Notwithstanding subparagraphs 
                (A) and (B), the percentage reduction under 
                subparagraph (B) shall not result in the depletion of 
                the reserve funds of any agency which charges the 1.0 
                percent insurance premium pursuant to section 
                428(b)(1)(H) below an amount equal to the amount of 
                lender claim payments paid 90 days prior to the date of 
                the return under this subsection. If any additional 
                amount is required to be returned after deducting the 
                total of the required shares under subparagraph (B) and 
                as a result of the preceding sentence, such additional 
                amount shall be obtained by imposing on each guaranty 
                agency to which the preceding sentence does not apply, 
                an equal percentage reduction in the amount of the 
                agency's remaining reserve funds.
            ``(4) Offset of required shares.--If any guaranty agency 
        returns to the Secretary any reserve funds in excess of the 
        amount required under this subsection or subsection (h), the 
        total amount required to be returned under paragraph (1) shall 
        be reduced by the amount of such excess reserve funds returned.
            ``(5) Definition of reserve funds.--The term `reserve 
        funds' when used with respect to a guaranty agency--
                    ``(A) includes any reserve funds in cash or liquid 
                assets held by the guaranty agency, or held by, or 
                under the control of, any other entity; and
                    ``(B) does not include buildings, equipment, or 
                other nonliquid assets.
    ``(j) Additional Recall of Reserves on September 1, 2007.--
            ``(1) In general.--Notwithstanding any other provision of 
        law and subject to paragraph (4), the Secretary shall recall, 
        on September 1, 2007, $165,000,000 from reserve funds held in 
        the Federal Student Loan Reserve Funds established under 
        section 422A by guaranty agencies.
            ``(2) Deposit.--Funds recalled by the Secretary under this 
        subsection shall be deposited in the Treasury.
            ``(3) Equal percentage reduction.--The Secretary shall 
        require each guaranty agency to return reserve funds under 
        paragraph (1) by requiring an equal percentage reduction in the 
        amount of reserve funds held by the agency on September 30, 
        1996.
            ``(4) Offset of required shares.--If any guaranty agency 
        returns to the Secretary any reserve funds in excess of the 
        amount required under this subsection, subsection (h), or 
        subsection (i), the total amount required to be returned under 
        paragraph (1) shall be reduced by the amount of such excess 
        reserve funds returned.
            ``(5) Definition of reserve funds.--The term `reserve 
        funds' when used with respect to a guaranty agency--
                    ``(A) includes any reserve funds in cash or liquid 
                assets held by the guaranty agency, or held by, or 
                under the control of, any other entity; and
                    ``(B) does not include buildings, equipment, or 
                other nonliquid assets.''.

SEC. 422. FEDERAL STUDENT LOAN RESERVE FUND.

    Part B of title IV (20 U.S.C. 1071 et seq.) is amended by inserting 
after section 422 (20 U.S.C. 1072) the following:

``SEC. 422A. FEDERAL STUDENT LOAN RESERVE FUND.

    ``(a) Establishment.--Each guaranty agency shall, not later than 45 
days after the date of enactment of this section, deposit all funds, 
securities, and other liquid assets contained in the reserve fund 
established pursuant to section 422 into a Federal Student Loan Reserve 
Fund (in this section referred to as the `Federal Fund'), in an account 
of a type selected by the agency, with the approval of the Secretary.
    ``(b) Investment of Funds.--Funds transferred to the Federal Fund 
shall be invested in obligations issued or guaranteed by the United 
States or a State, or in other similarly low-risk securities selected 
by the guaranty agency, with the approval of the Secretary. Earnings 
from the Federal Fund shall be the sole property of the Federal 
Government.
    ``(c) Additional Deposits.--After the establishment of the Federal 
Fund, a guaranty agency shall deposit into the Federal Fund--
            ``(1) all amounts received from the Secretary as payment of 
        reinsurance on loans pursuant to section 428(c)(1);
            ``(2) from amounts collected on behalf of the obligation of 
        a defaulted borrower, a percentage amount equal to the 
        complement of the reinsurance percentage in effect when payment 
        under the guaranty agreement was made with respect to the 
        defaulted loan pursuant to section 428(c)(6)(A); and
            ``(3) the amount of the insurance premium collected from 
        borrowers pursuant to section 428(b)(1)(H).
    ``(d) Uses of Funds.--Subject to subsection (f), the Federal Fund 
may only be used by a guaranty agency--
            ``(1) to pay lender claims pursuant to sections 
        428(b)(1)(G), 428(j), 437, and 439(q); and
            ``(2) to pay into the Agency Operating Fund established 
        pursuant to section 422B a default prevention fee in accordance 
        with section 428(l).
    ``(e) Ownership of Federal Fund.--The Federal Fund, and any 
nonliquid asset (such as a building or equipment) developed or 
purchased by the guaranty agency in whole or in part with Federal 
reserve funds, regardless of who holds or controls the Federal reserve 
funds or such asset, shall be considered to be the property of the 
United States, prorated based on the percentage of such asset developed 
or purchased with Federal reserve funds, which property shall be used 
in the operation of the program authorized by the part, as provided in 
subsection (d). The Secretary may restrict or regulate the use of such 
asset only to the extent necessary to reasonably protect the 
Secretary's prorated share of the value of such asset. The Secretary 
may direct a guaranty agency, or such agency's officers or directors, 
to cease any activity involving expenditures, use, or transfer of the 
Federal Fund administered by the guaranty agency that the Secretary 
determines is a misapplication, misuse, or improper expenditures of the 
Federal fund or the Secretary's share of such asset.
    ``(f) Transition.--
            ``(1) In general.--In order to establish the Agency 
        Operating Fund established by section 422B, each agency may 
        transfer not more than 180 days cash expenses for normal 
        operating expenses, as a working capital reserve as defined in 
        Office of Management and Budget Circular A-87 (Cost Accounting 
        Standards) for use in the performance of the agency's duties 
        under this part. Such transfers may occur during the first 3 
        years following the establishment of the Agency Operating Fund, 
        except that no agency may transfer in excess of 40 percent of 
        the Federal Fund balance to the agency's Agency Operating Fund 
        during any fiscal year. In determining the amount necessary for 
        transfer, the agency shall assure that sufficient funds remain 
        in the Federal Fund to pay lender claims within the required 
        time periods and to meet the reserve funds recall requirements 
        of subsection (b).
            ``(2) Repayment provisions.--Each guaranty agency shall 
        begin repayment of sums transferred pursuant to this subsection 
        not later than 3 years after the establishment of the Agency 
        Operating Fund, and shall repay all sums transferred not later 
        than 5 years from the date of the establishment of the Agency 
        Operating Fund. The guaranty agency shall provide to the 
        Secretary a schedule for repayment of the sums transferred and 
        an annual financial analysis demonstrating the agency's ability 
        to comply with the schedule and repay all outstanding sums 
        transferred.
            ``(3) Prohibition.--If a guaranty agency transfers funds 
        from the Federal Fund in accordance with this section, and 
        fails to make scheduled repayments to the Federal Fund, the 
        agency may not receive any other funds under this part until 
        the Secretary determines that the agency has made such 
        repayments. The Secretary shall pay to the guaranty agency any 
        funds withheld in accordance with this paragraph immediately 
        upon making the determination that the guaranty agency has made 
        all such repayments.
            ``(4) Waiver.--The Secretary may waive the requirements of 
        paragraph (3) for a guaranty agency described in such paragraph 
        if the Secretary determines there are extenuating circumstances 
        beyond the control of the agency that justify such a waiver.
            ``(5) Investment of federal funds.--Funds transferred from 
        the Federal Fund to the Agency Operating Fund for operating 
        expenses shall be invested in obligations issued or guaranteed 
        by the United States or a State, or in other similarly low-risk 
        securities selected by the guaranty agency, with the approval 
        of the Secretary.
            ``(6) Special rule.--In applying the minimum reserve level 
        required by section 428(c)(9)(A), the Secretary shall include 
        all amounts owed to the Federal Fund by the guaranty agency in 
        the calculation.''.

SEC. 423. AGENCY OPERATING FUND.

    Part B of title IV (20 U.S.C. 1071 et seq.) is amended further by 
inserting after section 422A (as added by section 422) the following:

``SEC. 422B. AGENCY OPERATING FUND.

    ``(a) Establishment.--Each guaranty agency shall, not later than 45 
days after the date of enactment of this section, establish a fund 
designated as the Agency Operating Fund (in this section referred to as 
the `Operating Fund').
    ``(b) Investment of Funds.--Funds deposited into the Operating 
Fund, with the exception of funds transferred from the Federal Student 
Loan Reserve Fund pursuant to section 422A(f), shall be invested at the 
discretion of the guaranty agency.
    ``(c) Additional Deposits.--After the establishment of the 
Operating Fund, the guaranty agency shall deposit into the Operating 
Fund--
            ``(1) the loan processing and issuance fee paid by the 
        Secretary pursuant to section 428(f);
            ``(2) administrative cost allowances paid under section 
        458, as such section was in effect on the day preceding the 
        date of enactment of the Higher Education Amendments of 1998, 
        and the portfolio maintenance fee paid by the Secretary in 
        accordance with section 458;
            ``(3) the default prevention fee paid in accordance with 
        section 428(l); and
            ``(4) amounts remaining pursuant to section 428(c)(6)(B) 
        from collection on defaulted loans held by the agency, after 
        payment of the Secretary's equitable share, excluding amounts 
        deposited in the Federal Student Loan Reserve Fund pursuant to 
        section 422A(c)(2).
    ``(d) Uses of Funds.--
            ``(1) In general.--Funds in the Operating Fund shall be 
        used for application processing, loan disbursement, enrollment 
        and repayment status management, default prevention activities 
        (including those described in section 422(h)(8), default 
        collection activities, school and lender training, compliance 
        monitoring, and other student financial aid related activities 
        as determined by the Secretary.
            ``(2) Special rule.--The guaranty agency may, in the 
        agency's discretion, transfer funds from the Operating Fund to 
        the Federal Student Loan Reserve Fund for use pursuant to 
        section 422A. Such transfer shall be irrevocable, and any funds 
        so transferred shall become the sole property of the United 
        States.
            ``(3) Definitions.--For purposes of this subsection:
                    ``(A) Default collection activities.--The term 
                `default collection activities' means activities of a 
                guaranty agency that are directly related to the 
                collection of the loan on which a default claim has 
                been paid to the participating lender, including the 
                attributable compensation of collection personnel (and 
                in the case of personnel who perform several functions 
                for such an agency only the portion of the compensation 
                attributable to the collection activity), attorney's 
                fees, fees paid to collection agencies, postage, 
                equipment, supplies, telephone, and similar charges.
                    ``(B) Default prevention activities.--The term 
                `default prevention activities' means activities of a 
                guaranty agency, including those described in section 
                422(h)(8), that are directly related to providing 
                collection assistance to the lender on a delinquent 
                loan, prior to the loan's being in a default status, 
                including the attributable compensation of appropriate 
                personnel (and in the case of personnel who perform 
                several functions for such an agency only the portion 
                of compensation attributable to the default prevention 
                activity), fees paid to locate a missing borrower, 
                postage, equipment, supplies, telephone, and similar 
                charges.
                    ``(C) Enrollment and repayment status management.--
                The term `enrollment and repayment status management' 
                means activities of a guaranty agency that are directly 
                related to ascertaining the student's enrollment 
                status, including prompt notification to the lender of 
                such status, an audit of the note or written agreement 
                to determine if the provisions of that note or 
                agreement are consistent with the records of the 
                guaranty agency as to the principal amount of the loan 
                guaranteed, and an examination of the note or agreement 
                to assure that the repayment provisions are consistent 
                with the provisions of this title.
    ``(e) Ownership of Operating Fund.--The Operating Fund, with the 
exception of funds transferred from the Federal Student Loan Reserve 
Fund in accordance with section 422A(f), shall be considered to be the 
property of the guaranty agency. The Secretary may not regulate the 
uses or expenditure of moneys in the Operating Fund, but the Secretary 
may require such necessary reports and audits as provided in section 
428(b)(2). However, during any period in which funds are owed to the 
Federal Student Loan Reserve Fund as a result of transfer under section 
422A(f), moneys in the Operating Fund may only be used for expenses 
related to the student loan programs authorized under this part.''.

SEC. 424. SCOPE AND DURATION OF FEDERAL LOAN INSURANCE PROGRAM.

    Section 424(a) (20 U.S.C. 1074(a)) is amended--
            (1) by striking ``October 1, 2002'' and inserting ``October 
        1, 2004''; and
            (2) by striking ``September 30, 2006'' and inserting 
        ``September 30, 2008''.

SEC. 425. APPLICABLE INTEREST RATES.

    (a) Applicable Interest Rates.--
            (1) Amendment.--Section 427A (20 U.S.C. 1077a et seq.) is 
        amended by amending subsection (j) to read as follows:
    ``(j) Interest Rates for New Loans On or After October 1, 1998, and 
Before July 1, 2003.--
            ``(1) In general.--Notwithstanding subsection (h) and 
        subject to paragraph (2), with respect to any loan made, 
        insured, or guaranteed under this part (other than a loan made 
        pursuant to section 428B or 428C) for which the first 
        disbursement is made on or after October 1, 1998, and before 
        July 1, 2003, the applicable rate of interest shall, during any 
        12-month period beginning on July 1 and ending on June 30, be 
        determined on the preceding June 1 and be equal to--
                    ``(A) the bond equivalent rate of 91-day Treasury 
                bills auctioned at the final auction held prior to such 
                June 1; plus
                    ``(B) 2.3 percent,
        except that such rate shall not exceed 8.25 percent.
            ``(2) In school and grace period rules.--Notwithstanding 
        subsection (h), with respect to any loan under this part (other 
        than a loan made pursuant to section 428B or 428C) for which 
        the first disbursement is made on or after October 1, 1998, and 
        before July 1, 2003, the applicable rate of interest for 
        interest which accrues--
                    ``(A) prior to the beginning of the repayment 
                period of the loan; or
                    ``(B) during the period in which principal need not 
                be paid (whether or not such principal is in fact paid) 
                by reason of a provision described in section 
                428(b)(1)(M) or 427(a)(2)(C),
        shall be determined under paragraph (1) by substituting `1.7 
        percent' for `2.3 percent'.
            ``(3) PLUS loans.--Notwithstanding subsection (h), with 
        respect to any loan under section 428B for which the first 
        disbursement is made on or after October 1, 1998, and before 
        July 1, 2003, the applicable rate of interest shall be 
        determined under paragraph (1)--
                    ``(A) by substituting `3.1 percent' for `2.3 
                percent'; and
                    ``(B) by substituting `9.0 percent' for `8.25 
                percent'.
            ``(4) Consultation.--The Secretary shall determine the 
        applicable rate of interest under this subsection after 
        consultation with the Secretary of the Treasury and shall 
        publish such rate in the Federal Register as soon as 
        practicable after the date of determination.''.
            (2) Conforming amendment.--Section 428B(d)(4) (20 U.S.C. 
        1078-2(d)(4)) is amended by striking ``section 427A(c)'' and 
        inserting ``section 427A(j)(3)''.
    (b) Special Allowances.
            (1) Amendment.--Section 438(b)(2)(G) (20 U.S.C. 1087-
        1(b)(2)(G)) is amended to read as follows:
                    ``(G) Loans disbursed between october 1, 1998, and 
                before july 1, 2003.--
                            ``(i) In general.--Subject to paragraph (4) 
                        and clauses (ii), (iii), and (iv) of this 
                        subparagraph, and except as provided in 
                        subparagraph (B), the special allowance paid 
                        pursuant to this subsection on loans for which 
                        the first disbursement is made on or after 
                        October 1, 1998, and before July 1, 2003, shall 
                        be computed--
                            ``(I) by determining the average of the 
                        bond equivalent rates of 91-day Treasury bills 
                        auctioned for such 3-month period;
                            ``(II) by subtracting the applicable 
                        interest rates on such loans from such average 
                        bond equivalent rate;
                            ``(III) by adding 2.8 percent to the 
                        resultant percent; and
                            ``(IV) by dividing the resultant percent by 
                        4.
                    ``(ii) In school and grace period.--In the case of 
                any loan for which the first disbursement is made on or 
                after October 1, 1998, and before July 1, 2003, and for 
                which the applicable rate of interest is described in 
                section 427A(j)(2), clause (i)(III) of this 
                subparagraph shall be applied by substituting `2.2 
                percent' for `2.8 percent'.
                    ``(iii) PLUS loans.--In the case of any loan for 
                which the first disbursement is made on or after 
                October 1, 1998, and before July 1, 2003, and for which 
                the applicable rate of interest is described in section 
                427A(j)(3), clause (i)(III) of this subparagraph shall 
                be applied by substituting `3.1 percent' for `2.8 
                percent', subject to clause (iv) of this subparagraph.
                    ``(iv) Limitation on special allowances for plus 
                loans.--In the case of loans disbursed on or after 
                October 1, 1998, and before July 1, 2003, for which the 
                interest rate is determined under section 427A(j)(3), a 
                special allowance shall not be paid for a loan made 
                under section 428B unless the rate determined for any 
                12-month period under section 427A(j)(3) exceeds 9 
                percent.''.
            (2) Conforming amendment.--Section 438(b)(2)(C)(ii) is 
        amended by striking ``In the case'' and inserting ``Subject to 
        subparagraph (G), in the case''.
    (c) Effective Date.--The amendments made by this section shall 
apply with respect to any loan made, insured, or guaranteed under part 
B of title IV of the Higher Education Act of 1965 for which the first 
disbursement is made on or after October 1, 1998, and before July 1, 
2003.

SEC. 426. FEDERAL PAYMENTS TO REDUCE STUDENT INTEREST COSTS.

    (a) Federal Interest Subsidies.--Section 428(a) (20 U.S.C. 1078(a)) 
is amended--
            (1) in paragraph (2)--
                    (A) in subparagraph (A)--
                            (i) in clause (i), by striking subclauses 
                        (I), (II), and (III) and inserting the 
                        following:
                            ``(I) sets forth the loan amount for which 
                        the student shows financial need; and
                            ``(II) sets forth a schedule for 
                        disbursement of the proceeds of the loan in 
                        installments, consistent with the requirements 
                        of section 428G; and''; and
                            (ii) by amending clause (ii) to read as 
                        follows:
                    ``(ii) meets the requirements of subparagraph (B); 
                and'';
                    (B) by amending subparagraph (B) to read as 
                follows:
            ``(B) For the purpose of clause (ii) of subparagraph (A), a 
        student shall qualify for a portion of an interest payment 
        under paragraph (1) (and a loan amount pursuant to section 
        428H) if the eligible institution has determined and documented 
        the student's amount of need for a loan based on the student's 
        estimated cost of attendance, estimated financial assistance, 
        and, for the purpose of an interest payment pursuant to this 
        section, the expected family contribution (as determined under 
        part F), subject to the provisions of subparagraph (D).'';
                    (C) by amending subparagraph (C) to read as 
                follows:
            ``(C) For the purpose of subparagraph (B) and this 
        paragraph--
                    ``(i) a student's cost of attendance shall be 
                determined under section 472;
                    ``(ii) a student's estimated financial assistance 
                means, for the period for which the loan is sought, the 
                amount of assistance such student will receive under 
                subpart 1 of part A (as determined in accordance with 
                section 484(b)), subpart 3 of part A, parts C and E, 
                and any veterans' education benefits paid because of 
                enrollment in a postsecondary education institution, 
                including veterans' education benefits (as defined in 
                section 480(c)), plus other scholarship, grant, or loan 
                assistance; and
                    ``(iii) the determination of need and of the amount 
                of a loan by an eligible institution under subparagraph 
                (B) with respect to a student shall, with the exception 
                of loans made under section 428H, be calculated in 
                accordance with part F.''; and
                    (D) by striking subparagraph (F);
            (2) in paragraph (3)(A)(v)--
                    (A) in subclause (I), by inserting ``by the 
                institution'' after ``disbursement''; and
                    (B) in clause (II), by inserting ``by the 
                institution'' after ``disbursement''; and
            (3) in paragraph (5)--
                    (A) by striking ``September 30, 2002'' and 
                inserting ``September 30, 2004''; and
                    (B) by striking ``September 30, 2006'' and 
                inserting ``September 30, 2008''.
    (b) Insurance Program Agreements.--Section 428(b) (20 U.S.C. 
1078(b)) is amended--
            (1) in paragraph (1)--
                    (A) in subparagraph (A)--
                            (i) in the matter preceding clause (i), by 
                        inserting ``, as defined in section 
                        481(d)(2),'' after ``academic year'';
                            (ii) in clause (iv), by striking ``and'' 
                        after the semicolon;
                            (iii) in clause (v), by inserting ``and'' 
                        after the semicolon; and
                            (iv) by inserting before the matter 
                        following clause (v) the following:
                            ``(vi) in the case of a student enrolled in 
                        coursework specified in sections 484(b)(3)(B) 
                        and 484(b)(4)(B)--
                                    ``(I) $2,625 for coursework 
                                necessary for enrollment in an 
                                undergraduate degree or certificate 
                                program, and $5,500 for coursework 
                                necessary for enrollment in a graduate 
                                or professional degree or certification 
                                program; and
                                    ``(II) $5,500 for coursework 
                                necessary for a professional credential 
                                or certification from a State required 
                                for employment as a teacher in an 
                                elementary or secondary school;'';
                    (B) by amending subparagraph (E) to read as 
                follows:
                    ``(E) subject to subparagraphs (D) and (L), and 
                except as provided by subparagraph (M), provides that--
                            ``(i) not more than 6 months prior to the 
                        date on which the borrower's first payment is 
                        due, the lender shall offer the borrower of a 
                        loan made, insured, or guaranteed under this 
                        section or section 428H, the option of repaying 
                        the loan in accordance with a graduated, 
                        income-sensitive, or extended repayment 
                        schedule (as described in paragraph (9)) 
                        established by the lender in accordance with 
                        regulations provided by the Secretary; and
                            ``(ii) repayment of loans shall be in 
                        installments in accordance with the repayment 
                        plan selected under paragraph (9) and 
                        commencing at the beginning of the repayment 
                        period determined under paragraph (7)'';
                    (C) in subparagraph (L)(i), by inserting ``except 
                as otherwise provided by a repayment plan selected by 
                the borrower under clause (ii) or (iii) of paragraph 
                (9)(A),'' before ``during any''; and
                    (D) in subparagraph (U)(iii)(I), by inserting 
                ``that originates or holds more than $5,000,000 in 
                loans made under this title for any fiscal year (except 
                that each lender described in section 
                435(d)(1)(A)(ii)(III) shall annually submit the results 
                of an audit required by this clause),'' before ``at 
                least once a year'';
            (2) in paragraph (7), by adding at the end the following:
            ``(D) There shall be excluded from the 6-month period that 
        begins on the date on which a student ceases to carry at least 
        one-half the normal full-time academic workload as described in 
        subparagraph (A)(i) any period not to exceed 3 years during 
        which a borrower who is a member of a reserve component of the 
        Armed Forces named in section 10101 of title 10, United States 
        Code, is called or ordered to active duty for a period of more 
        than 30 days (as defined in section 101(d)(2) of such title). 
        Such period of exclusion shall include the period necessary to 
        resume enrollment at the borrower's next available regular 
        enrollment period.''; and
            (3) by adding at the end the following:
            ``(9) Repayment plans.--
                    ``(A) Design and selection.--In accordance with 
                regulations promulgated by the Secretary, the lender 
                shall offer a borrower of a loan made under this part 
                the plans described in this subparagraph for repayment 
                of such loan, including principal and interest thereon. 
                Except as provided in paragraph (1)(L)(i), no plan may 
                require a borrower to repay a loan in less than 5 
                years. The borrower may choose from--
                            ``(i) a standard repayment plan, with a 
                        fixed annual repayment amount paid over a fixed 
                        period of time, not to exceed 10 years;
                            ``(ii) a graduated repayment plan paid over 
                        a fixed period of time, not to exceed 10 years;
                            ``(iii) an income-sensitive repayment plan, 
                        with income-sensitive repayment amounts paid 
                        over a fixed period of time, not to exceed 10 
                        years, except that the borrower's scheduled 
                        payments shall not be less than the amount of 
                        interest due; and
                            ``(iv) for first-time borrowers on or after 
                        the date of enactment of the Higher Education 
                        Amendments of 1998 with outstanding loans under 
                        this part totaling more than $30,000, an 
                        extended repayment plan, with a fixed annual or 
                        graduated repayment amount paid over an 
                        extended period of time, not to exceed 25 
                        years, except that the borrower shall repay 
                        annually a minimum amount determined in 
                        accordance with paragraph (2)(L).
                    ``(B) Lender selection of option if borrower does 
                not select.--If a borrower of a loan made under this 
                part does not select a repayment plan described in 
                subparagraph (A), the lender shall provide the borrower 
                with a repayment plan described in subparagraph (A)(i).
                    ``(C) Changes in selection.--The borrower of a loan 
                made under this part may change the borrower's 
                selection of a repayment plan under subparagraph (B), 
                as the case may be, under such conditions as may be 
                prescribed by the Secretary in regulation.
                    ``(D) Acceleration permitted.--Under any of the 
                plans described in this paragraph, the borrower shall 
                be entitled to accelerate, without penalty, repayment 
                on the borrower's loans under this part.''.
    (c) Guaranty Agreements for Reimbursing Losses.--Section 428(c) (20 
U.S.C. 1078(c)) is amended--
            (1) in paragraph (1)--
                    (A) in the fourth sentence of subparagraph (A), by 
                striking ``as reimbursement under this subsection shall 
                be equal to 98 percent'' and inserting ``as 
                reimbursement for loans for which the first 
                disbursement is made on or after the date of enactment 
                of the Higher Education Amendments of 1998 shall be 
                equal to 95 percent'';
                    (B) in subparagraph (B)--
                            (i) in clause (i), by striking ``88 percent 
                        of the amount of such excess'' and inserting 
                        ``85 percent of the amount of such excess for 
                        loans for which the first disbursement is made 
                        on or after the date of enactment of the Higher 
                        Education Amendments of 1998''; and
                            (ii) in clause (ii), by striking ``78 
                        percent of the amount of such excess'' and 
                        inserting ``75 percent of the amount of such 
                        excess for loans for which the first 
                        disbursement is made on or after the date of 
                        enactment of the Higher Education Amendments of 
                        1998'';
                    (C) in subparagraph (E)--
                            (i) in clause (i), by striking ``98 
                        percent'' and inserting ``95 percent'';
                            (ii) in clause (ii), by striking ``88 
                        percent'' and inserting ``85 percent''; and
                            (iii) in clause (iii), by striking ``78 
                        percent'' and inserting ``75 percent''; and
                    (D) in subparagraph (F)--
                            (i) in clause (i), by striking ``98 
                        percent'' and inserting ``95 percent''; and
                            (ii) in clause (ii), by striking ``88 
                        percent'' and inserting ``85 percent'';
            (2) in paragraph (2)--
                    (A) in subparagraph (A), by striking ``proof that 
                reasonable attempts were made'' and inserting ``proof 
                that the institution was contacted and other reasonable 
                attempts were made''; and
                    (B) in subparagraph (G), by striking ``certifies to 
                the Secretary that diligent attempts have been made'' 
                and inserting ``certifies to the Secretary that 
                diligent attempts, including contact with the 
                institution, have been made''.
            (3) in paragraph (3)--
                    (A) in subparagraph (A)(i), by inserting ``or 
                electronic'' after ``written'';
                    (B) in subparagraph (B), by striking ``and'' after 
                the semicolon;
                    (C) in subparagraph (C), by striking the period and 
                inserting ``; and''; and
                    (D) by inserting before the matter following 
                subparagraph (C) the following:
                    ``(D) shall contain provisions that specify that 
                forbearance for a period not to exceed 60 days may be 
                granted if the lender determines that such a suspension 
                of collection activity is warranted following a 
                borrower's request for forbearance in order to collect 
                or process appropriate supporting documentation related 
                to the request, and that during such period interest 
                shall not be capitalized.'';
            (4) by amending paragraph (6) to read as follows:
            ``(6) Secretary's equitable share.--For the purpose of 
        paragraph (2)(D), the Secretary's equitable share of payments 
        made by the borrower shall be that portion of the payments 
        remaining after the guaranty agency with which the Secretary 
        has an agreement under this subsection has deducted from such 
        payments--
                    ``(A) a percentage amount equal to the complement 
                of the reinsurance percentage in effect when payment 
                under the guaranty agreement was made with respect to 
                the loan; and
                    ``(B) an amount equal to 24 percent of such 
                payments for use in accordance with section 422B, 
                except that, beginning on September 30, 2003, this 
                subparagraph shall be applied by substituting `23 
                percent' for `24 percent'.'';
            (5) in paragraph (8)--
                    (A) by striking ``(A) If'' and inserting ``If''; 
                and
                    (B) by striking subparagraph (B); and
            (6) in paragraph (9)--
                    (A) in subparagraph (A), by striking ``maintain a 
                current minimum reserve level of at least .5 percent'' 
                and inserting ``maintain in the agency's Federal 
                Student Loan Reserve Fund established under section 
                422A a current minimum reserve level of at least 0.25 
                percent'';
                    (B) in subparagraph (C)--
                            (i) by striking ``80 percent'' and 
                        inserting ``78 percent'';
                            (ii) by striking ``, as appropriate,''; and
                            (iii) by striking ``30 working'' and 
                        inserting ``45 working'';
                    (C) in subparagraph (E)--
                            (i) in clause (iv), by inserting ``or'' 
                        after the semicolon;
                            (ii) in clause (v), by striking ``; or'' 
                        and inserting a period; and
                            (iii) by striking clause (vi);
                    (D) in subparagraph (F), by amending clause (vii) 
                to read as follows:
                    ``(vii) take any other action the Secretary 
                determines necessary to avoid disruption of the student 
                loan program, to ensure the continued availability of 
                loans made under this part to residents of each State 
                in which the guaranty agency did business, to ensure 
                the full honoring of all guarantees issued by the 
                guaranty agency prior to the Secretary's assumption of 
                the functions of such agency, and to ensure the proper 
                servicing of loans guaranteed by the guaranty agency 
                prior to the Secretary's assumption of the functions of 
                such agency.''; and
                    (E) in subparagraph (K), by striking ``and the 
                progress of the transition from the loan programs under 
                this part to the direct student loan programs under 
                part D of this title''.
    (d) Payment for Lender Referral Services.--Subsection (e) of 
section 428 (20 U.S.C. 1078) is repealed.
    (e) Payment of Certain Costs.--Subsection (f) of section 428 (20 
U.S.C. 1078) is amended to read as follows:
    ``(f) Payments of Certain Costs.--
            ``(1) Payment for certain activities.--
                    ``(A) In general.--The Secretary--
                            ``(i) for loans originated on or after 
                        October 1, 1998, and before October 1, 2003, 
                        and in accordance with the provisions of this 
                        paragraph, shall pay to each guaranty agency, a 
                        loan processing and issuance fee equal to 0.65 
                        percent of the total principal amount of the 
                        loans on which insurance was issued under this 
                        part during such fiscal year by such agency; 
                        and
                            ``(ii) for loans originated on or after 
                        October 1, 2003, and in accordance with the 
                        provisions of this paragraph, shall pay to each 
                        guaranty agency, a loan processing and issuance 
                        fee equal to 0.40 percent of the total 
                        principal amount of the loans on which 
                        insurance was issued under this part during 
                        such fiscal year by such agency.
                    ``(B) Payment.--The payment required by 
                subparagraph (A) shall be paid on a quarterly basis. 
                The guaranty agency shall be deemed to have a 
                contractual right against the United States to receive 
                payments according to the provisions of this 
                subparagraph. Payments shall be made promptly and 
                without administrative delay to any guaranty agency 
                submitting an accurate and complete application 
                therefore under this subparagraph.''.
    (f) Lenders-of-Last-Resort.--Paragraph (3) of section 428(j) (20 
U.S.C. 1078(j)) is amended--
            (1) in the paragraph heading, by striking ``during 
        transition to direct lending''; and
            (2) in subparagraph (A), by striking ``during the 
        transition from the Federal Family Education Loan Program under 
        this part to the Federal Direct Student Loan Program under part 
        D of this title'';
    (g) Default Aversion Assistance.--Subsection (l) of section 428 (20 
U.S.C. 1078) is amended to read as follows:
    ``(l) Default Aversion Assistance.--
            ``(1) Assistance required.--Upon receipt of a proper 
        request from the lender not earlier than the 60th nor later 
        than the 90th day of delinquency, a guaranty agency having an 
        agreement with the Secretary under subsection (c) shall engage 
        in default aversion activities designed to prevent the default 
        by a borrower on a loan covered by such agreement.
            ``(2) Default prevention fee required.--
                    ``(A) In general.--A guaranty agency, in accordance 
                with the provisions of this paragraph, may transfer 
                from the Federal Student Loan Reserve Fund to the 
                Agency Operating Fund a default prevention fee. Such 
                fee shall be paid for any loan on which a claim for 
                default has not been presented that the guaranty agency 
                successfully brings into current repayment status on or 
                before the 300th day after the loan becomes 60 days 
                delinquent.
                    ``(B) Amount.--The default prevention fee shall be 
                equal to 1 percent of the total unpaid principal and 
                accrued interest on the loan calculated at the time the 
                request is submitted by the lender. Such fee shall not 
                be paid more than once on any loan for which the 
                guaranty agency averts the default unless the borrower 
                remained current in payments for at least 24 months 
                prior to the subsequent delinquency. A guaranty agency 
                may transfer such fees earned under this subsection not 
                more frequently than monthly.
                    ``(C) Definition of current repayment status.--For 
                the purpose of this paragraph, the term `current 
                repayment status' means that the borrower is not 
                delinquent, in any respect, in the payment of principal 
                and interest on the loan at the time the guaranty 
                agency qualifies for the default prevention fee.''.
    (h) State Share of Default Costs.--Subsection (n) of section 428 
(20 U.S.C. 1078) is repealed.

SEC. 427. VOLUNTARY FLEXIBLE AGREEMENTS WITH GUARANTY AGENCIES.

    Part B of title IV (20 U.S.C. 1071 et seq.) is amended by inserting 
after section 428 (20 U.S.C. 1078) the following:

``SEC. 428A. VOLUNTARY FLEXIBLE AGREEMENTS WITH GUARANTY AGENCIES.

    ``(a) Voluntary Agreements.--
            ``(1) Authority.--The Secretary may enter into a voluntary, 
        flexible agreement, subject to paragraph (2), with guaranty 
        agencies under this section, in lieu of agreements with a 
        guaranty agency under subsections (b) and (c) of section 428. 
        The Secretary may waive or modify any requirement under such 
        subsections, except that the Secretary may not waive any 
        statutory requirement pertaining to the terms and conditions 
        attached to student loans, default claim payments made to 
        lenders, or the prohibitions on inducements contained in 
        section 428(b)(3).
            ``(2) Eligibility.--During fiscal years 1999, 2000, and 
        2001, the Secretary may enter into a voluntary, flexible 
        agreement with not more than 6 guaranty agencies that had 1 or 
        more agreements with the Secretary under subsections (b) and 
        (c) of section 428 as of the day before the date of enactment 
        of the Higher Education Amendments of 1998. Beginning in fiscal 
        year 2002, any guaranty agency or consortium thereof may enter 
        into a similar agreement with the Secretary.
            ``(3) Report required.--Not later than September 30, 2001, 
        the Secretary shall report to the Committee on Labor and Human 
        Resources of the Senate and the Committee on Education and the 
        Workforce of the House of Representatives regarding the impact 
        that the voluntary flexible agreements have had upon program 
        integrity, program and cost efficiencies, and the availability 
        and delivery of student financial aid. Such report shall 
        include--
                    ``(A) a description of each voluntary flexible 
                agreement and the performance goals established by the 
                Secretary for each agreement;
                    ``(B) a list of participating guaranty agencies and 
                the specific statutory or regulatory waivers provided 
                to each guaranty agency;
                    ``(C) a description of the standards by which each 
                agency's performance under the agency's voluntary 
                flexible agreement was assessed and the degree to which 
                each agency achieved the performance standards; and
                    ``(D) an analysis of the fees paid by the 
                Secretary, and the costs and efficiencies achieved 
                under each voluntary agreement.
    ``(b) Terms of Agreement.--An agreement between the Secretary and a 
guaranty agency under this section--
            ``(1) shall be developed by the Secretary, in consultation 
        with the guaranty agency, on a case-by case basis;
            ``(2) may be secured by the parties;
            ``(3) may only include provisions--
                    ``(A) specifying the responsibilities of the 
                guaranty agency under the agreement, with respect to--
                            ``(i) administering the issuance of 
                        insurance on loans made under this part on 
                        behalf of the Secretary;
                            ``(ii) monitoring insurance commitments 
                        made under this part;
                            ``(iii) default aversion activities;
                            ``(iv) review of default claims made by 
                        lenders;
                            ``(v) payment of default claims;
                            ``(vi) collection of defaulted loans;
                            ``(vii) adoption of internal systems of 
                        accounting and auditing that are acceptable to 
                        the Secretary, and reporting the result thereof 
                        to the Secretary in a timely manner, and on an 
                        accurate, and auditable basis;
                            ``(viii) timely and accurate collection and 
                        reporting of such other data as the Secretary 
                        may require to carry out the purposes of the 
                        programs under this title;
                            ``(ix) monitoring of institutions and 
                        lenders participating in the program under this 
                        part; and
                            ``(x) informational outreach to schools and 
                        students in support of access to higher 
                        education;
                    ``(B) regarding the fees the Secretary shall pay, 
                in lieu of revenues that the guaranty agency may 
                otherwise receive under this part, to the guaranty 
                agency under the agreement, and other funds that the 
                guaranty agency may receive or retain under the 
                agreement, except that in no case may the cost to the 
                Secretary of the agreement, as reasonably projected by 
                the Secretary, exceed the cost to the Secretary, as 
                similarly projected, in the absence of the agreement;
                    ``(C) regarding the use of net revenues, as 
                described in the agreement under this section, for such 
                other activities in support of postsecondary education 
                as may be agreed to by the Secretary and the guaranty 
                agency;
                    ``(D) regarding the standards by which the guaranty 
                agency's performance of the agency's responsibilities 
                under the agreement will be assessed, and the 
                consequences for a guaranty agency's failure to achieve 
                a specified level of performance on one or more 
                performance standards;
                    ``(E) regarding the circumstances in which a 
                guaranty agency's agreement under this section may be 
                ended in advance of the agreement's expiration date;
                    ``(F) regarding such other businesses, previously 
                purchased or developed with reserve funds, that relate 
                to the program under this part and in which the 
                Secretary permits the guaranty agency to engage; and
                    ``(G) such other provisions as the Secretary may 
                determine to be necessary to protect the United States 
                from the risk of unreasonable loss and to promote the 
                purposes of this part;
            ``(4) shall provide for uniform lender participation with 
        the guaranty agency under the terms of the agreement; and
            ``(5) shall not prohibit or restrict borrowers from 
        selecting a lender of the borrower's choosing, subject to the 
        prohibitions and restrictions applicable to the selection under 
        this Act.
    ``(c) Public Notice.--
            ``(1) In general.--The Secretary shall publish in the 
        Federal Register a notice to all guaranty agencies that sets 
        forth--
                    ``(A) an invitation for the guaranty agencies to 
                enter into agreements under this section; and
                    ``(B) the criteria that the Secretary will use for 
                selecting the guaranty agencies with which the 
                Secretary will enter into agreements under this 
                section.
            ``(2) Agreement notice.--The Secretary shall notify the 
        Chairperson and the Ranking Minority Members of the Committee 
        on Labor and Human Resources of the Senate, and the Committee 
        on Education and Workforce of the House of Representatives, and 
        shall publish a notice in the Federal Register, with a request 
        for public comment, at least 30 days prior to concluding an 
        agreement under this section. The notice shall contain--
                    ``(A) a description of the voluntary flexible 
                agreement and the performance goals established by the 
                Secretary for the agreement;
                    ``(B) a list of participating guaranty agencies and 
                the specific statutory or regulatory waivers provided 
                to each guaranty agency;
                    ``(C) a description of the standards by which each 
                guaranty agency's performance under the agreement will 
                be assessed; and
                    ``(D) a description of the fees that will be paid 
                to each participating guaranty agency.
            ``(3) Public availability.--The text of any voluntary 
        flexible agreement, and any subsequent revisions, shall be 
        readily available to the public.
            ``(4) Modification notice.--The Secretary shall notify the 
        Chairperson and the Ranking Minority Member of the Committee on 
        Labor and Human Resources of the Senate, and the Committee on 
        Education and Workforce of the House of Representatives 30 days 
        prior to any modifications to an agreement under this section.
    ``(d) Termination.--At the expiration or early termination of an 
agreement under this section, the Secretary shall reinstate the 
guaranty agency's prior agreements under subsections (b) and (c) of 
section 428, subject only to such additional requirements as the 
Secretary determines to be necessary in order to ensure the efficient 
transfer of responsibilities between the agreement under this section 
and the agreements under subsections (b) and (c) of section 428, and 
including the guaranty agency's compliance with reserve requirements 
under sections 422 and 428.''.

SEC. 428. FEDERAL PLUS LOANS.

    Section 428B (20 U.S.C. 1078-2) is amended--
            (1) by amending subsection (a) to read as follows:
    ``(a) Authority To Borrow.--
            ``(1) Authority and eligibility.--Parents of a dependent 
        student shall be eligible to borrow funds under this section in 
        amounts specified in subsection (b), if--
                    ``(A) the parents do not have an adverse credit 
                history as determined pursuant to regulations 
                promulgated by the Secretary; and
                    ``(B) the parents meet such other eligibility 
                criteria as the Secretary may establish by regulation, 
                after consultation with guaranty agencies, eligible 
                lenders, and other organizations involved in student 
                financial assistance.
            ``(2) Terms, conditions, and benefits.--Except as provided 
        in subsections (c), (d), and (e), loans made under this section 
        shall have the same terms, conditions, and benefits as all 
        other loans made under this part.
            ``(3) Special rule.--Whenever necessary to carry out the 
        provisions of this section, the terms ``student'' and 
        ``borrower'' as used in this part shall include a parent 
        borrower under this section.''; and
            (2) by adding at the end the following:
    ``(f) Verification of Immigration Status and Social Security 
Number.--A parent who wishes to borrow funds under this section shall 
be subject to verification of the parent's--
            ``(1) immigration status in the same manner as immigration 
        status is verified for students under section 484(g); and
            ``(2) social security number in the same manner as social 
        security numbers are verified for students under section 
        484(p).''.

SEC. 429. FEDERAL CONSOLIDATION LOANS.

    (a) In General.--Section 428C(a)(3) (20 U.S.C. 1078-3(a)(3)) is 
amended--
            (1) by amending subparagraph (A) to read as follows: ``(A) 
        For the purpose of this section, the term `eligible borrower' 
        means a borrower who--
                    ``(i) is not subject to a judgment secured through 
                litigation or an order for wage garnishment under 
                section 488A; or
                    ``(ii) at the time of application for a 
                consolidation loan--
                            ``(I) is in repayment status;
                            ``(II) is in a grace period preceding 
                        repayment; or
                            ``(III) is a defaulted borrower who has 
                        made arrangements to repay the obligation on 
                        the defaulted loans satisfactory to the holders 
                        of the defaulted loans.''; and
            (2) in subparagraph (B)(i)--
                    (A) in subclause (I), by striking ``and'' after the 
                semicolon;
                    (B) by redesignating subclause (II) as subclause 
                (III);
                    (C) by inserting after subclause (I) the following:
                    ``(II) with respect to eligible student loans 
                received prior to the date of consolidation that the 
                borrower may wish to include with eligible loans 
                specified in subclause (I) in a later consolidation 
                loan; and''; and
                    (D) in subclause (III) (as redesignated by 
                subparagraph (B)--
                            (i) by striking ``that loans'' and 
                        inserting ``with respect to loans''; and
                            (ii) by inserting ``that'' before ``may be 
                        added''.
    (b) Date Change.--Section 428C(e) (20 U.S.C. 1078-3(e)) is amended 
by striking ``September 30, 2002'' and inserting ``September 30, 
2004''.

SEC. 430. REQUIREMENTS FOR DISBURSEMENTS OF STUDENT LOANS.

    (a) In General.--Section 428G (20 U.S.C. 1078G) is amended--
            (1) in subsection (a)(1), by striking ``The proceeds'' and 
        inserting ``Except for a loan made for the final period of 
        enrollment, that is less than an academic year, in a student's 
        baccalaureate program of study, at an institution with a cohort 
        default rate (as calculated under section 435(m)) that is 5 
        percent or less, the proceeds'';
            (2) in subsection (b)(1), by striking ``The first'' and 
        inserting ``Except for a loan made to a student borrower 
        entering an institution with a cohort default rate (as 
        calculated under section 435(m)) of less than 5 percent, the 
        first''; and
            (3) in subsection (e)--
                    (A) by striking ``or made'' and inserting ``, 
                made''; and
                    (B) by inserting ``, or made to a student to cover 
                the cost of attendance in a program of study abroad 
                approved by the home eligible institution if the home 
                eligible institution has a cohort default rate (as 
                calculated under section 435(m)) of less than 5 
                percent'' before the period.
    (b) Effective Date.--The amendment made by subsection (a)(2) shall 
be effective during the period beginning on October 1, 1998, and ending 
on September 30, 2002.

SEC. 431. DEFAULT REDUCTION PROGRAM.

    The heading for subsection (b) of section 428F (20 U.S.C. 1078-6) 
is amended by striking ``Special Rule'' and inserting ``Satisfactory 
Repayment Arrangements To Renew Eligibility''.

SEC. 432. UNSUBSIDIZED LOANS.

    (a) In General.--Section 428H (20 U.S.C. 1078-8) is amended--
            (1) by amending subsection (b) to read as follows:
    ``(b) Eligible Borrowers.--Any student meeting the requirements for 
student eligibility under section 484 (including graduate and 
professional students as defined in regulations promulgated by the 
Secretary) shall be entitled to borrow an unsubsidized Stafford loan if 
the eligible institution at which the student has been accepted for 
enrollment, or at which the student is in attendance, has--
            ``(1) determined and documented the student's need for the 
        loan based on the student's estimated cost of attendance (as 
        determined under section 472) and the student's estimated 
        financial assistance, including a loan which qualifies for 
        interest subsidy payments under section 428; and
            ``(2) provided the lender a statement--
                    ``(A) certifying the eligibility of the student to 
                receive a loan under this section and the amount of the 
                loan for which such student is eligible, in accordance 
                with subsection (c); and
                    ``(B) setting forth a schedule for disbursement of 
                the proceeds of the loan in installments, consistent 
                with the requirements of section 428G.'';
            (2) in subsection (d)--
                    (A) in paragraph (2)--
                            (i) in the matter preceding subparagraph 
                        (A)--
                                    (I) by inserting ``, as defined in 
                                section 481(d)(2),'' after ``academic 
                                year''; and
                                    (II) by striking ``or in any period 
                                of 7 consecutive months, whichever is 
                                longer,'';
                            (ii) in subparagraph (C), by inserting 
                        ``and'' after the semicolon; and
                            (iii) by inserting before the matter 
                        following subparagraph (C) the following:
                    ``(D) in the case of a student enrolled in 
                coursework specified in sections 484(b)(3)(B) and 
                484(b)(4)(B)--
                            ``(i) $4,000 for coursework necessary for 
                        enrollment in an undergraduate degree or 
                        certificate program, and $5,000 for coursework 
                        necessary for enrollment in a graduate or 
                        professional program; and
                            ``(ii) $5,000 for coursework necessary for 
                        a professional credential or certification from 
                        a State required for employment as a teacher in 
                        an elementary or secondary school;''; and
                    (B) in paragraph (3), by adding at the end the 
                following: ``The maximum aggregate amount shall not 
                include interest capitalized from an in-school 
                period.'';
            (3) in subsection (e)--
                    (A) by amending paragraph (2) to read as follows:
            ``(2) Capitalization of interest.--Interest on loans made 
        under this section for which payments of principal are not 
        required during the in-school and grace periods or for which 
        payments are deferred under sections 427(a)(2)(C) and 
        428(b)(1)(M) shall, if agreed upon by the borrower and the 
        lender--
                    ``(A) be paid monthly or quarterly; or
                    ``(B) be added to the principal amount of the loan 
                by the lender only--
                            ``(i) when the loan enters repayment;
                            ``(ii) at the expiration of a grace period, 
                        in the case of a loan that qualifies for a 
                        grace period;
                            ``(iii) at the expiration of a period of 
                        deferment; or
                            ``(iv) when the borrower defaults.''; and
                    (B) in paragraph (6), by striking ``10 year 
                repayment period under section 428(b)(1)(D)'' and 
                inserting ``repayment period under section 428(b)(9)''.
    (b) Sense of the Senate on Loan Limit Flexibility.--
            (1) Findings.--The Senate finds that--
                    (A) due to the annual borrowing ceilings on the 
                Federal student loan programs, increasing numbers of 
                needy students are borrowing from more expensive 
                private sector loan programs than from the Federal loan 
                programs;
                    (B) according to the College Board, in academic 
                year 1996-1997, students borrowed approximately 
                $1,200,000,000 from private sector loan programs;
                    (C) the alternative private sector loan programs 
                are not only more expensive, but the interest rates are 
                not capped, leaving students vulnerable to higher 
                monthly payments when interest rates increase; and
                    (D) with more flexible Federal annual loan 
                ceilings, students could be kept in Federal student 
                loan programs, thereby making available to the students 
                the debt management advantages of loan consolidation 
                and alternative repayment options that are available 
                under Federal student loan programs, and lowering the 
                costs of monthly payments.
            (2) Sense of the senate.--It is the sense of the Senate 
        that Congress should consider the growing problem described in 
        paragraph (1) by continuing to examine the potential for adding 
        borrowing flexibility to the annual, but not the aggregate, 
        amounts that both undergraduate and graduate students are 
        allowed to borrow under section 428H of the Higher Education 
        Act of 1965.

SEC. 433. LOAN FORGIVENESS FOR TEACHERS.

    Section 428J (20 U.S.C. 1078-10) is amended to read as follows:

``SEC. 428J. LOAN FORGIVENESS FOR TEACHERS.

    ``(a) Statement of Purpose.--It is the purpose of this section to 
encourage individuals to enter and continue in the teaching profession.
    ``(b) Program Authorized.--The Secretary is authorized to carry out 
a program, through the holder of the loan, of assuming the obligation 
to repay a qualifying loan made under section 428 that is eligible for 
interest subsidy, for any new borrower on or after October 1, 1998, 
who--
            ``(1) has been employed as a full-time teacher for 3 
        consecutive complete school years--
                    ``(A) in a school that qualifies under section 
                465(a)(2)(A) for loan cancellation for Perkins loan 
                recipients who teach in such schools;
                    ``(B) if employed as a secondary school teacher, is 
                teaching a subject area that is relevant to the 
                borrower's academic major as certified by the chief 
                administrative officer of the public or nonprofit 
                private secondary school in which the borrower is 
                employed; and
                    ``(C) if employed as an elementary school teacher, 
                has demonstrated, in accordance with State teacher 
                certification or licensing requirements and as 
                certified by the chief administrative officer of the 
                public or nonprofit private elementary school in which 
                the borrower is employed, knowledge and teaching skills 
                in reading, writing, mathematics and other areas of the 
                elementary school curriculum; and
            ``(2) is not in default on a loan for which the borrower 
        seeks forgiveness.
    ``(c) Qualifying Loans.--For purposes of this section, a loan is a 
qualifying loan if--
            ``(1) the loan was obtained to cover the cost of 
        instruction for an academic year after the first and second 
        years of undergraduate education; and
            ``(2) the loan did not cover the costs of instruction for 
        more than 2 academic years, or 3 academic years in the case of 
        a program of instruction normally requiring 5 years to 
        complete.
    ``(d) Regulations.--The Secretary is authorized to issue such 
regulations as may be necessary to carry out the provisions of this 
section.
    ``(e) Loan Repayment During Continuing Teaching Service.--
            ``(1) In general.--The Secretary shall assume the 
        obligation to repay through reimbursement to the holder--
                    ``(A) 30 percent of the total outstanding amount 
                and applicable interest of subsidized Federal Stafford 
                loans that are qualifying loans and are owed by the 
                student borrower after the completion of the fourth or 
                fifth complete school year of service described in 
                subsection (b);
                    ``(B) 40 percent of such total amount after the 
                completion of the sixth complete school year of such 
                service; and
                    ``(C) a total amount for any borrower that shall 
                not exceed $8,000.
            ``(2) Construction.--Nothing in this section shall be 
        construed to authorize any refunding of any repayment of a 
        loan.
    ``(f) List.--If the list of schools in which a teacher may perform 
service pursuant to subsection (b) is not available before May 1 of any 
year, the Secretary may use the list for the year preceding the year 
for which the determination is made to make such service determination.
    ``(g) Continued Eligibility.--Any teacher who performs service in a 
school that--
            ``(1) meets the requirements of subsection (b)(1)(A) in any 
        year during such service; and
            ``(2) in a subsequent year fails to meet the requirements 
        of such subsection, may continue to teach in such school and 
        shall be eligible for loan forgiveness pursuant to subsection 
        (b).''.

SEC. 434. LOAN FORGIVENESS FOR CHILD CARE PROVIDERS.

    Part B (20 U.S.C. 1071 et seq.) is amended by inserting after 
section 428J (as added by section 433) (20 U.S.C. 1078-10) the 
following:

``SEC. 428K. LOAN FORGIVENESS FOR CHILD CARE PROVIDERS.

    ``(a) Purpose.--It is the purpose of this section--
            ``(1) to bring more highly trained individuals into the 
        early child care profession; and
            ``(2) to keep more highly trained child care providers in 
        the early child care field for longer periods of time.
    ``(b) Definitions.--In this section:
            ``(1) Child care facility.--The term `child care facility' 
        means a facility, including a home, that--
                    ``(A) provides child care services; and
                    ``(B) meets applicable State or local government 
                licensing, certification, approval, or registration 
                requirements, if any.
            ``(2) Child care services.--The term `child care services' 
        means activities and services provided for the education and 
        care of children from birth through age 5 by an individual who 
        has a degree in early childhood education.
            ``(3) Degree.--The term `degree' means an associate's or 
        bachelor's degree awarded by an institution of higher 
        education.
            ``(4) Early childhood education.--The term `early childhood 
        education' means education in the areas of early child 
        education, child care, or any other educational area related to 
        child care that the Secretary determines appropriate.
            ``(5) Institution of higher education.--The term 
        `institution of higher education' has the meaning given the 
        term in section 101.
    ``(c) Demonstration Program.--
            ``(1) In general.--The Secretary may carry out a 
        demonstration program of assuming the obligation to repay, 
        pursuant to subsection (d), a loan made, insured or guaranteed 
        under this part or part D (excluding loans made under sections 
        428B and 428C) for any new borrower after the date of enactment 
        of the Higher Education Amendments of 1998, who--
                    ``(A) completes a degree in early childhood 
                education;
                    ``(B) obtains employment in a child care facility; 
                and
                    ``(C) has worked full time for the 2 consecutive 
                years preceding the year for which the determination is 
                made as a child care provider in a low-income 
                community.
            ``(2) Low-income community.--For the purposes of this 
        subsection, the term `low-income community' means a community 
        in which 70 percent of households within the community earn 
        less than 85 percent of the State median household income.
            ``(3) Award basis; priority.--
                    ``(A) Award basis.--Subject to subparagraph (B), 
                loan repayment under this section shall be on a first-
                come, first-served basis and subject to the 
                availability of appropriations.
                    ``(B) Priority.--The Secretary shall give priority 
                in providing loan repayment under this section for a 
                fiscal year to student borrowers who received loan 
                repayment under this section for the preceding fiscal 
                year.
            ``(4) Regulations.--The Secretary is authorized to 
        prescribe such regulations as may be necessary to carry out the 
        provisions of this section.
    ``(d) Loan Repayment.--
            ``(1) In general.--The Secretary shall assume the 
        obligation to repay--
                    ``(A) after the second consecutive year of 
                employment described in subparagraphs (B) and (C) of 
                subsection (c)(1), 20 percent of the total amount of 
                all loans made after date of enactment of the Higher 
                Education Amendments of 1998, to a student under this 
                part or part D;
                    ``(B) after the third consecutive year of such 
                employment, 20 percent of the total amount of all such 
                loans; and
                    ``(C) after each of the fourth and fifth 
                consecutive years of such employment, 30 percent of the 
                total amount of all such loans.
            ``(2) Construction.--Nothing in this section shall be 
        construed to authorize the refunding of any repayment of a loan 
        made under this part or part D.
            ``(3) Interest.--If a portion of a loan is repaid by the 
        Secretary under this section for any year, the proportionate 
        amount of interest on such loan which accrues for such year 
        shall be repaid by the Secretary.
            ``(4) Special rule.--In the case where a student borrower 
        who is not participating in loan repayment pursuant to this 
        section returns to an institution of higher education after 
        graduation from an institution of higher education for the 
        purpose of obtaining a degree in early childhood education, the 
        Secretary is authorized to assume the obligation to repay the 
        total amount of loans made under this part or part D incurred 
        for a maximum of two academic years in returning to an 
        institution of higher education for the purpose of obtaining a 
        degree in early childhood education. Such loans shall only be 
        repaid for borrowers who qualify for loan repayment pursuant to 
        the provisions of this section, and shall be repaid in 
        accordance with the provisions of paragraph (1).
            ``(5) Ineligibility of national service award recipients.--
        No student borrower may, for the same volunteer service, 
        receive a benefit under both this section and subtitle D of 
        title I of the National and Community Service Act of 1990 (42 
        U.S.C. 12601 et seq.).
    ``(e) Repayment to Eligible Lenders.--The Secretary shall pay to 
each eligible lender or holder for each fiscal year an amount equal to 
the aggregate amount of loans which are subject to repayment pursuant 
to this section for such year.
    ``(f) Application for Repayment.--
            ``(1) In general.--Each eligible individual desiring loan 
        repayment under this section shall submit a complete and 
        accurate application to the Secretary at such time, in such 
        manner, and containing such information as the Secretary may 
        require.
            ``(2) Conditions.--An eligible individual may apply for 
        loan repayment under this section after completing each year of 
        qualifying employment. The borrower shall receive forbearance 
        while engaged in qualifying employment unless the borrower is 
        in deferment while so engaged.
    ``(g) Evaluation.--
            ``(1) In general.--The Secretary shall conduct, by grant or 
        contract, an independent national evaluation of the impact of 
        the demonstration program assisted under this section on the 
        field of early childhood education.
            ``(2) Competitive basis.--The grant or contract described 
        in subsection (b) shall be awarded on a competitive basis.
            ``(3) Contents.--The evaluation described in this 
        subsection shall--
                    ``(A) determine the number of individuals who were 
                encouraged by the demonstration program assisted under 
                this section to pursue early childhood education;
                    ``(B) determine the number of individuals who 
                remain employed in a child care facility as a result of 
                participation in the program;
                    ``(C) identify the barriers to the effectiveness of 
                the program;
                    ``(D) assess the cost-effectiveness of the program 
                in improving the quality of--
                            ``(i) early childhood education; and
                            ``(ii) child care services;
                    ``(E) identify the reasons why participants in the 
                program have chosen to take part in the program;
                    ``(F) identify the number of individuals 
                participating in the program who received an 
                associate's degree and the number of such individuals 
                who received a bachelor's degree; and
                    ``(G) identify the number of years each individual 
                participates in the program.
            ``(4) Interim and final evaluation reports.--The Secretary 
        shall prepare and submit to the President and the Congress such 
        interim reports regarding the evaluation described in this 
        subsection as the Secretary deems appropriate, and shall 
        prepare and so submit a final report regarding the evaluation 
        by January 1, 2002.
    ``(h) Authorization of Appropriations.--There are authorized to be 
appropriated to carry out this section $10,000,000 for fiscal year 
1999, and such sums as may be necessary for each of the 4 succeeding 
fiscal years.''.

SEC. 435. NOTICE TO SECRETARY AND PAYMENT OF LOSS.

    The third sentence of section 430(a) (20 U.S.C. 1080(a)) is amended 
by inserting ``the institution was contacted and other'' after ``submit 
proof that''.

SEC. 436. COMMON FORMS AND FORMATS.

    Section 432 (20 U.S.C. 1082) is amended--
            (1) in subsection (m)(1)--
                    (A) in subparagraph (A), by striking ``a common 
                application form and promissory note'' and inserting 
                ``common application forms and promissory notes, or 
                master promissory notes,'';
                    (B) by striking subparagraph (C);
                    (C) by redesignating subparagraph (D) as 
                subparagraph (C); and
                    (D) in subparagraph (C) (as redesignated by 
                subparagraph (C))--
                            (i) by inserting ``, application and 
                        other'' after ``electronic''; and
                            (ii) by adding at the end the following: 
                        ``Guaranty agencies, borrowers, and lenders may 
                        use electronically printed versions of common 
                        forms approved for use by the Secretary.''; and
            (2) in subsection (p), by striking ``State postsecondary 
        reviewing entities designated under subpart 1 of part H,''.

SEC. 437. STUDENT LOAN INFORMATION BY ELIGIBLE LENDERS.

    Section 433 (20 U.S.C. 1083) is amended--
            (1) in subsection (a), by amending the matter preceding 
        paragraph (1) to read as follows:
    ``(a) Required Disclosure Before Disbursement.--Each eligible 
lender shall, at or prior to the time such lender disburses a loan that 
is insured or guaranteed under this part (other than a loan made under 
section 428C), provide thorough and accurate loan information on such 
loan to the borrower. Any disclosure required by this subsection may be 
made by an eligible lender by written or electronic means, including as 
part of the application material provided to the borrower, as part of 
the promissory note evidencing the loan, or on a separate written form 
provided to the borrower. Each lender shall provide a telephone number, 
and may provide an electronic address, to each borrower through which 
additional loan information can be obtained. The disclosure shall 
include--''; and
            (2) in subsection (b), by amending the matter preceding 
        paragraph (1) to read as follows:
    ``(b) Required Disclosure Before Repayment.--Each eligible lender 
shall, at or prior to the start of the repayment period of the student 
borrower on loans made, insured, or guaranteed under this part, 
disclose to the borrower by written or electronic means the information 
required under this subsection. Each eligible lender shall provide a 
telephone number, and may provide an electronic address, to each 
borrower through which additional loan information can be obtained. For 
any loan made, insured, or guaranteed under this part, other than a 
loan made under section 428B or 428C, such disclosure required by this 
subsection shall be made not less than 30 days nor more than 240 days 
before the first payment on the loan is due from the borrower. The 
disclosure shall include--''.

SEC. 438. DEFINITIONS.

    (a) Eligible Institution.--Section 435(a) (20 U.S.C. 1085(a)) is 
amended--
            (1) in paragraph (2)--
                    (A) by adding after the matter following 
                subparagraph (A)(ii) the following:
        ``If an institution continues to participate in a program under 
        this part, and the institution's appeal of the loss of 
        eligibility is unsuccessful, the institution shall be required 
        to pay to the Secretary an amount equal to the amount of 
        interest, special allowance, reinsurance, and any related 
        payments made by the Secretary (or which the Secretary is 
        obligated to make) with respect to loans made under this part 
        to students attending, or planning to attend, that institution 
        during the pendency of such appeal. In order to continue to 
        participate during an appeal under this paragraph, the 
        institution shall provide a letter of credit in favor of the 
        Secretary or other third-party financial guarantees 
        satisfactory to the Secretary in an amount determined by the 
        Secretary to be sufficient to satisfy the institution's 
        potential liability on such loans under the preceding 
        sentence.''; and
                    (B) by amending subparagraph (C) to read as 
                follows:
            ``(C)(i) This paragraph shall not apply to any institution 
        described in clause (ii), and any such institution that exceeds 
        the threshold percentage in subparagraph (A)(ii) for 2 
        consecutive years shall submit to the Secretary a default 
        management plan satisfactory to the Secretary and containing 
        criteria designed, in accordance with the regulations of the 
        Secretary, to demonstrate continuous improvement by the 
        institution in the institution's cohort default rate. If the 
        institution fails to submit the required plan, or to satisfy 
        the criteria in the plan, the institution shall be subject to a 
        loss of eligibility in accordance with this paragraph, except 
        as the Secretary may otherwise specify in regulations.
            ``(ii) An institution referred to in clause (i) is--
                    ``(I) a part B institution within the meaning of 
                section 322(2);
                    ``(II) a Tribally Controlled College or University 
                within the meaning of section 2(a)(4) of the Tribally 
                Controlled College or University Assistance Act of 
                1978; or
                    ``(III) a Navajo Community College under the Navajo 
                Community College Act.'';
            (2) in the matter following subparagraph (C)--
                    (A) by inserting ``for a reasonable period of time, 
                not to exceed 30 days,'' after ``access''; and
                    (B) by striking ``of the affected guaranty agencies 
                and loan servicers for a reasonable period of time, not 
                to exceed 30 days'' and inserting ``used by a guaranty 
                agency in determining whether to pay a claim on a 
                defaulted loan''; and
            (3) by adding at the end the following:
            ``(4) Participation rate index.--
                    ``(A) In general.--An institution that demonstrates 
                to the Secretary that the institution's participation 
                rate index is equal to or less than 0.0375 for any of 
                the 3 applicable participation rate indices shall not 
                be subject to paragraph (2). The participation rate 
                index shall be determined by multiplying the 
                institution's cohort default rate for loans under part 
                B or D, or weighted average cohort default rate for 
                loans under parts B and D, by the percentage of the 
                institution's regular students, enrolled on at least a 
                half-time basis, who received a loan made under part B 
                or D for a 12-month period ending during the 6 months 
                immediately preceding the fiscal year for which the 
                cohort of borrowers used to calculate the institution's 
                cohort default rate is determined.
                    ``(B) Data.--An institution shall provide the 
                Secretary with sufficient data to determine the 
                institution's participation rate index within 30 days 
                after receiving an initial notification of the 
                institution's draft cohort default rate.
                    ``(C) Notification.--Prior to publication of a 
                final cohort default rate for an institution that 
                provides the data described in subparagraph (B), the 
                Secretary shall notify the institution of the 
                institution's compliance or noncompliance with 
                subparagraph (A).''.
    (b) Effective Date.--The amendment made by subsection (a)(1)(B) 
shall be effective during the period beginning on the date of enactment 
of this Act and ending on September 30, 2002.
    (c) Eligible Lender.--Section 435(d)(1)(A)(ii) (20 U.S.C. 
1085(d)(1)(A)(ii) is amended--
            (1) by striking ``or'' after ``1992,''; and
            (2) by inserting before the semicolon the following: ``, or 
        (III) it is a bank (as defined in section 3(a)(1) of the 
        Federal Deposit Insurance Act (12 U.S.C. 1813(a)(1)) that is a 
        wholly owned subsidiary of a nonprofit foundation, the 
        foundation is described in section 501(c)(3) of the Internal 
        Revenue Code of 1986 and exempt from taxation under section 
        501(1) of such Code, and the bank makes loans under this part 
        only to undergraduate students who are age 22 or younger and 
        has a portfolio of such loans that is not more than 
        $5,000,000''.
    (d) Definition of Default.--
            (1) Amendment.--Section 435(l) (20 U.S.C. 1085l) is 
        amended--
                    (A) by striking ``180 days'' and inserting ``270 
                days''; and
                    (B) by striking ``240 days'' and inserting ``330 
                days''.
            (2) Effective date.--The amendment made by paragraph (1) 
        shall apply with respect to loans for which the first day of 
        delinquency occurs on or after the date of enactment of this 
        Act.
    (e) Cohort Default Rate.--Section 435(m)(1)(B) (20 U.S.C. 
1085(m)(1)(B)) is amended by striking ``insurance, and, in considering 
appeals with respect to cohort default rates pursuant to subsection 
(a)(3), exclude'' and inserting ``insurance. In considering appeals 
with respect to cohort default rates pursuant to subsection (a)(3), the 
Secretary shall exclude, from the calculation of the number of students 
who entered repayment and from the calculation of the number of 
students who default,''.
    (f) Publication Date.--Section 435(m)(4) (20 U.S.C. 1085(m)(4)) is 
amended by adding at the end the following:
            ``(D) The Secretary shall publish the report described in 
        subparagraph (C) by September 30 of each year.''.

SEC. 439. STUDY OF THE EFFECTIVENESS OF COHORT DEFAULT RATES FOR 
              INSTITUTIONS WITH FEW STUDENT LOAN BORROWERS.

    Part A of title IV (20 U.S.C. 1071 et seq.) is amended by adding 
after section 435 the following:

``SEC. 435A. STUDY OF THE EFFECTIVENESS OF COHORT DEFAULT RATES FOR 
              INSTITUTIONS WITH FEW STUDENT LOAN BORROWERS.

    ``(a) Study Required.--The Secretary shall conduct a study of the 
effectiveness of cohort default rates as an indicator of administrative 
capability and program quality for institutions of higher education at 
which less than 15 percent of students eligible to borrow participate 
in the Federal student loan programs under this title and fewer than 30 
borrowers enter repayment in any fiscal year. At a minimum, the study 
shall include--
            ``(1) identification of the institutions included in the 
        study and of the student populations the institutions serve;
            ``(2) analysis of cohort default rates as indicators of 
        administrative shortcomings and program quality at the 
        institutions;
            ``(3) analysis of the effectiveness of cohort default rates 
        as a means to prevent fraud and abuse in the programs assisted 
        under this title;
            ``(4) analysis of the extent to which the institutions with 
        high cohort default rates are no longer participants in the 
        Federal student loan programs under this title; and
            ``(5) analysis of the costs incurred by the Department for 
        the calculation, publication, correction, and appeal of cohort 
        default rates for the institutions in relation to any benefits 
        to taxpayers.
    ``(b) Consultation.--In conducting the study described in 
subsection (a), the Secretary shall consult with institutions of higher 
education.
    ``(c) Report to Congress.--The Secretary shall report to the 
Committee on Labor and Human Resources of the Senate and the Committee 
on Education and the Workforce of the House of Representatives not 
later than September 30, 1999, regarding the results of the study 
described in subsection (a).''.

SEC. 440. DELEGATION OF FUNCTIONS.

    Section 436 (20 U.S.C. 1086) is amended to read as follows:

``SEC. 436. DELEGATION OF FUNCTIONS.

    ``(a) In General.--An eligible lender or guaranty agency that 
contracts with another entity to perform any of the lender's or 
agency's functions under this title, or otherwise delegates the 
performance of such functions to such other entity--
            ``(1) shall not be relieved of the lender's or agency's 
        duty to comply with the requirements of this title; and
            ``(2) shall monitor the activities of such other entity for 
        compliance with such requirements.
    ``(b) Special Rule.--A lender that holds a loan made under part B 
in the lender's capacity as a trustee is responsible for complying with 
all statutory and regulatory requirements imposed on any other holder 
of a loan made under this part.''.

SEC. 440A. SPECIAL ALLOWANCES.

    (a) Amendments.--Section 438 (20 U.S.C. 1087-1) is amended--
            (1) in subsection (c), by amending paragraph (1) to read as 
        follows:
            ``(1) Deduction from interest and special allowance 
        subsidies.--(A) Notwithstanding subsection (b), the Secretary 
        shall collect the amount the lender is authorized to charge as 
        an origination fee in accordance with paragraph (2) of this 
        subsection--
                    ``(i) by reducing the total amount of interest and 
                special allowance payable under section 428(a)(3)(A) 
                and subsection (b) of this section, respectively, to 
                any holder; or
                    ``(ii) directly from the holder of the loan, if the 
                lender fails or is not required to bill the Secretary 
                for interest and special allowance or withdraws from 
                the program with unpaid loan origination fees.
            ``(B) If the Secretary collects the origination fee under 
        this subsection through the reduction of interest and special 
        allowance, and the total amount of interest and special 
        allowance payable under section 428(a)(3)(A) and subsection (b) 
        of this section, respectively, is less than the amount the 
        lender was authorized to charge borrowers for origination fees 
        in that quarter, the Secretary shall deduct the excess amount 
        from the subsequent quarters' payments until the total amount 
        has been deducted.'';
            (2) in subsection (d), by amending paragraph (1) to read as 
        follows:
            ``(1) Deduction from interest and special allowance 
        subsidies.--
                    ``(A) In general.--Notwithstanding subsection (b), 
                the Secretary shall collect a loan fee in an amount 
                determined in accordance with paragraph (2)--
                            ``(i) by reducing the total amount of 
                        interest and special allowance payable under 
                        section 428(a)(3)(A) and subsection (b), 
                        respectively, to any holder of a loan; or
                            ``(ii) directly from the holder of the 
                        loan, if the lender--
                                    ``(I) fails or is not required to 
                                bill the Secretary for interest and 
                                special allowance payments; or
                                    ``(II) withdraws from the program 
                                with unpaid loan fees.
                    ``(B) Special rule.--If the Secretary collects loan 
                fees under this subsection through the reduction of 
                interest and special allowance payments, and the total 
                amount of interest and special allowance payable under 
                section 428(a)(3)(A) and subsection (b), respectively, 
                is less than the amount of such loan fees, then the 
                Secretary shall deduct the amount of the loan fee 
                balance from the amount of interest and special 
                allowance payments that would otherwise be payable, in 
                subsequent quarterly increments until the balance has 
                been deducted.''; and
            (3) in subsection (e)--
                    (A) by striking paragraphs (1) and (2); and
                    (B) by redesignating paragraphs (3) and (4) as 
                paragraphs (1) and (2), respectively.
    (b) Conforming Amendment.--Section 432(f)(1)(D) is amended by 
striking ``required to file a plan for doing business under section 
438(d)'' and inserting ``that meets the requirements of section 
438(e)''.

SEC. 440B. STUDY OF MARKET-BASED MECHANISMS FOR DETERMINING STUDENT 
              LOAN INTEREST RATES.

    (a) Study Required.--
            (1) In general.--The Secretary of the Treasury shall 
        conduct a study of the feasibility of employing market-based 
        mechanisms, including some form of auction, for determining 
        student loan interest rates under title IV of the Higher 
        Education Act of 1965 (20 U.S.C. 1070 et seq.). The study shall 
        include--
                    (A) analysis of the potential impact of the 
                mechanisms on the delivery of student financial aid;
                    (B) analysis of the implications of the mechanisms 
                with respect to student and institutional access to 
                student loan capital;
                    (C) analysis of the potential impact of the 
                mechanisms on the costs of the programs under such 
                title for students and the Federal Government; and
                    (D) a plan for structuring and implementing the 
                mechanisms in such a manner that ensures the cost-
                effective availability of student loans for students 
                and their families.
    (b) Consultation.--In conducting the study described in paragraph 
(1), the Secretary shall consult with lenders, secondary markets, 
guaranty agencies, institutions of higher education, student loan 
borrowers, and other participants in the student loan programs under 
title IV of the Higher Education Act of 1965 (20 U.S.C. 1070 et seq.).
    (c) Report to Congress.--The Secretary of the Treasury shall report 
to the Committee on Labor and Human Resources of the Senate, and the 
Committee on Education and the Workforce of the House of 
Representatives not later than September 30, 1999, regarding the 
results of the study described in subsection (a).

                  PART C--FEDERAL WORK-STUDY PROGRAMS

SEC. 441. AUTHORIZATION OF APPROPRIATIONS; COMMUNITY SERVICES.

    Section 441 (20 U.S.C. 2751) is amended--
            (1) in subsection (b), by striking ``$800,000,000 for 
        fiscal year 1993'' and inserting ``$900,000,000 for fiscal year 
        1999''; and
            (2) in subsection (c)--
                    (A) in paragraph (1), by inserting ``(including 
                child care services provided on campus)'' after ``child 
                care''; and
                    (B) in paragraph (3), by inserting ``, including 
                students with disabilities who are enrolled at the 
                institution'' before the semicolon.

SEC. 442. GRANTS FOR FEDERAL WORK-STUDY PROGRAMS.

    Section 443(b) (20 U.S.C. 2753(b)) is amended--
            (1) in paragraph (1), by inserting ``, including 
        internships or research assistanceships as determined by the 
        Secretary,'' after ``part-time employment'';
            (2) by amending paragraph (3) to read as follows:
            ``(3) provide that in the selection of students for 
        employment under such work-study program, only students who 
        demonstrate financial need in accordance with part F of this 
        title and meet the requirements of section 484 will be 
        assisted, except that if the institution's grant under this 
        part is directly or indirectly based in part on the financial 
        need demonstrated by students who are (A) attending the 
        institution on less than a full-time basis, or (B) independent 
        students, a reasonable portion of the allocation shall be made 
        available to such students;'';
            (3) in paragraph (5)--
                    (A) by striking ``provide that'' and inserting 
                ``(A) provide that'';
                    (B) by striking ``1993-1994'' and inserting ``1999-
                2000''; and
                    (C) by inserting ``and (B) provide that the Federal 
                share of the compensation of students employed in 
                community service shall not exceed 90 percent for 
                academic years 1999-2000 and succeeding academic 
                years,'' after ``academic years,''; and
            (4) in paragraph (6), by striking ``, and to make'' and all 
        that follows through ``such employment''.

SEC. 443. WORK COLLEGES.

    Section 448 (20 U.S.C. 2756b) is amended--
            (1) in subsection (b)(2)--
                    (A) in subparagraph (C), by striking ``and'' after 
                the semicolon;
                    (B) in subparagraph (D)(ii), by striking the period 
                and inserting a semicolon; and
                    (C) by adding at the end the following:
                    ``(E) coordinate and carry out joint projects and 
                activities to promote work service learning; and
                    ``(F) carry out a comprehensive, longitudinal study 
                of student academic progress and academic and career 
                outcomes, relative to student self-sufficiency in 
                financing their higher education, repayment of student 
                loans, continued community service, kind and quality of 
                service performed, and career choice and community 
                service selected after graduation.''; and
            (2) in subsection (f), by striking ``$5,000,000 for fiscal 
        year 1993'' and inserting ``$7,000,000 for fiscal year 1999''.

          PART D--WILLIAM D. FORD FEDERAL DIRECT LOAN PROGRAM

SEC. 451. SELECTION OF INSTITUTIONS.

    Section 453(c) (20 U.S.C. 1087c(c)) is amended--
            (1) in paragraph (2)--
                    (A) in the paragraph heading, by striking 
                ``Transition'';
                    (B) by striking subparagraph (E); and
                    (C) by redesignating subparagraphs (F), (G), and 
                (H) as subparagraphs (E), (F), and (G), respectively; 
                and
            (2) in paragraph (3)--
                    (A) in the paragraph heading, by striking ``After 
                transition''; and
                    (B) by striking ``For academic year 1995-1996 and 
                subsequent academic years, the'' and inserting ``The''.

SEC. 452. TERMS AND CONDITIONS.

    (a) Direct Loan Interest Rates.--Section 455(b) (20 U.S.C. 
1087e(b)) is amended by amending paragraph (5) to read as follows:
            ``(5) Interest rate provision.--
                    ``(A) Rates for fdsl and fdusl.--Notwithstanding 
                the preceding paragraphs of this subsection, for 
                Federal Direct Unsubsidized Stafford/Ford Loans for 
                which the first disbursement is made on or after 
                October 1, 1998, and before July 1, 2003, the 
                applicable rate of interest shall, during any 12-month 
                period beginning on July 1 and ending on June 30, be 
                determined on the preceding June 1 and be equal to--
                            ``(i) the bond equivalent rate of 91-day 
                        Treasury bills auctioned at the final auction 
                        held prior to such June 1; plus
                            ``(ii) 2.3 percent,
                except that such rate shall not exceed 8.25 percent.
                    ``(B) In school and grace period rules.--
                Notwithstanding the preceding paragraphs of this 
                subsection, with respect to any Federal Direct 
                Stafford/Ford Loan or Federal Direct Unsubsidized 
                Stafford/Ford Loan for which the first disbursement is 
                made on or after October 1, 1998, and before July 1, 
                2003, the applicable rate of interest for interest 
                which accrues--
                            ``(i) prior to the beginning of the 
                        repayment period of the loan; or
                            ``(ii) during the period in which principal 
                        need not be paid (whether or not such principal 
                        is in fact paid) by reason of a provision 
                        described in section 428(b)(1)(M) or 
                        427(a)(2)(C),
                shall be determined under subparagraph (A) by 
                substituting `1.7 percent' for `2.3 percent'.
                    ``(C) PLUS loans.--Notwithstanding the preceding 
                paragraphs of this subsection, with respect to Federal 
                Direct PLUS Loan for which the first disbursement is 
                made on or after October 1, 1998, and before July 1, 
                2003, the applicable rate of interest shall be 
                determined under subparagraph (A)--
                            ``(i) by substituting `3.1 percent' for 
                        `2.3 percent'; and
                            ``(ii) by substituting `9.0 percent' for 
                        `8.25 percent'.''.
    (b) Effective date.--The amendments made by subsection (a) shall 
apply with respect to any loan made under part D of title IV of the 
Higher Education Act of 1965 for which the first disbursement is made 
on or after October 1, 1998, and before July 1, 2003.
    (c) Repayment Incentives.--Section 455(b) (20 U.S.C. 1087e(b)) is 
amended further by adding at the end the following:
            ``(7) Repayment incentives.--
                    ``(A) In general.--Notwithstanding any other 
                provision of this part, the Secretary is authorized to 
                prescribe by regulation such reductions in the interest 
                rate paid by a borrower of a loan made under this part 
                as the Secretary determines appropriate to encourage 
                on-time repayment of the loan. Such reductions may be 
                offered only if the Secretary determines the reductions 
                are cost neutral and in the best financial interest of 
                the Federal Government. Any increase in subsidy costs 
                resulting from such reductions shall be completely 
                offset by corresponding savings in funds available for 
                the William D. Ford Federal Direct Loan Program in that 
                fiscal year from section 458 and other administrative 
                accounts.
                    ``(B) Accountability.--The Secretary shall ensure 
                the cost neutrality of such reductions by obtaining an 
                official report from the Director of the Office of 
                Management and Budget and the Director of the 
                Congressional Budget Office that any such reductions 
                will be completely cost neutral. The reports shall be 
                transmitted to the Committee on Labor and Human 
                Resources of the Senate and the Committee on Education 
                and the Workforce of the House of Representatives not 
                less than 60 days prior to the publication of 
                regulations proposing such reductions.''.

SEC. 453. CONTRACTS.

    Section 456(b) (20 U.S.C. 1087f(b)) is amended--
            (1) in paragraph (3), by inserting ``and'' after the 
        semicolon;
            (2) by striking paragraph (4); and
            (3) by redesignating paragraph (5) as paragraph (4).

SEC. 454. FUNDS FOR ADMINISTRATIVE EXPENSES.

    Section 458 (20 U.S.C. 1087h) is amended--
            (1) by amending subsection (a) to read as follows:
    ``(a) Administrative Expenses.--
            ``(1) In general.--Each fiscal year there shall be 
        available to the Secretary, from funds not otherwise 
        appropriated, funds to be obligated for--
                    ``(A) administrative costs under this part and part 
                B, including the costs of the direct student loan 
                programs under this part; and
                    ``(B) account maintenance fees payable to guaranty 
                agencies under part B and calculated in accordance with 
                subsections (b) and (c),
        not to exceed (from such funds not otherwise appropriated) 
        $612,000,000 in fiscal year 1999, $730,000,000 in fiscal year 
        2000, $765,000,000 in fiscal year 2001, $770,000,000 in fiscal 
        year 2002, and $785,000,000 in fiscal year 2003.
            ``(2) Account maintenance fees.--Account maintenance fees 
        under paragraph (1)(B) shall be paid quarterly and deposited in 
        the Agency Operating Fund established under section 422B.
            ``(3) Carryover.--The Secretary may carry over funds made 
        available under this section to a subsequent fiscal year.'';
            (2) by amending subsection (b) to read as follows:
    ``(b) Calculation Basis.--Except as provided in subsection (c), 
account maintenance fees payable to guaranty agencies under paragraph 
(1)(B) shall be calculated--
            ``(1) for fiscal years 1999 and 2000, on the basis of 0.12 
        percent of the original principal amount of outstanding loans 
        on which insurance was issued under part B; and
            ``(2) for fiscal year 2001, 2002, and 2003, on the basis of 
        0.10 percent of the original principal amount of outstanding 
        loans on which insurance was issued under part B.'';
            (3) by redesignating subsections (c) and (d) as subsections 
        (d) and (e), respectively; and
            (4) by inserting after subsection (b) the following:
    ``(c) Special Rules.--
            ``(1) Fee cap.--The total amount of account maintenance 
        fees payable under this section--
                    ``(A) for fiscal year 1999, shall not exceed 
                $177,000,000;
                    ``(B) for fiscal year 2000, shall not exceed 
                $180,000,000;
                    ``(C) for fiscal year 2001, shall not exceed 
                $170,000,000;
                    ``(D) for fiscal year 2002, shall not exceed 
                $180,000,000; and
                    ``(E) for fiscal year 2003, shall not exceed 
                $195,000,000.
            ``(2) Insufficient funding.--
                    ``(A) In general.--Notwithstanding section 422A(d), 
                if the amount made available under subsection (a) is 
                insufficient to pay the account maintenance fees 
                payable to guaranty agencies under paragraph (1) for a 
                fiscal year, the Secretary shall pay the insufficiency 
                by requiring guaranty agencies to transfer funds from 
                the Federal Student Loan Reserve Funds under section 
                422A to the Agency Operating Funds under section 422B.
                    ``(B) Entitlement.--A guaranty agency shall be 
                deemed to have a contractual right against the United 
                States to receive payments according to the provisions 
                of subparagraph (A).''.

SEC. 455. LOAN CANCELLATION FOR TEACHERS.

    Part D of title IV (20 U.S.C. 1087a et seq.) is amended by adding 
at the end the following:

``SEC. 459. LOAN CANCELLATION FOR TEACHERS.

    ``(a) Statement of Purpose.--It is the purpose of this section to 
encourage individuals to enter and continue in the teaching profession.
    ``(b) Program Authorized.--The Secretary is authorized to carry out 
a program of canceling the obligation to repay a Federal Direct 
Stafford/Ford Loan made under this part that is eligible for an 
interest subsidy and is a qualifying loan, for any new borrower on or 
after October 1, 1998, who--
            ``(1) has been employed as a full-time teacher for 3 
        consecutive complete school years--
                    ``(A) in a school that qualifies under section 
                465(a)(2)(A) for loan cancellation for Perkins loan 
                recipients who teach in such schools;
                    ``(B) if employed as a secondary school teacher, is 
                teaching a subject area that is relevant to the 
                borrower's academic major as certified by the chief 
                administrative officer of the public or non-profit 
                private secondary school in which the borrower is 
                employed; and
                    ``(C) if employed as an elementary school teacher, 
                has demonstrated, in accordance with State teacher 
                certification or licensing requirements and as 
                certified by the chief administrative officer of the 
                public or nonprofit private elementary school in which 
                the borrower is employed, knowledge and teaching skills 
                in reading, writing, mathematics and other areas of the 
                elementary school curriculum; and
            ``(2) is not in default on a loan for which the borrower 
        seeks forgiveness.
    ``(c) Qualifying Loans.--For purposes of this section, a loan is a 
qualifying loan if--
            ``(1) the loan was obtained to cover the cost of 
        instruction for an academic year after the first and second 
        years of undergraduate education; and
            ``(2) the loan did not cover the costs of instruction for 
        more than 2 academic years, or 3 academic years in the case of 
        a program of instruction normally requiring 5 years to 
        complete.
    ``(d) Regulations.--The Secretary is authorized to issue such 
regulations as may be necessary to carry out the provisions of this 
section.
    ``(e) Loan Cancellation During Continuing Teaching Service.--
            ``(1) In general.--The Secretary shall cancel the 
        obligation to repay--
                    ``(A) 30 percent of the total outstanding amount 
                and applicable interest of subsidized Federal Direct 
                Stafford/Ford loans that are qualifying loans and are 
                owed by the student borrower after the completion of 
                the fourth or fifth complete school year of service 
                described in subsection (b);
                    ``(B) 40 percent of such total amount after the 
                completion of the sixth complete school year of such 
                service; and
                    ``(C) a total amount for any borrower that shall 
                not exceed $8,000.
            ``(2) Construction.--Nothing in this section shall be 
        construed to authorize any refunding of any canceled loan.
    ``(f) List.--If the list of schools in which a teacher may perform 
service pursuant to subsection (b) is not available before May 1 of any 
year, the Secretary may use the list for the year preceding the year 
for which the determination is made to make such service determination.
    ``(g) Continued Eligibility.--Any teacher who performs service in a 
school that--
            ``(1) meets the requirements of subsection (b)(1)(A) in any 
        year during such service; and
            ``(2) in a subsequent year fails to meet the requirements 
        of such subsection, may continue to teach in such school and 
        shall be eligible for loan cancellation pursuant to subsection 
        (b).''.

                     PART E--FEDERAL PERKINS LOANS

SEC. 461. AUTHORIZATION OF APPROPRIATIONS.

    Subsection (b) of section 461 (20 U.S.C. 1087aa) is amended--
            (1) in paragraph (1), by striking ``1993'' and inserting 
        ``1999''; and
            (2) in paragraph (2), by striking ``1997'' each place the 
        term appears and inserting ``2003''.

SEC. 462. ALLOCATION OF FUNDS.

    (a) Amendments.--Section 462 (20 U.S.C. 1087bb) is amended--
            (1) in the matter preceding subparagraph (A) of subsection 
        (d)(3), by striking ``the Secretary, for'' and all that follows 
        through ``years,'';
            (2) by amending subsection (f) to read as follows:
    ``(f) Default Penalties.--
            ``(1) In general.--For fiscal year 1998 and any succeeding 
        fiscal year, any institution with a cohort default rate (as 
        defined under subsection (h)) that equals or exceeds 25 percent 
        shall have a default penalty of zero.
            ``(2) Ineligibility.--
                    ``(A) In general.--For fiscal year 1998 and any 
                succeeding fiscal year, any institution with a cohort 
                default rate (as defined in subsection (h)) that equals 
                or exceeds 50 percent for each of the 3 most recent 
                years for which data are available shall not be 
                eligible to participate in a program under this part 
                for the fiscal year for which the determination is made 
                and the 2 succeeding fiscal years, unless, within 30 
                days of receiving notification from the Secretary of 
                the loss of eligibility under this paragraph, the 
                institution appeals the loss of eligibility to the 
                Secretary. The Secretary shall issue a decision on any 
                such appeal within 45 days after the submission of the 
                appeal. Such decision may permit the institution to 
                continue to participate in a program under this part 
                if--
                            ``(i) the institution demonstrates to the 
                        satisfaction of the Secretary that the 
                        calculation of the institution's cohort default 
                        rate is not accurate, and that recalculation 
                        would reduce the institution's cohort default 
                        rate for any of the 3 fiscal years below 50 
                        percent; or
                            ``(ii) there are, in the judgment of the 
                        Secretary, exceptional mitigating circumstances 
                        such as a small number of borrowers entering 
                        repayment, that would make the application of 
                        this subparagraph inequitable.
                    ``(B) Continued participation.--During an appeal 
                under subparagraph (A), the Secretary may permit the 
                institution to continue to participate in a program 
                under this part.
                    ``(C) Definition.--For the purposes of subparagraph 
                (A), the term `loss of eligibility' shall be defined as 
                the mandatory liquidation of an institution's student 
                loan fund, and assignment of the institution's 
                outstanding loan portfolio to the Secretary.'';
            (3) by amending paragraph (1) of subsection (g) to read as 
        follows: ``(1) For award year 1998 and subsequent years, the 
        maximum cohort default rate is 25 percent.''; and
            (4) in subsection (h)--
                    (A) in the subsection heading, by striking 
                ``Definitions of Default Rate and'' and inserting 
                ``Definition of'';
                    (B) by striking paragraphs (1) and (2);
                    (C) by redesignating paragraphs (3) and (4) as 
                paragraphs (1) and (2), respectively;
                    (D) in paragraph (1) (as redesignated by 
                subparagraph (C))--
                            (i) by striking subparagraph (B); and
                            (ii) by redesignating subparagraphs (C) 
                        through (G) as subparagraphs (B) through (F), 
                        respectively; and
                    (E) in the matter preceding subparagraph (A) of 
                paragraph (2) (as redesignated by subparagraph (C)), by 
                striking ``A loan'' and inserting ``For purposes of 
                calculating the cohort default rate under this 
                subsection, a loan''.
    (b) Conforming Amendments.--Section 462 (20 U.S.C. 1087bb) is 
amended--
            (1) in the matter following paragraphs (1)(B) and 
        (2)(D)(ii) of subsection (a), by inserting ``cohort'' before 
        ``default'' each place the term appears;
            (2) in the matter following paragraphs (2)(B) and (3)(C) of 
        subsection (c), by inserting ``cohort'' before ``default'' each 
        place the term appears;
            (3) in subsection (e)(2), by inserting ``cohort'' before 
        ``default''; and
            (4) in subsection (h)(1)(F) (as redesignated by 
        subparagraphs (C) and (D)(ii) of subsection (a)(4)), by 
        inserting ``cohort'' before ``default''.

SEC. 463. AGREEMENTS WITH INSTITUTIONS OF HIGHER EDUCATION.

    Section 463 (20 U.S.C. 1087cc) is amended--
            (1) by amending subparagraph (B) of subsection (a)(2) to 
        read as follows:
                    ``(B) a capital contribution by an institution in 
                an amount equal to one-third of the Federal capital 
                contributions described in subparagraph (A);'';
            (2) in subsection (c)--
                    (A) in paragraph (2)--
                            (i) in the matter preceding subparagraph 
                        (A), by striking ``by the Secretary'' and all 
                        that follows through ``of--'' and inserting 
                        ``by the Secretary or an institution, as the 
                        case may be, to such organizations, with 
                        respect to any loan held by the Secretary or 
                        the institution, respectively, of--'';
                            (ii) by amending subparagraph (A) to read 
                        as follows:
                    ``(A) the date of disbursement and the amount of 
                such loans made to any borrower under this part at the 
                time of disbursement of the loan;'';
                            (iii) in subparagraph (B)--
                                    (I) by inserting ``the repayment 
                                and'' after ``concerning''; and
                                    (II) by striking ``any defaulted'' 
                                and inserting ``such''; and
                            (iv) in subparagraph (C), by inserting ``, 
                        or upon cancellation or discharge of the 
                        borrower's obligation on the loan for any 
                        reason'' before the period;
                    (B) in paragraph (3)--
                            (i) in the matter preceding subparagraph 
                        (A), by striking ``until--'' and inserting 
                        ``until the loan is paid in full.''; and
                            (ii) by striking subparagraphs (A) and (B); 
                        and
                    (C) by amending paragraph (4) to read as follows:
            ``(4)(A) Except as provided in subparagraph (B), an 
        institution of higher education, after consultation with the 
        Secretary and pursuant to the agreements entered into under 
        paragraph (1), shall disclose at least annually to any credit 
        bureau organization with which the Secretary has such an 
        agreement the information set forth in paragraph (2), and shall 
        disclose promptly to such credit bureau organization any 
        changes to the information previously disclosed.
            ``(B) The Secretary may promulgate regulations establishing 
        criteria under which an institution of higher education may 
        cease reporting the information described in paragraph (2) 
        before a loan is paid in full.''.

SEC. 464. TERMS OF LOANS.

    Section 464 (20 U.S.C. 1087dd) is amended--
            (1) in subsection (a), by amending paragraph (2) to read as 
        follows:
            ``(2)(A) Except as provided in paragraph (4), the total of 
        loans made to a student in any academic year or its equivalent 
        by an institution of higher education from a loan fund 
        established pursuant to an agreement under this part shall not 
        exceed--
                    ``(i) $4,000, in the case of a student who has not 
                successfully completed a program of undergraduate 
                education; or
                    ``(ii) $6,000, in the case of a graduate or 
                professional student (as defined in regulations issued 
                by the Secretary).
            ``(B) Except as provided in paragraph (4), the aggregate of 
        the loans for all years made to a student by institutions of 
        higher education from loan funds established pursuant to 
        agreements under this part may not exceed--
                    ``(i) $40,000, in the case of any graduate or 
                professional student (as defined by regulations issued 
                by the Secretary, and including any loans from such 
                funds made to such person before such person became a 
                graduate or professional student);
                    ``(ii) $20,000, in the case of a student who has 
                successfully completed 2 years of a program of 
                education leading to a bachelor's degree but who has 
                not completed the work necessary for such a degree 
                (determined under regulations issued by the Secretary, 
                and including any loans from such funds made to such 
                person before such person became such a student); and
                    ``(iii) $8,000, in the case of any other student.
            ``(C)(i) The total of loans made to a student described in 
        clause (ii) in any academic year or its equivalent by an 
        institution of higher education from loan funds established 
        pursuant to agreements under this part may not exceed--
                    ``(I) $8,000 for each of the third and fourth years 
                of the program of instruction leading to a bachelor's 
                degree; or
                    ``(II) $10,000 for the first year of graduate study 
                (as defined in regulations issued by the Secretary).
            ``(ii) A student referred to in clause (i) is any student--
                    ``(I) who is a junior in a program of instruction 
                leading to a bachelor's degree;
                    ``(II) who states in writing that the student will 
                pursue a course of study to become an elementary or 
                secondary school teacher; and
                    ``(III) who states in writing that the student 
                intends to become a full-time teacher in a school which 
                meets the requirements of section 465(a)(2)(A).
            ``(iii) Each institution shall provide a report to the 
        Secretary annually containing the number of loans under this 
        subparagraph that are made, the amount of each loan, and 
        whether students benefiting from the higher loan limits met the 
        requirements for receiving those loans.
            ``(iv) If 3 years after the date of enactment of the Higher 
        Education Amendments of 1998, the Secretary determines that an 
        institution has engaged in a pattern of abuse of this 
        subparagraph, the Secretary may reduce or terminate the 
        institution's Federal capital contribution.'';
            (2) in subsection (b), by amending paragraph (2) to read as 
        follows:
            ``(2) If the institution's capital contribution under 
        section 462 is directly or indirectly based in part on the 
        financial need demonstrated by students who are (A) attending 
        the institution less than full time; or (B) independent 
        students, a reasonable portion of the loans made from the 
        institution's student loan fund containing the contribution 
        shall be made available to such students.'';
            (3) in subsection (c)(1)--
                    (A) in subparagraph (D), by striking ``(i) 3 
                percent'' and all that follows through ``or (iii)'';
                    (B) by redesignating subparagraphs (H) and (I) as 
                subparagraphs (I) and (J), respectively; and
                    (C) by inserting after subparagraph (G) the 
                following:
                    ``(H) shall provide that, in the case of a loan 
                made on or after July 1, 1999, the loan shall be 
                considered in default (except as otherwise provided in 
                section 462(h)) if the borrower of a loan made under 
                this part fails to make an installment payment when 
                due, or to meet any other term of the promissory note 
                or written repayment agreement, and such failure 
                persists for--
                            ``(i) 180 days in the case of a loan that 
                        is repayable in monthly installments; or
                            ``(ii) 240 days in the case of a loan that 
                        is repayable in less frequent installments;'';
            (4) in subsection (c), by adding at the end the following:
    ``(7) There shall be excluded from the 9-month period that begins 
on the date on which a student ceases to carry at least one-half the 
normal full-time academic workload as described in paragraph (1)(A) any 
period not to exceed 3 years during which a borrower who is a member of 
a reserve component of the Armed Forces named in section 10101 of title 
10, United States Code, is called or ordered to active duty for a 
period of more than 30 days (as defined in section 101(d)(2) of such 
title). Such period of exclusion shall include the period necessary to 
resume enrollment at the borrower's next available regular enrollment 
period.''; and
            (5) by adding at the end the following:
    ``(g) Discharge.--
            ``(1) In general.--If a student borrower who received a 
        loan made under this part on or after January 1, 1986, is 
        unable to complete the program in which such student is 
        enrolled due to the closure of the institution, then the 
        Secretary shall discharge the borrower's liability on the loan 
        (including the interest and collection fees) by repaying the 
        amount owed on the loan and shall subsequently pursue any claim 
        available to such borrower against the institution and the 
        institution's affiliates and principals, or settle the loan 
        obligation pursuant to the financial responsibility standards 
        described in section 498(c).
            ``(2) Assignment.--A borrower whose loan has been 
        discharged pursuant to this subsection shall be deemed to have 
        assigned to the United States the right to a loan refund in an 
        amount that does not exceed the amount discharged against the 
        institution and the institution's affiliates and principals.
            ``(3) Eligibility for additional assistance.--The period 
        during which a student was unable to complete a course of study 
        due to the closing of the institution shall not be considered 
        for purposes of calculating the student's period of eligibility 
        for additional assistance under this title.
            ``(4) Special rule.--A borrower whose loan has been 
        discharged pursuant to this subsection shall not be precluded, 
        because of that discharge, from receiving additional grant, 
        loan, or work assistance under this title for which the 
        borrower would be otherwise eligible (but for the default on 
        the discharged loan).
            ``(5) Reporting.--The Secretary or institution, as the case 
        may be, shall report to credit bureaus with respect to loans 
        that have been discharged pursuant to this subsection.
    ``(h) Rehabilitation of Loans.--
            ``(1) Rehabilitation.--
                    ``(A) In general.--If the borrower of a loan made 
                under this part who has defaulted on the loan makes 12 
                ontime, consecutive, monthly payments of amounts owed 
                on the loan, as determined by the institution, the loan 
                shall be considered rehabilitated, and the institution 
                that made that loan (or the Secretary, in the case of a 
                loan held by the Secretary) shall instruct any credit 
                bureau organization or credit reporting agency to which 
                the default was reported to remove the default from the 
                borrower's credit history.
                    ``(B) Comparable conditions.--As long as the 
                borrower continues to make scheduled repayments on a 
                loan rehabilitated under this paragraph, the 
                rehabilitated loan shall be subject to the same terms 
                and conditions, and qualify for the same benefits and 
                privileges, as other loans made under this part.
                    ``(C) Additional assistance.--The borrower of a 
                rehabilitated loan shall not be precluded by section 
                484 from receiving additional grant, loan, or work 
                assistance under this title (for which the borrower is 
                otherwise eligible) on the basis of defaulting on the 
                loan prior to such rehabilitation.
                    ``(D) Limitations.--A borrower only once may obtain 
                the benefit of this paragraph with respect to 
                rehabilitating a loan under this part.
            ``(2) Restoration of eligibility.--If the borrower of a 
        loan made under this part who has defaulted on that loan makes 
        6 ontime, consecutive, monthly payments of amounts owed on such 
        loan, the borrower's eligibility for grant, loan, or work 
        assistance under this title shall be restored. A borrower only 
        once may obtain the benefit of this paragraph with respect to 
        restored eligibility.
    ``(i) Incentive Repayment Program.--
            ``(1) In general.--Each institution of higher education may 
        establish, with the approval of the Secretary, an incentive 
        repayment program designed to reduce default and to replenish 
        student loan funds established under this part. Each such 
        incentive repayment program may--
                    ``(A) offer a reduction of the interest rate on a 
                loan on which the borrower has made 48 ontime, 
                consecutive, monthly repayments, but in no event may 
                the rate be reduced by more than 1 percent;
                    ``(B) provide for a discount on the balance owed on 
                a loan on which the borrower pays the principal and 
                interest in full prior to the end of the applicable 
                repayment period, but in no event may the discount 
                exceed 5 percent of the unpaid principal balance due on 
                the loan at the time the early repayment is made; and
                    ``(C) include such other incentive repayment 
                options as the institution determines will carry out 
                the objectives of this subsection.
            ``(2) Limitation.--No incentive repayment option under an 
        incentive repayment program authorized by this subsection may 
        be paid for with Federal funds, including any Federal funds 
        from the student loan fund, nor can an incentive repayment 
        option be paid for with institutional funds from the student 
        loan fund.''.

SEC. 465. DISTRIBUTION OF ASSETS FROM STUDENT LOAN FUNDS.

    Section 466 (20 U.S.C. 1087ff) is amended--
            (1) in subsection (a)--
                    (A) in the matter preceding paragraph (1)--
                            (i) by striking ``1996'' and inserting 
                        ``2003''; and
                            (ii) by striking ``1997'' and inserting 
                        ``2004''; and
                    (B) in paragraph (1), by striking ``1996'' and 
                inserting ``2003'';
            (2) in subsection (b)--
                    (A) by striking ``2005'' and inserting ``2012''; 
                and
                    (B) by striking ``1996'' and inserting ``2003''; 
                and
            (3) in subsection (c), by striking ``1997'' and inserting 
        ``2004''.

SEC. 466. PERKINS LOAN REVOLVING FUND.

    (a) Repeal.--Subsection (c) of section 467 (20 U.S.C. 1087gg(c)) is 
repealed.
    (b) Transfer of balance.--Any funds in the Perkins Loan Revolving 
Fund on the date of enactment of this Act shall be transferred to and 
deposited in the Treasury.

                         PART F--NEED ANALYSIS

SEC. 471. COST OF ATTENDANCE.

    Section 472 (20 U.S.C. 1087ll) is amended--
            (1) in paragraph (3)--
                    (A) in subparagraph (A), by striking ``of not less 
                than $1,500'' and inserting ``determined by the 
                institution''; and
                    (B) in subparagraph (C), by striking ``, except 
                that the amount may not be less than $2,500''; and
            (2) in paragraph (11), by striking ``placed'' and inserting 
        ``engaged''.

SEC. 472. FAMILY CONTRIBUTION FOR DEPENDENT STUDENTS.

    Section 475 (20 U.S.C. 1087oo) is amended--
            (1) in subsection (g)--
                    (A) in paragraph (2)--
                            (i) in subparagraph (D)--
                                    (I) by striking ``$1,750'' and 
                                inserting ``$2,200''; and
                                    (II) by striking ``and'' after the 
                                semicolon;
                            (ii) in subparagraph (E), by striking the 
                        period and inserting ``; and''; and
                            (iii) by adding at the end the following:
                    ``(F) an allowance for parents' negative available 
                income, determined in accordance with paragraph (6).''; 
                and
                    (B) by adding at the end the following:
            ``(6) Allowance for parents' negative available income.--
        The allowance for parents' negative available income is the 
        amount, if any, by which the sum of the amounts deducted under 
        subparagraphs (A) through (F) of paragraph (1) exceeds the 
        parents' total income (as defined in section 480).''; and
            (2) by adding at the end the following:
    ``(j) Adjustments to Students Contribution for Enrollment Periods 
of Less Than Nine Months.--For periods of enrollment of less than 9 
months, the student's contribution from adjusted available income (as 
determined under subsection (g)) is determined, for purposes other than 
subpart 2 of part A, by dividing the amount determined under such 
subsection by 9, and multiplying the result by the number of months in 
the period of enrollment.''.

SEC. 473. FAMILY CONTRIBUTION FOR INDEPENDENT STUDENTS WITHOUT 
              DEPENDENTS OTHER THAN A SPOUSE.

    Section 476(b)(1)(A)(iv) (20 U.S.C. 1087pp(b)(1)(A)(iv)) is 
amended--
            (1) in subclause (I), by striking ``$3,000'' and inserting 
        ``$4,250'';
            (2) in subclause (II), by striking ``$3,000'' and inserting 
        ``$4,250''; and
            (3) in subclause (III), by striking ``$6,000'' and 
        inserting ``$7,250''.

SEC. 474. REGULATIONS; UPDATED TABLES AND AMOUNTS.

    Section 478(b) (20 U.S.C. 1087rr(b)) is amended--
            (1) by striking ``For each academic year'' and inserting 
        the following:
            ``(1) Revised tables.--For each academic year''; and
            (2) by adding at the end the following new paragraph:
            ``(2) Revised amounts.--For each academic year after 
        academic year 1999-2000, the Secretary shall publish in the 
        Federal Register revised income protection allowances for the 
        purpose of sections 475(g)(2)(D) and 476(b)(1)(A)(iv). Such 
        revised allowances shall be developed by increasing each of the 
        dollar amounts contained in such section by a percentage equal 
        to the estimated percentage increase in the Consumer Price 
        Index (as determined by the Secretary) between December 1998 
        and the December next preceding the beginning of such academic 
        year, and rounding the result to the nearest $10.''.

SEC. 475. SIMPLIFIED NEEDS TEST; ZERO EXPECTED FAMILY CONTRIBUTION.

    Section 479 (20 U.S.C. 1087ss) is amended--
            (1) in subsection (b)(3)--
                    (A) in subparagraph (A), by striking ``or'' after 
                the semicolon;
                    (B) by redesignating subparagraph (B) as 
                subparagraph (C); and
                    (C) by inserting after subparagraph (A) the 
                following:
                    ``(B) a form 1040 (including any prepared or 
                electronic version of such form) required pursuant to 
                the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, except that such 
                form shall be considered a form described in this 
                paragraph only if the student or family files such form 
                in order to take a tax credit under section 25A of the 
                Internal Revenue Code of 1986, and would otherwise be 
                eligible to file a form described in subparagraph (A); 
                or''; and
            (2) in subsection (c)--
                    (A) in paragraph (1), by amending subparagraph (A) 
                to read as follows:
                    ``(A)(i) the student's parents file, or are 
                eligible to file, a form described in subsection 
                (b)(3), or the parents certify to the Secretary that 
                the parents are not required to file an income tax 
                return; and
                    ``(ii) the student files, or is eligible to file, a 
                form described in subsection (b)(3), or the student 
                certifies to the Secretary that the student is not 
                required to file an income tax return; and''; and
                    (B) in paragraph (2), by amending subparagraph (A) 
                to read as follows:
                    ``(A) the student (and the student's spouse, if 
                any) files, or is eligible to file, a form described in 
                subsection (b)(3), or the student certifies to the 
                Secretary that the student (and the student's spouse, 
                if any) is not required to file an income tax return; 
                and''.

SEC. 476. REFUSAL OR ADJUSTMENT OF LOAN CERTIFICATIONS.

    Section 479A (20 U.S.C. 1087tt) is amended--
            (1) in subsection (a), by inserting ``Special circumstances 
        may include tuition expenses at an elementary school or 
        secondary school, medical or dental expenses not covered by 
        insurance, other changes in a family's income or assets, or 
        changes in a student's status.'' after ``absence of special 
        circumstances.''; and
            (2) by amending subsection (c) to read as follows:
    ``(c) Refusal or Adjustment of Loan Certifications.--An eligible 
institution may refuse to certify a statement that permits a student to 
receive a loan under part B, or refuse to make a loan under part D, or 
may certify a loan amount or make a loan that is less than the 
student's determination of need (as determined under this part), if the 
reason for the action is documented and provided in written form to the 
student. No eligible institution shall discriminate against any 
borrower or applicant in obtaining a loan on the basis of race, 
national origin, religion, sex, marital status, age, or disability 
status.''.

SEC. 477. TREATMENT OF OTHER FINANCIAL ASSISTANCE.

    Section 480(j)(3) (20 U.S.C. 1087vv(j)(3)) is amended by inserting 
``educational assistance after discharge or release from service under 
chapter 30 of title 38, United States Code, or'' after ``paragraph 
(1),''.

                       PART G--GENERAL PROVISIONS

SEC. 481. DEFINITION OF INSTITUTION OF HIGHER EDUCATION.

    Subparagraph (A) of section 481(a)(2) (20 U.S.C. 1088(a)(2)) is 
amended--
            (1) in the second sentence, by inserting ``or veterinary'' 
        after ``case of a graduate medical'';
            (2) by striking ``attending a graduate medical school'' and 
        inserting ``attending such school''; and
            (3) by amending clause (ii) to read as follows:
                            ``(ii) the institution has a clinical 
                        training program that was approved by a State 
                        as of January 1, 1992, or students enrolled in 
                        the institution complete their clinical 
                        training at an approved veterinary school 
                        located in the United States.''.

SEC. 482. MASTER CALENDAR.

    Section 482 (20 U.S.C. 1089) is amended--
            (1) in subsection (a), by adding at the end the following:
            ``(3) To the extent feasible, the Secretary shall notify 
        eligible institutions and vendors by December 1 prior to the 
        start of an award year of minimal hardware and software 
        requirements necessary to administer programs under this 
        title.''; and
            (2) by amending subsection (c) to read as follows:
    ``(c) Delay of Effective Date of Late Publications.--(1) Except as 
provided in paragraph (2), any regulatory changes initiated by the 
Secretary affecting the programs under this title that have not been 
published in final form by November 1 prior to the start of the award 
year shall not become effective until the beginning of the second award 
year after such November 1 date.
    ``(2)(A) The Secretary may designate any regulatory provision that 
affects the programs under this title and is published in final form 
after November 1 as one that an entity subject to the provision may, in 
the entity's discretion, choose to implement prior to the effective 
date described in paragraph (1). The Secretary may specify in the 
designation when, and under what conditions, an entity may implement 
the provision prior to that effective date. The Secretary shall publish 
any designation under this subparagraph in the Federal Register.
    ``(B) If an entity chooses to implement a regulatory provision 
prior to the effective date described in paragraph (1), as permitted by 
subparagraph (A), the provision shall be effective with respect to that 
entity in accordance with the terms of the Secretary's designation.''.

SEC. 483. FORMS AND REGULATIONS.

    Section 483 (20 U.S.C. 1090) is amended--
            (1) in subsection (a)--
                    (A) in the subsection heading, by striking ``Form'' 
                and inserting ``Form Development'';
                    (B) by amending paragraph (1) to read as follows:
            ``(1) Single form requirements.--The Secretary, in 
        cooperation with representatives of agencies and organizations 
        involved in student financial assistance, shall produce, 
        distribute, and process free of charge a common financial 
        reporting form (which shall include electronic versions of the 
        form) to be used--
                    ``(A) to determine the need (including the expected 
                family contribution and, if appropriate, cost of 
                attendance) and eligibility of a student for financial 
                assistance under parts A, C, D, and E; and
                    ``(B) to determine the need (including the expected 
                family contribution and cost of attendance) of a 
                student for the purposes of part B.
            ``(2) State data items.--The Secretary shall include on the 
        form developed under this subsection such data items, selected 
        in consultation with the States to assist the States in 
        awarding State student financial assistance, as the Secretary 
        determines are appropriate for inclusion.
            ``(3) Parent's social security number.--The Secretary shall 
        include on the form developed under this paragraph space for 
        the social security number of parents of dependent students 
        seeking financial assistance under this title.
            ``(4) Use.--The Secretary shall require that the form 
        developed under this paragraph be used for the purpose of 
        collecting eligibility and other data for purposes of part B, 
        including the applicant's choice of lender.''; and
                    (C) in paragraph (3)--
                            (i) by striking ``Institutions of higher 
                        education and States shall receive'' and 
                        inserting ``The Secretary shall provide''; and
                            (ii) by striking ``by the Secretary''; and
            (2) by adding at the end the following:
    ``(g) Payment for Data.--The Secretary may pay such charges as the 
Secretary determines are necessary to obtain data that the Secretary 
considers essential to the efficient administration of the programs 
under this title.
    ``(h) Master Promissory Note.--
            ``(1) In general.--The Secretary shall develop and require 
        the use of a master promissory note, for loans made under this 
        title for periods of enrollment beginning on or after July 1, 
        2000, that may be applicable to more than 1 academic year, or 
        more than 1 type of loan made under this title. Prior to 
        implementing the master promissory note for all loans made 
        under this title, the Secretary may develop, test, and require 
        the use of such a master promissory note on a limited or pilot 
        basis.
            ``(2) Consultation.--In developing the master promissory 
        note under this subsection, the Secretary shall consult with 
        representatives of guaranty agencies, eligible lenders, 
        institutions of higher education, students, and organizations 
        involved in student financial assistance.
            ``(3) Sale; assignment; enforceability.--Notwithstanding 
        any other provision of law, each loan made under a master 
        promissory note under this subsection may be sold or assigned 
        independently of any other loan made under the same promissory 
        note and each such loan shall be separately enforceable in all 
        Federal and State courts on the basis of an original or copy of 
        the master promissory note in accordance with the terms of the 
        master promissory note.''.

SEC. 484. STUDENT ELIGIBILITY.

    (a) Amendments.--Section 484 (20 U.S.C. 1091) is amended--
            (1) in subsection (d)--
                    (A) in the matter preceding paragraph (1), by 
                striking ``either''; and
                    (B) by adding at the end the following:
            ``(3) The student has completed a high school education in 
        a home school setting and has met any State requirements with 
        respect to such education in a home school setting.'';
            (2) in subsection (l), by amending paragraph (1) to read as 
        follows:
            ``(1) Relation to correspondence courses.--
                    ``(A) In general.--A student enrolled in a course 
                of instruction at an institution of higher education 
                that is offered in whole or in part through 
                telecommunications and leads to a recognized 
                certificate for a program of study of 1 year or longer, 
                or a recognized associate, baccalaureate, or graduate 
                degree, conferred by such institution, shall not be 
                considered to be enrolled in correspondence courses 
                unless the total amount of telecommunications and 
                correspondence courses at such institution equals or 
                exceeds 50 percent of the total amount of all courses 
                at the institution.
                    ``(B) Requirement.--An institution of higher 
                education referred to in subparagraph (A) is an 
                institution of higher education--
                            ``(i) that is not an institute or school 
                        described in section 521(4)(C) of the Carl D. 
                        Perkins Vocational and Applied Technology 
                        Education Act; and
                            ``(ii) for which at least 50 percent of the 
                        programs of study offered by the institution 
                        lead to the award of a recognized associate, 
                        baccalaureate, or graduate degree.''; and
            (3) by adding at the end the following:
    ``(q) Verification of IRS Return Information.--The Secretary shall 
verify the information reported by all applicants for assistance on the 
form prescribed under section 483 with the return information (as 
defined in section 6103 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986) available 
to the Secretary of the Treasury. Notwithstanding section 6103 of such 
Code the Secretary of the Treasury shall provide the return information 
to the Secretary. In the case of a dependent student the return 
information shall include the return information of the parent of the 
student. The form prescribed by the Secretary under section 483 shall 
contain a prominent notice of the verification of the information and a 
warning to all the applicants of the penalties for misrepresentation, 
with respect to the information, under the United States Code.
    ``(r) Suspension of Eligibility for Drug-Related Offenses.--
            ``(1) In general.--A student who has been convicted of any 
        offense under any Federal or State law involving the possession 
        or sale of a controlled substance shall not be eligible to 
        receive any grant, loan, or work assistance under this title 
        during the period beginning on the date of such conviction and 
        ending after the interval specified in the following table:

``If convicted of an offense involving:

    The possession of a con-
                                          
      trolled substance:
                                        Ineligibility period is:
        First offense..............
                                            1 year 
        Second offense.............
                                            2 years 
        Third offense..............
                                            Indefinite.

    The sale of a controlled
                                          
      substance:
                                        Ineligibility period is:
        First offense..............
                                            2 years 
        Second offense.............
                                            Indefinite.
            ``(2) Rehabilitation.--A student whose eligibility has been 
        suspended under paragraph (1) may resume eligibility before the 
        end of the ineligibility period determined under such paragraph 
        if--
                    ``(A) the student satisfactorily completes a drug 
                rehabilitation program that--
                            ``(i) complies with such criteria as the 
                        Secretary shall prescribe in regulations for 
                        purposes of this paragraph; and
                            ``(ii) includes 2 unannounced drug tests; 
                        or
                    ``(B) the conviction is expunged by pardon, 
                reversed, set aside, or otherwise rendered nugatory.
            ``(3) Definitions.--In this subsection, the term 
        `controlled substance' has the meaning given the term in 
        section 102(6) of the Controlled Substances Act (21 U.S.C. 
        802(6)).''.
    (b) Effective Date.--The amendment made by subsection (a)(2) 
regarding suspension of eligibility for drug-related offenses, shall 
apply with respect to financial assistance to cover the costs of 
attendance for periods of enrollment beginning after the date of 
enactment of this Act.

SEC. 485. INSTITUTIONAL REFUNDS.

    Section 484B (20 U.S.C. 1091b) is amended to read as follows:

``SEC. 484B. INSTITUTIONAL REFUNDS.

    ``(a) Return of Title IV Funds.--
            ``(1) In general.--If a recipient of assistance under this 
        title withdraws from a payment period in which the recipient 
        began attendance, the amount of grant (other than assistance 
        received under part C of this title) or loan assistance to be 
        returned to the title IV programs is calculated according to 
        paragraph (2) and returned in accordance with subsection (b).
            ``(2) Calculation of amount of title iv assistance 
        earned.--
                    ``(A) In general.--The amount of grant or loan 
                assistance under this title that is earned by the 
                recipient for purposes of this section is calculated 
                by--
                            ``(i) determining the percentage of grant 
                        and loan assistance under this title that has 
                        been earned by the student, as described in 
                        subparagraph (B); and
                            ``(ii) applying such percentage to the 
                        total amount of such grant and loan assistance 
                        that was disbursed (and that could have been 
                        disbursed) to the student, or on the student's 
                        behalf, for the payment period, as of the day 
                        the student withdrew.
                    ``(B) Percentage earned.--For purposes of 
                subparagraph (A)(i), the percentage of grant or loan 
                assistance under this title that has been earned by the 
                student is--
                            ``(i) equal to the percentage of the 
                        payment period completed (as determined in 
                        accordance with subsection (d)) as of the day 
                        the student withdrew, provided that such date 
                        occurs on or before the completion of 60 
                        percent of the payment period; or
                            ``(ii) 100 percent, if the day the student 
                        withdrew occurs after the student has completed 
                        60 percent of the payment period.
                    ``(C) Percentage not earned.--For purposes of 
                subsection (b), the amount of grant and loan assistance 
                awarded under this title that has not been earned by 
                the student shall be calculated by--
                            ``(i) determining the complement of the 
                        percentage of grant or loan assistance under 
                        this title has been earned by the student 
                        described in subparagraph (B); and
                            ``(ii) applying the percentage determined 
                        under clause (i) to the total amount of such 
                        grant and loan assistance that was disbursed 
                        (and that could have been disbursed) to the 
                        student, or on the student's behalf, for the 
                        payment period, as of the day the student 
                        withdrew.
            ``(3) Differences between amounts earned and amounts 
        received.--
                    ``(A) In general.--If the student has received less 
                grant or loan assistance than the amount earned, as 
                calculated under paragraph (2)(B), the institution of 
                higher education shall comply with the procedures for 
                late disbursement specified by the Secretary in 
                regulations.
                    ``(B) Return.--If the student has received more 
                grant or loan assistance than the amount earned, as 
                calculated under paragraph (2)(B), the unearned funds 
                shall be returned by the institution or the student, or 
                both, as may be required under paragraphs (1) and (2) 
                of subsection (b), to the programs under this title in 
                the order specified in subsection (b)(3).
    ``(b) Return of Title IV Program Funds.--
            ``(1) Responsibility of the institution.--The institution 
        shall return, in the order specified in paragraph (3), the 
        lesser of--
                    ``(A) the amount of grant and loan assistance 
                awarded under this title that has not been earned by 
                the student, as calculated under subsection (a)(2)(C); 
                or
                    ``(B) an amount equal to--
                            ``(i) the total institutional charges for 
                        the payment period; multiplied by
                            ``(ii) the percentage of grant and loan 
                        assistance awarded under this title that has 
                        not been earned by the student, as described in 
                        subsection (a)(2)(C).
            ``(2) Responsibility of the student.--
                    ``(A) In general.--The student shall return 
                assistance that has not been earned by the student as 
                described in subsection (a)(2)(C) in the order 
                specified in paragraph (3) minus the amount the 
                institution is required to return under paragraph (1).
                    ``(B) Special rule.--The student shall return or 
                repay, as appropriate, the amount determined under 
                subparagraph (A) to--
                            ``(i) a loan program under this title in 
                        accordance with the terms of the loan; and
                            ``(ii) a grant program under this title, as 
                        an overpayment of such grant and shall be 
                        subject to overpayment collection procedures 
                        prescribed by the Secretary.
            ``(3) Order of return of title iv funds.--
                    ``(A) In general.--Excess funds returned by the 
                institution or the student, as appropriate, in 
                accordance with paragraph (1) or (2), respectively, 
                shall be credited to outstanding balances on loans made 
                under this title to the student or on behalf of the 
                student for the payment period for which a return of 
                funds is required. Such excess funds shall be credited 
                in the following order:
                            ``(i) To outstanding balances on loans made 
                        under section 428H for the payment period for 
                        which a return of funds is required.
                            ``(ii) To outstanding balances on loans 
                        made under section 428 for the payment period 
                        for which a return of funds is required.
                            ``(iii) To outstanding balances on 
                        unsubsidized loans (other than parent loans) 
                        made under part D for the payment period for 
                        which a return of funds is required.
                            ``(iv) To outstanding balances on 
                        subsidized loans made under part D for the 
                        payment period for which a return of funds is 
                        required.
                            ``(v) To outstanding balances on loans made 
                        under part E for the payment period for which a 
                        return of funds is required.
                            ``(vi) To outstanding balances on loans 
                        made under section 428B for the payment period 
                        for which a return of funds is required.
                            ``(vii) To outstanding balances on parent 
                        loans made under part D for the payment period 
                        for which a return of funds is required.
                    ``(B) Remaining excesses.--If excess funds remain 
                after repaying all outstanding loan amounts, the 
                remaining excess shall be credited in the following 
                order:
                            ``(i) To awards under subpart 1 of part A 
                        for the payment period for which a return of 
                        funds is required.
                            ``(ii) To awards under subpart 3 of part A 
                        for the payment period for which a return of 
                        funds is required.
                            ``(iii) To other assistance awarded under 
                        this title for which a return of funds is 
                        required.
    ``(c) Withdrawal Date.--
            ``(1) In general.--In this section, the term `day the 
        student withdrew'--
                    ``(A) is the date that the institution determines--
                            ``(i) the student began the withdrawal 
                        process prescribed by the institution;
                            ``(ii) the student otherwise provided 
                        official notification to the institution of the 
                        intent to withdraw; or
                            ``(iii) in the case of a student who does 
                        not begin the withdrawal process or otherwise 
                        notify the institution of the intent to 
                        withdraw, the date that the payment period ends 
                        for which aid under this title was disbursed; 
                        or
                    ``(B) for schools required to take attendance, is 
                determined by the institution from such attendance 
                records.
            ``(2) Special rule.--Notwithstanding paragraph (1), if the 
        institution determines that a student was not able to begin the 
        withdrawal process, or otherwise notify the institution of the 
        intent to withdraw, due to illness, accident, grievous personal 
        loss, or other such circumstances beyond the student's control, 
        the institution may determine the appropriate withdrawal date.
    ``(d) Percentage of the Payment Period Completed.--For purposes of 
subsection (a)(2)(B)(i), the percentage of the payment period completed 
is determined--
            ``(1) in the case of a program that is measured in credit 
        hours, by dividing the total number of calendar days comprising 
        the payment period into the number of calendar days completed 
        in that period as of the day the student withdrew; and
            ``(2) in the case of a program that is measured in clock 
        hours, by dividing the total number of clock hours comprising 
        the payment period into the number of clock hours completed by 
        the student in that payment period as of the day the student 
        withdrew.''.

SEC. 486. INSTITUTIONAL AND FINANCIAL ASSISTANCE INFORMATION FOR 
              STUDENTS.

    (a) Information Dissemination Activities.--Section 485(a) (20 
U.S.C. 1092(a)) is amended--
            (1) in paragraph (1)--
                    (A) in the second sentence, by striking ``, through 
                appropriate publications and mailings, to all current 
                students, and to any prospective student upon 
                request.'' and inserting ``upon request, through 
                appropriate publications, mailings, and electronic 
                media to an enrolled student, and to any prospective 
                student.'';
                    (B) by inserting after the second sentence the 
                following: ``Each eligible institution annually shall 
                provide to all students enrolled at the institution, a 
                list of the information that is required by this 
                section, together with a statement of the procedures 
                required to obtain the information.'';
                    (C) by amending subparagraph (F) to read as 
                follows:
                    ``(F) a statement of--
                            ``(i) the requirements of any refund policy 
                        with which the institution is required to 
                        comply;
                            ``(ii) the requirements under section 484B 
                        for the return of grant or loan assistance 
                        provided under this title; and
                            ``(iii) the requirements for officially 
                        withdrawing from the institution;'';
                    (D) in subparagraph (M)(ii), by striking ``and'' 
                after the semicolon; and
                    (E) in subparagraph (N), by striking the period and 
                inserting ``; and'';
            (2) in paragraph (2), by inserting ``an application for'' 
        after ``concerning''; and
            (3) in paragraph (3), by amending subparagraph (A) to read 
        as follows:
                    ``(A) shall be made available by July 1 each year 
                to current and prospective students prior to enrolling 
                or entering into any financial obligation; and''.
    (b) Exit Counseling for Borrowers.--Section 485(b) (20 U.S.C. 
1092(b)) is amended--
            (1) in paragraph (1)(A), by striking ``(individually or in 
        groups)''; and
            (2) in paragraph (2), by adding at the end the following:
    ``(C) Nothing in this subsection shall be construed to prohibit an 
institution of higher education from utilizing electronic means to 
provide personalized exit counseling.''.
    (c) Disclosures Required With Respect to Athletically Related 
Student Aid.--Section 485(e) (20 U.S.C. 1092(e)) is amended--
            (1) by amending paragraph (2) to read as follows:
            ``(2) When an institution described in paragraph (1) offers 
        a potential student athlete athletically related student aid, 
        such institution shall provide to the student, the student's 
        parents, the student's guidance counselor, and the student's 
        coach the information contained in the report submitted by such 
        institution pursuant to paragraph (1). If the institution is a 
        member of a national collegiate athletic association that 
        compiles graduation rate data on behalf of its member 
        institutions, that the Secretary determines is substantially 
        comparable to the information described in the previous 
        sentence, the distribution of the compilation to all secondary 
        schools shall fulfill the responsibility of the institution to 
        provide the information to a prospective student athlete's 
        guidance counselor and coach.''; and
            (2) by amending paragraph (9) to read as follows:
            ``(9) The reports required by this subsection shall be due 
        each July 1 and shall cover the 1-year period ending August 31 
        of the preceding year.''.
    (d) Disclosure of Campus Security Policy and Campus Crime 
Statistics.--Section 485(f) (20 U.S.C. 1092(f)) is amended--
            (1) by amending subparagraph (F) of paragraph (1) to read 
        as follows:
                    ``(F) Statistics concerning the occurrence on 
                campus, during the most recent calendar year, and 
                during the 2 preceding calendar years for which data 
                are available--
                            ``(i) of the following criminal offenses 
                        reported to campus security authorities or 
                        local police agencies--
                                    ``(I) homicide, including murder or 
                                nonnegligent manslaughter or negligent 
                                manslaughter;
                                    ``(II) sex offenses, forcible or 
                                nonforcible;
                                    ``(III) robbery;
                                    ``(IV) aggravated assault;
                                    ``(V) burglary;
                                    ``(VI) motor vehicle theft; and
                                    ``(VII) arson;
                            ``(ii) of the crimes described in 
                        subclauses (I) through (VII), and vandalism and 
                        simple assault, that manifest evidence of 
                        prejudice based on actual or perceived race, 
                        gender, religion, sexual orientation, 
                        ethnicity, or disability that are reported to 
                        campus security authorities or local police 
                        agencies, which data shall be collected and 
                        reported according to category of prejudice.'';
            (2) by redesignating paragraphs (4) through (7) as 
        paragraphs (5) through (8), respectively;
            (3) by inserting after paragraph (3) the following:
            ``(4)(A) Each institution participating in any program 
        under this title which maintains either a police or security 
        department of any kind shall make, keep, and maintain a daily 
        log, written in a form that can be easily understood, recording 
        all crimes reported to such police or security department, 
        including--
                    ``(i) the nature, date, time, and general location 
                of each crime; and
                    ``(ii) the disposition of the complaint, if known.
            ``(B)(i) All entries that are required pursuant to this 
        paragraph shall, except where disclosure of such information is 
        prohibited by law or such disclosure would jeopardize the 
        confidentiality of the victim, be open to public inspection 
        within 2 business days of the initial report being made to the 
        department or a campus security authority.
            ``(ii) If new information about an entry into a log becomes 
        available to a police or security department, then the new 
        information shall be recorded in the log not later than 2 
        business days after the information becomes available to the 
        police or security department.
            ``(iii) Where there is clear and convincing evidence that 
        the release of such information would jeopardize an ongoing 
        criminal investigation or the safety of an individual, cause a 
        suspect to flee or evade detection, or result in the 
        destruction of evidence, such information may be withheld until 
        that damage is no longer likely to occur from the release of 
        such information.
            ``(iv) Notwithstanding clause (iii), an institution of 
        higher education shall record all criminal incidents occurring 
        on campus and shall make the reports open to public inspection 
        not later than 2 business days after the requirements of clause 
        (iii) are met.'';
            (4) in paragraph (6) (as redesignated by paragraph (2)), by 
        amending subparagraph (A) to read as follows: ``(A) For 
        purposes of this section the term `campus' means--
                    ``(i) any building or property owned or controlled 
                by an institution of higher education within the same 
                reasonably contiguous geographic area of the 
                institution, including a building or property owned by 
                the institution, but controlled by another person, such 
                as a food or other retail vendor;
                    ``(ii) any building or property owned or controlled 
                by a student organization recognized by the 
                institution;
                    ``(iii) all public property that is within the same 
                reasonably contiguous geographic area of the 
                institution, such as a sidewalk, a street, other 
                thoroughfare, or parking facility, that is adjacent to 
                a facility owned or controlled by the institution;
                    ``(iv) any building or property (other than a 
                branch campus) owned or controlled by an institution of 
                higher education that is used in direct support of, or 
                in relation to, the institution's educational purposes, 
                is used by students, and is not within the same 
                reasonably contiguous geographic area of the 
                institution; and
                    ``(v) all dormitories or other student residential 
                facilities owned or controlled by the institution.'';
            (5) in paragraph (7) (as redesignated by subparagraph (B)), 
        by inserting at the end the following: ``Such statistics shall 
        not identify victims of crimes or persons accused of crimes, 
        except as required by State or local law.''; and
            (6) by adding at the end the following:
            ``(9) Study.--
                    ``(A) In general.--The Secretary, in consultation 
                with the Attorney General, shall provide for a national 
                study to examine procedures undertaken after an 
                institution of higher education receives a report of 
                sexual assault.
                    ``(B) Report.--The study required by subparagraph 
                (A) shall include an analysis of--
                            ``(i) the existence and publication of the 
                        institution of higher education's and State's 
                        definition of sexual assault;
                            ``(ii) the existence and publication of the 
                        institution's policy for campus sexual 
                        assaults;
                            ``(iii) the individuals to whom reports of 
                        sexual assault are given most often and--
                                    ``(I) how the individuals are 
                                trained to respond to the reports; and
                                    ``(II) the extent to which the 
                                individuals are trained;
                            ``(iv) the reporting options that are 
                        articulated to the victim or victims of the 
                        sexual assault regarding--
                                    ``(I) on-campus reporting and 
                                procedure options; and
                                    ``(II) off-campus reporting and 
                                procedure options;
                            ``(v) the resources available for victims' 
                        safety, support, medical health, and 
                        confidentiality, including--
                                    ``(I) how well the resources are 
                                articulated both specifically to the 
                                victim of sexual assault and generally 
                                to the campus at large; and
                                    ``(II) the security of the 
                                resources in terms of confidentiality 
                                or reputation;
                            ``(vi) policies and practices that may 
                        prevent or discourage the reporting of campus 
                        sexual assaults to local crime authorities, or 
                        that may otherwise obstruct justice or 
                        interfere with the prosecution of perpetrators 
                        of campus sexual assaults;
                            ``(vii) policies and practices found 
                        successful in aiding the report and any ensuing 
                        investigation or prosecution of a campus sexual 
                        assault;
                            ``(viii) the on-campus procedures for 
                        investigation and disciplining the perpetrator 
                        of a sexual assault, including--
                                    ``(I) the format for collecting 
                                evidence; and
                                    ``(II) the format of the 
                                investigation and disciplinary 
                                proceeding, including the faculty 
                                responsible for running the 
                                disciplinary procedure and the persons 
                                allowed to attend the disciplinary 
                                procedure; and
                            ``(ix) types of punishment for offenders, 
                        including--
                                    ``(I) whether the case is directed 
                                outside for further punishment; and
                                    ``(II) how the institution punishes 
                                perpetrators.
                    ``(C) Submission of report.--The report required by 
                subparagraph (B) shall be submitted to Congress not 
                later than September 1, 1999.
                    ``(D) Definition.--For purposes of this section, 
                the term `campus sexual assaults' means sexual assaults 
                occurring at institutions of higher education and 
                sexual assaults committed against or by students or 
                employees of such institutions.
                    ``(E) Authorization of appropriations.--There is 
                authorized to be appropriated to carry out this section 
                $1,000,000 for fiscal year 1999.
            ``(10)(A) The Secretary shall report to the appropriate 
        committees of Congress each institution of higher education 
        that the Secretary determines is not in compliance with the 
        reporting requirements of this subsection.
            ``(B) The Secretary shall provide to an institution of 
        higher education that the Secretary determines is having 
        difficulty, or is not in compliance, with the reporting 
        requirements of this subsection--
                    ``(i) data and analysis regarding successful 
                practices employed by institutions of higher education 
                to reduce campus crime; and
                    ``(ii) technical assistance.
            ``(11) For purposes of reporting the statistics described 
        in paragraphs (1)(F) and (1)(H), an institution of higher 
        education shall distinguish, by means of separate categories, 
        any criminal offenses that occur--
                    ``(A) on publicly owned sidewalks, streets, or 
                other thoroughfares, or in parking facilities, that are 
                adjacent to facilities owned by the institution; and
                    ``(B) in dormitories or other residential 
                facilities for students on campus.
            ``(12)(A) Upon determination, after reasonable notice and 
        opportunity for a hearing on the record, that an institution of 
        higher education--
                    ``(i) has violated or failed to carry out any 
                provision of this subsection or any regulation 
                prescribed under this subsection; or
                    ``(ii) has substantially misrepresented the number, 
                location, or nature of the crimes required to be 
                reported under this subsection,
        the Secretary shall impose a civil penalty upon the institution 
        of not to exceed $25,000 for each violation, failure, or 
        misrepresentation.
            ``(B) Any civil penalty may be compromised by the 
        Secretary. In determining the amount of such penalty, or the 
        amount agreed upon in compromise, the appropriateness of the 
        penalty to the size of the institution of higher education 
        subject to the determination, and the gravity of the violation, 
        failure, or misrepresentation shall be considered. The amount 
        of such penalty, when finally determined, or the amount agreed 
        upon in compromise, may be deducted from any sums owing by the 
        United States to the institution charged.
            ``(13)(A) Nothing in this subsection may be construed to--
                    ``(i) create a cause of action against any 
                institution of higher education or any employee of such 
                an institution for any civil liability; or
                    ``(ii) establish any standard of care.
            ``(B) Notwithstanding any other provision of law, evidence 
        regarding compliance or noncompliance with this subsection 
        shall not be admissible as evidence in any proceeding of any 
        court, agency, board, or other entity, except with respect to 
        an action to enforce this subsection
            ``(14) This subsection may be cited as the `Jeanne Clery 
        Disclosure of Campus Security Policy and Campus Crime 
        Statistics Act'.''.
    (e) Data Required.--Section 485(g) (20 U.S.C. 1092(g)) is amended--
            (1) in paragraph (1), by adding at the end the following:
                    ``(I)(i) The total revenues, and the revenues from 
                football, men's basketball, women's basketball, all 
                other men's sports combined, and all other women's 
                sports combined, derived by the institution from the 
                institution's intercollegiate athletics activities.
                    ``(ii) For the purpose of clause (i) revenues from 
                intercollegiate athletics activities allocable to a 
                sport shall include, without limitation, gate receipts, 
                broadcast revenues, appearance guarantees and options, 
                concessions and advertising, except that revenues such 
                as student activities fees or alumni contributions not 
                so allocable shall be included in the calculation of 
                total revenues only.
                    ``(J)(i) The total expenses, and the expenses 
                attributable to football, men's basketball, women's 
                basketball, all other men's sports combined and all 
                other women's sports combined, made by the institution 
                for the institution's intercollegiate athletics 
                activities.
                    ``(ii) For the purpose of clause (i) expenses for 
                intercollegiate athletics activities allocable to a 
                sport shall include without limitation grants-in-aid, 
                salaries, travel, equipment, and supplies, except that 
                expenses such as general and administrative overhead 
                not so allocable shall be included in the calculation 
                of total expenses only.''.
            (2) by striking paragraph (5);
            (3) by redesignating paragraph (4) as paragraph (5); and
            (4) by inserting after paragraph (3) the following:
            ``(4) Submission; report; information availability.--(A) 
        Each institution of higher education described in paragraph (1) 
        shall provide to the Secretary, within 15 days of the date that 
        the institution makes available the report under paragraph (1), 
        the information contained in the report.
            ``(B) The Secretary shall prepare a report regarding the 
        information received under subparagraph (A) for each year by 
        April 1 of the year. The report shall--
                    ``(i) summarize the information and identify trends 
                in the information;
                    ``(ii) aggregate the information by divisions of 
                the National Collegiate Athletic Association; and
                    ``(iii) contain information on each individual 
                institution of higher education.
            ``(C) The Secretary shall ensure that the report described 
        in subparagraph (B) is made available on the Internet within a 
        reasonable period of time.
            ``(D) The Secretary shall notify, not later than 180 days 
        after the date of enactment of the Higher Education Amendments 
        of 1998, all secondary schools in all States regarding the 
        availability of the information reported under subparagraph (B) 
        and the information made available under paragraph (1), and how 
        such information may be accessed.''.
    (f) GEPA Amendment.--Section 444(a)(4)(B) of the General Education 
Provisions Act (20 U.S.C. 1232g(a)(4)(B)) is amended--
            (1) by redesignating clauses (iii) and (iv) as clauses (iv) 
        and (v), respectively; and
            (2) by inserting after clause (ii) the following:
                            ``(iii) records that are maintained by 
                        local police or campus security officers of an 
                        educational agency or institution about--
                                    ``(I) individuals who have been 
                                found guilty of, or have pled guilty 
                                to, committing or participating in any 
                                criminal activity as defined in 
                                Federal, State, or local law that has 
                                occurred while the individual was a 
                                student in attendance, including audit 
                                or noncredit, at an educational 
                                institution; and
                                    ``(II) findings of guilt of 
                                criminal misconduct and related 
                                sanctions from any previously attended 
                                educational agencies or institutions 
                                where such records were created on or 
                                after September 1, 1999;''.

SEC. 487. NATIONAL STUDENT LOAN DATA BANK SYSTEM.

    Section 485B (20 U.S.C. 1092b) is amended by adding at the end the 
following:
    ``(h) Student Status Confirmation Report.--In order to reduce 
unnecessary paperwork and to increase the efficient administration, the 
Secretary shall assure that borrowers under part E are included in the 
Student Status Confirmation Report in the same manner as borrowers 
under parts B and D.''.

SEC. 488. TRAINING IN FINANCIAL AID SERVICES.

    Section 486 (20 U.S.C. 1093) is amended to read as follows:

``SEC. 486. INFORMATION ON THE COSTS OF HIGHER EDUCATION.

    ``(a) In General.--For the purpose of providing comparative 
information to families about the costs of higher education--
            ``(1) the National Center for Education Statistics shall--
                    ``(A) develop a standard definition for the 
                following data elements:
                            ``(i) Tuition and fees for a full-time 
                        undergraduate student.
                            ``(ii) Cost of attendance for a full-time 
                        undergraduate student, consistent with the 
                        provisions of section 472.
                            ``(iii) Average amount of financial 
                        assistance received by an undergraduate student 
                        who attends an institution of higher education, 
                        including--
                                    ``(I) each type of assistance or 
                                benefit described in section 
                                428(a)(2)(C)(i);
                                    ``(II) fellowships; and
                                    ``(III) institutional and other 
                                assistance.
                            ``(iv) Percentage of students receiving 
                        financial assistance described in each of 
                        subclauses (I), (II), and (III) of clause 
                        (iii);
                    ``(B) report the definitions to each institution of 
                higher education and the Committee on Labor and Human 
                Resources of the Senate and the Committee on Education 
                and the Workforce of the House of Representatives not 
                later than 90 days after the date of enactment of the 
                Higher Education Amendments of 1998;
                    ``(C) collect information regarding the data 
                elements described in subparagraph (A) with respect to 
                at least all institutions of higher education 
                participating in the program under this title, and make 
                available the information each year in a timely fashion 
                through the integrated postsecondary education data 
                system, beginning with the information from the 1999-
                2000 academic year;
                    ``(D) provide the public notice when the 
                information described in subparagraph (C) is available 
                for public inspection; and
                    ``(E) publish in a timely fashion a report after 
                the third year of collection of the information 
                described in subparagraph (C) that compares the 
                information described in subparagraph (C) 
                longitudinally by institution, which information shall 
                be presented in a form that is easily understandable, 
                including clear definitions of the data elements 
                described in subparagraph (A), to allow parents and 
                students to make informed decisions about attending 
                college; and
            ``(2) institutions of higher education shall provide 
        information regarding each data element described in paragraph 
        (1)(A) to the National Center for Education Statistics by March 
        1 of each year, beginning in the year 2000.
    ``(b) Study.--
            ``(1) In general.--In consultation with the Bureau of Labor 
        Statistics, the National Center for Education Statistics shall 
        conduct a national study of expenditures at institutions of 
        higher education. Such study shall include information about--
                    ``(A) expenditures for--
                            ``(i) faculty salaries and benefits;
                            ``(ii) administrative salaries, benefits, 
                        and expenses;
                            ``(iii) academic support services;
                            ``(iv) research;
                            ``(v) operations and maintenance;
                            ``(vi) construction; and
                            ``(vii) technology;
                    ``(B) the replacement cost of instructional 
                buildings and equipment;
                    ``(C) how the expenditures described in 
                subparagraph (A) change over time; and
                    ``(D) how the expenditures described in 
                subparagraph (A) and the replacement cost described in 
                subparagraph (B) relate to college costs.
            ``(2) Final report.--The National Center for Education 
        Statistics shall submit a report regarding the findings of the 
        study required by paragraph (1) to the Committee on Labor and 
        Human Resources of the Senate and the Committee on Education 
        and the Workforce of the House of Representatives not later 
        than September 30, 2001.
    ``(c) Higher Education Market Basket.--In consultation with the 
Bureau of Labor Statistics, the National Center for Education 
Statistics shall develop a Higher Education Market Basket that 
identifies the items that comprise the costs of higher education. The 
National Center for Education Statistics shall provide a report on the 
market basket to the Committee on Labor and Human Resources of the 
Senate and the Committee on Education and the Workforce of the House of 
Representatives not later than September 30, 2002.
    ``(d) Fines.--In addition to the actions authorized in section 
487(c), the Secretary may impose a fine in an amount not to exceed 
$25,000 on an institution of higher education for failure to provide 
the information described in subsection (a)(2) in a timely or accurate 
manner, or for failure to otherwise cooperate with the National Center 
for Education Statistics regarding efforts to obtain data on the cost 
of higher education under such subsection.''.

SEC. 489. PROGRAM PARTICIPATION AGREEMENTS.

    (a) In General.--Section 487 (20 U.S.C. 1094) is amended--
            (1) in subsection (a)--
                    (A) in paragraph (3)--
                            (i) by striking subparagraph (B); and
                            (ii) by redesignating subparagraphs (C) and 
                        (D) as subparagraphs (B) and (C), respectively;
                    (B) in paragraph (9), by striking ``part B'' and 
                inserting ``part B or D'';
                    (C) in paragraph (14)--
                            (i) in subparagraph (A), by striking ``part 
                        B'' and inserting ``part B or D''; and
                            (ii) in subparagraph (B)--
                                    (I) by inserting ``for-profit'' 
                                after ``Any'';
                                    (II) by striking ``and any eligible 
                                institution which'' and inserting 
                                ``or''; and
                                    (III) by striking ``part B'' and 
                                inserting ``part B or D'';
                    (D) in paragraph (15), by striking ``State review 
                entities'' and inserting ``the State agencies'';
                    (E) by striking paragraph (18);
                    (F) by redesignating paragraphs (19) through (22) 
                as paragraphs (18) through (21), respectively; and
                    (G) by amending paragraph (20) (as redesignated by 
                subparagraph (F)) to read as follows:
            ``(20) The institution will meet the requirements 
        established by the Secretary and accrediting agencies or 
        associations, and will provide evidence to the Secretary that 
        the institution has the authority to operate within a State.''; 
        and
            (2) in subsection (c)--
                    (A) in paragraph (1)(A)--
                            (i) in clause (i)--
                                    (I) by striking ``clause (ii)'' and 
                                inserting ``clauses (ii) and (iii)'';
                                    (II) by striking ``State review 
                                entities referred to in'' and inserting 
                                ``appropriate State agency notifying 
                                the Secretary under''; and
                                    (III) by striking ``or'' after the 
                                semicolon;
                            (ii) in clause (ii), by inserting ``or'' 
                        after the semicolon; and
                            (iii) by adding at the end the following:
            ``(iii) with regard to an eligible institution (other than 
        an eligible institution described in section 481(a)(1)(C)) that 
        has obtained less than $200,000 in funds under this title 
        during each of the 2 award years that precede the audit period 
        and submits a letter of credit payable to the Secretary equal 
        to not less than \1/2\ of the annual potential liabilities of 
        such institution as determined by the Secretary, deeming an 
        audit conducted every 3 years to satisfy the requirements of 
        clause (i), except for the award year immediately preceding 
        renewal of the institution's eligibility under section 
        498(g);'';
                    (B) in paragraph (4), by striking ``, after 
                consultation with each State review entity designated 
                under subpart 1 of part H,''; and
                    (C) in paragraph (5), by striking ``State review 
                entities designated'' and inserting ``State agencies 
                notifying the Secretary''.
    (b) Provision of Voter Registration Forms.--
            (1) Program participation requirement.--Section 487(a) (20 
        U.S.C. 1094(a)) is amended by adding at the end the following:
            ``(23) The institution, if located in a State to which 
        section 113 applies, will make a good faith effort to provide a 
        mail voter registration form, received from such State, to each 
        student enrolled in a degree or certificate program and in 
        attendance at the institution and to make such forms widely 
        available to students at the institution.''.
            (2) Regulation prohibited.--No officer of the executive 
        branch is authorized to instruct the State in the manner in 
        which the amendment made by this subsection is carried out.

SEC. 490. REGULATORY RELIEF AND IMPROVEMENT.

    Section 487A (20 U.S.C. 1094a) is amended to read as follows:

``SEC. 487A. REGULATORY RELIEF AND IMPROVEMENT.

    ``(a) Quality Assurance Program.--
            ``(1) In general.--The Secretary is authorized to select 
        institutions for voluntary participation in a Quality Assurance 
        Program that provides participating institutions with an 
        alternative management approach through which individual 
        schools develop and implement their own comprehensive systems, 
        including processing and disbursement of student financial aid, 
        verification of student financial aid application data, and 
        entrance and exit interviews, thereby enhancing program 
        integrity within the student aid delivery system. The Quality 
        Assurance Program authorized by this section shall be based on 
        criteria that include demonstrated institutional performance, 
        as determined by the Secretary, and shall take into 
        consideration current quality assurance goals, as determined by 
        the Secretary.
            ``(2) Waiver.--The Secretary is authorized to waive for any 
        institution participating in the Quality Assurance Program any 
        regulations dealing with reporting or verification requirements 
        in this title that are addressed by the institution's 
        alternative management system, and may substitute such quality 
        assurance reporting as the Secretary determines necessary to 
        ensure accountability and compliance with the purposes of the 
        programs under this title.
            ``(3) Determination.--The Secretary is authorized to 
        determine--
                    ``(A) when an institution that is unable to 
                administer the Quality Assurance Program shall be 
                removed from such program; and
                    ``(B) when institutions desiring to cease 
                participation in such program will be required to 
                complete the current award year under the requirements 
                of the Quality Assurance Program.
            ``(4) Review and evaluation.--The Secretary shall review 
        and evaluate the Quality Assurance Program conducted by each 
        participating institution and, on the basis of that evaluation, 
        make recommendations regarding amendments to this Act that will 
        streamline the administration and enhance the integrity of 
        Federal student assistance programs. Such recommendations shall 
        be submitted to the Committee on Labor and Human Resources of 
        the Senate and the Committee on Education and the Workforce of 
        the House of Representatives.
    ``(b) Regulatory Improvement and Streamlining Experiments.--
            ``(1) In general.--The Secretary shall review and evaluate 
        the experience of institutions participating as experimental 
        sites during the period of 1993 through 1998 under this section 
        (as such section was in effect on the day before the date of 
        enactment of the Higher Education Amendments of 1998), and 
        shall submit a report based on this review and evaluation to 
        the Committee on Labor and Human Resources of the Senate and 
        the Committee on Education and the Workforce of the House of 
        Representatives not later than 6 months after the enactment of 
        the Higher Education Amendments of 1998. Such report shall 
        include--
                    ``(A) a list of participating institutions and the 
                specific statutory or regulatory waivers granted to 
                each institution;
                    ``(B) the findings and conclusions reached 
                regarding each of the experiments conducted; and
                    ``(C) recommendations for amendments to improve and 
                streamline this Act, based on the results of the 
                experiment.
            ``(2) Selection.--
                    ``(A) In general.--The Secretary is authorized to 
                select a limited number of institutions for voluntary 
                participation as experimental sites to provide 
                recommendations to the Secretary on the impact and 
                effectiveness of proposed regulations or new management 
                initiatives, except that additional institutions may 
                not be selected by the Secretary until the report 
                required by subsection (b)(1) has been submitted to 
                Congress.
                    ``(B) Consultation.--Prior to approving any 
                additional experimental sites, the Secretary shall 
                consult with the Committee on Labor and Human Resources 
                of the Senate and the Committee on Education and the 
                Workforce of the House of Representatives and shall 
                provide--
                            ``(i) a list of institutions proposed for 
                        participation in the experiment and the 
                        specific statutory or regulatory waivers 
                        proposed to be granted to each institution;
                            ``(ii) the objectives to be achieved 
                        through the experiment; and
                            ``(iii) the period of time over which the 
                        experiment is to be conducted.
                    ``(C) Waivers.--The Secretary is authorized to 
                waive, for any institution participating as an 
                experimental site under subparagraph (A), any 
                requirements in this title, or regulations prescribed 
                under this title, that will bias experimental results.
    ``(c) Regulatory and Statutory Relief for Small Volume 
Institutions.--The Secretary, following discussions with 
representatives of eligible institutions (other than eligible 
institutions described in section 481(a)(1)(C)) that have obtained in 
each of the 2 most recent award years prior to the date of enactment of 
the Higher Education Amendments of 1998 less than $200,000 in funds 
through this title, shall review and evaluate ways in which regulations 
under and provisions of this Act affecting the institutions may be 
improved, streamlined, or eliminated, and shall submit, not later than 
1 year after the enactment of the Higher Education Amendments of 1998, 
a report to the Committee on Labor and Human Resources of the Senate 
and the Committee on Education and the Workforce of the House of 
Representatives detailing the Secretary's findings and recommendations, 
including a timetable for implementation of any recommended changes.
    ``(d) Definitions.--For purposes of this section, the term `current 
award year' is defined as the award year during which the participating 
institution indicates the institution's intention to cease 
participation.''.

SEC. 490A. DISTANCE EDUCATION DEMONSTRATION PROGRAMS.

    Part G (20 U.S.C. 1088 et seq.) is amended by inserting after 
section 487B (20 U.S.C. 1094a) the following:

``SEC. 487C. DISTANCE EDUCATION DEMONSTRATION PROGRAMS.

    ``(a) Purpose.--It is the purpose of this section--
            ``(1) to allow demonstration programs that are strictly 
        monitored by the Department to test the quality and viability 
        of expanded distance education programs currently restricted 
        under this Act;
            ``(2) to help determine the specific statutory and 
        regulatory requirements which should be altered to provide 
        greater access to high quality distance education programs; and
            ``(3) to help determine the appropriate level of Federal 
        assistance for students enrolled in distance education 
        programs.
    ``(b) Demonstration Programs Authorized.--
            ``(1) In general.--The Secretary, in accordance with the 
        provisions of subsection (d), is authorized to select 
        institutions of higher education or consortia of such 
        institutions for voluntary participation in a Distance 
        Education Demonstration Program that provides participating 
        institutions with the ability to offer distance education 
        programs that do not meet all or a portion of the sections or 
        regulations described in paragraph (2).
            ``(2) Waivers.--The Secretary is authorized to waive for 
        any institution of higher education, system of institutions of 
        higher education, or consortium participating in a Distance 
        Education Demonstration Program, the requirements of section 
        472(5) as the section relates to computer costs, sections 
        481(d) and 481(e) as such sections relate to requirements for a 
        minimum number of weeks of instruction, sections 472(10), 
        481(a)(3)(A), 481(a)(3)(B), 484(l)(1), or 1 or more of the 
        regulations prescribed under this part or part F which inhibit 
        the operation of quality distance education programs.
            ``(3) Special rules.--
                    ``(A) Eligible institutions.--Only an institution 
                of higher education that provides at least a 2-year, or 
                4-year program of instruction for which the institution 
                awards an associate or a baccalaureate degree, or 
                provides a graduate degree, shall be eligible to 
                participate in the demonstration program authorized 
                under this section.
                    ``(B) Prohibition.--An institution of higher 
                education described in section 481(a)(1)(C) shall not 
                be eligible to participate in the demonstration program 
                authorized under this section.
                    ``(C) Special rule.--Subject to subparagraph (B), 
                an institution of higher education that meets the 
                requirements of subsection (a) of section 481, other 
                than the requirement of paragraph (3)(A) or (3)(B) of 
                such subsection, shall be eligible to participate in 
                the demonstration program authorized under this 
                section.
                    ``(D) Requirement.--Notwithstanding any other 
                provision of this paragraph, Western Governors 
                University shall be considered eligible to participate 
                in the demonstration program authorized under this 
                section, and the Secretary may, in addition to the 
                waivers described in paragraph (2), waive for such 
                university such other requirements of this title as the 
                Secretary determines to be appropriate because of the 
                unique characteristics of such university. In carrying 
                out the preceding sentence, the Secretary shall ensure 
                that adequate program integrity and accountability 
                measures apply to such university's participation in 
                the demonstration program authorized under this 
                section.
    ``(c) Application.--
            ``(1) In general.--Each institution or consortia of 
        institutions desiring to participate in a demonstration program 
        under this section shall submit an application to the Secretary 
        at such time and in such manner as the Secretary may require.
            ``(2) Contents.--Each application shall include--
                    ``(A) a description of the institution or 
                consortium's consultation with a recognized accrediting 
                agency or association with respect to quality 
                assurances for the distance education programs to be 
                offered;
                    ``(B) a description of the statutory and regulatory 
                requirements described in subsection (b)(2) for which a 
                waiver is sought and the reasons for which the waiver 
                is sought;
                    ``(C) a description of the distance education 
                programs to be offered;
                    ``(D) a description of the students to whom 
                distance education programs will be offered;
                    ``(E) an assurance that the institution or 
                consortium will offer full cooperation with the ongoing 
                evaluations of the demonstration program provided for 
                in this section; and
                    ``(F) such other information as the Secretary may 
                require.
    ``(d) Selection.--
            ``(1) In general.--For the first year of the demonstration 
        program authorized under this section, the Secretary is 
        authorized to select for participation in the program not more 
        than 15 institutions, systems of institutions, or consortia of 
        institutions. For the third year of the demonstration program 
        authorized under this title, the Secretary may select not more 
        than 35 institutions, systems, or consortia, in addition to the 
        institutions, systems, or consortia selected pursuant to the 
        preceding sentence, to participate in the demonstration program 
        if the Secretary determines that such expansion is warranted 
        based on the evaluations conducted in accordance with 
        subsections (f) and (g).
            ``(2) Considerations.--In selecting institutions to 
        participate in the demonstration program in the first or 
        succeeding years of the program, the Secretary shall take into 
        account--
                    ``(A) the number and quality of applications 
                received;
                    ``(B) the Department's capacity to oversee and 
                monitor each institution's participation; and
                    ``(C) an institution's--
                            ``(i) financial responsibility;
                            ``(ii) administrative capability; and
                            ``(iii) program or programs being offered 
                        via distance education.
    ``(e) Notification.--The Secretary shall make available to the 
public and to the Committee on Labor and Human Resources of the Senate 
and the Committee on Education and the Workforce of the House of 
Representatives a list of institutions or consortia selected to 
participate in the demonstration program authorized by this section. 
Such notice shall include a listing of the specific statutory and 
regulatory requirements being waived for each institution or consortia 
and a description of the distance education courses to be offered.
    ``(f) Evaluations and Reports.--
            ``(1) Evaluation.--The Secretary, on an annual basis, shall 
        evaluate the demonstration programs authorized under this 
        section. Such evaluations shall specifically review--
                    ``(A) the number and types of students 
                participating in the programs being offered, including 
                the progress of participating students toward 
                recognized associate, bachelor's, or graduate degrees, 
                and the degree to which participation in such programs 
                increased;
                    ``(B) issues related to student financial 
                assistance for distance education; and
                    ``(C) the extent to which statutory or regulatory 
                requirements not waived under the demonstration program 
                present difficulties for students or institutions.
            ``(2) Policy analysis.--In addition, the Secretary shall 
        review current policies and identify those policies which 
        present impediments to the development and use of distance 
        education and other nontraditional methods of expanding access 
        to education.
            ``(3) Reports.--
                    ``(A) In general.--Within 18 months of the 
                initiation of the demonstration program, the Secretary 
                shall report to the Committee on Labor and Human 
                Resources of the Senate and the Committee on Education 
                and the Workforce of the House of Representatives with 
                respect to--
                            ``(i) the evaluations of the demonstration 
                        programs authorized under this section; and
                            ``(ii) any proposed statutory changes 
                        designed to enhance the use of distance 
                        education.
                    ``(B) Additional reports.--The Secretary shall 
                provide additional reports to the Committee on Labor 
                and Human Resources of the Senate and the Committee on 
                Education and the Workforce of the House of 
                Representatives on an annual basis regarding--
                            ``(i) the demonstration programs authorized 
                        under this section; and
                            ``(ii) the number and types of students 
                        receiving assistance under this title for 
                        instruction leading to a recognized 
                        certificate, as provided for in section 
                        484(l)(1), including the progress of such 
                        students toward recognized certificates and the 
                        degree to which participation in such programs 
                        leading to such certificates increased.
    ``(g) Independent Evaluation.--
            ``(1) In general.--The Secretary shall enter into a 
        contract with the National Academy of Sciences to study the 
        quality of and student learning outcomes in distance education 
        programs. Such study shall include--
                    ``(A) identification of the elements by which 
                quality in distance education can be assessed, such as 
                subject matter, interactivity, and student outcomes; 
                and
                    ``(B) identification of the types of students which 
                can most benefit from distance education in areas such 
                as access to higher education, persistence, and 
                graduation.
            ``(2) Scope.--Such study shall include distance education 
        programs offered by the institutions or consortia participating 
        in the demonstration program authorized by this section, as 
        well as the distance education programs offered by other 
        institutions.
            ``(3) Interim and final reports.--The Secretary shall 
        request that the National Academy of Sciences submit an interim 
        report to the Secretary, the Committee on Labor and Human 
        Resources of the Senate, and the Committee on Education and the 
        Workforce of the House of Representatives not later than 
        December 31, 2000, and a final report not later than December 
        31, 2002, regarding the study.
            ``(4) Funding.--The Secretary shall make available not more 
        than $1,000,000 for the study required by this subsection.
    ``(h) Oversight.--In conducting the demonstration program 
authorized under this section, the Secretary shall, on a continuing 
basis--
            ``(1) assure compliance of institutions or consortia with 
        the requirements of this title (other than the sections and 
        regulations that are waived under subsection (b)(2));
            ``(2) provide technical assistance;
            ``(3) monitor fluctuations in the student population 
        enrolled in the participating institutions or consortia; and
            ``(4) consult with appropriate accrediting agencies or 
        associations and appropriate State regulatory authorities.
    ``(i) Definition.--For the purpose of this section, the term 
`distance education' means an educational process that is characterized 
by the separation, in time or place, between instructor and student. 
Distance education may include courses offered principally through the 
use of--
            ``(1) television, audio, or computer transmission, such as 
        open broadcast, closed circuit, cable, microwave, or satellite 
        transmission;
            ``(2) audio or computer conferencing;
            ``(3) video cassettes or discs; or
            ``(4) correspondence.''.

SEC. 490B. ADVISORY COMMITTEE ON STUDENT FINANCIAL ASSISTANCE.

    Section 491 (20 U.S.C. 1098) is amended--
            (1) in subsection (b)--
                    (A) in the second sentence, by striking ``and 
                expenditures'' and inserting ``, expenditures and 
                staffing levels''; and
                    (B) by inserting after the third sentence the 
                following: ``Reports, publications, and other 
                documents, including such reports, publications, and 
                documents in electronic form, shall not be subject to 
                review by the Secretary.'';
            (2) in subsection (e)--
                    (A) by redesignating paragraphs (3), (4), and (5), 
                as paragraphs (4), (5), and (6), respectively; and
                    (B) by inserting after paragraph (2) the following:
            ``(3) No officers or full-time employees of the Federal 
        Government shall serve as members of the Advisory Committee.'';
            (3) in subsection (g), by striking ``(1) Members'' and all 
        that follows through ``of the United States may'' and inserting 
        ``Members of the Advisory Committee may'';
            (4) in subsection (h)(1)--
                    (A) by inserting ``determined'' after ``as may 
                be''; and
                    (B) by adding at the end the following: ``The 
                Advisory Committee may appoint not more than 1 full-
                time equivalent, nonpermanent, consultant without 
                regard to the provisions of title 5, United States 
                Code. The Advisory Committee shall not be required by 
                the Secretary to reduce personnel to meet agency 
                personnel reduction goals.'';
            (5) in subsection (i), by striking ``$750,000'' and 
        inserting ``$800,000'';
            (6) by amending subsection (j) to read as follows:
    ``(j) Special Analyses and Activities.--The Advisory Committee 
shall--
            ``(1) monitor and evaluate the modernization of student 
        financial aid systems and delivery processes, including the 
        implementation of a performance-based organization within the 
        Department, and report to Congress regarding such modernization 
        on not less than an annual basis, including recommendations for 
        improvement;
            ``(2) assess the adequacy of current methods for 
        disseminating information about programs under this title and 
        recommend improvements, as appropriate, regarding early needs 
        assessment and information for first-year secondary school 
        students;
            ``(3) assess and make recommendations concerning the 
        feasibility and degree of use of appropriate technology in the 
        application for, and delivery and management of, financial 
        assistance under this title, as well as policies that promote 
        use of such technology to reduce cost and enhance service and 
        program integrity, including electronic application and 
        reapplication, just-in-time delivery of funds, reporting of 
        disbursements and reconciliation;
            ``(4) assess the implications of distance education on 
        student eligibility and other requirements for financial 
        assistance under this title, and make recommendations that will 
        enhance access to postsecondary education through distance 
        education while maintaining access, through on-campus 
        instruction at eligible institutions, and program integrity; 
        and
            ``(5) make recommendations to the Secretary regarding 
        redundant or outdated provisions of and regulations under this 
        Act, consistent with the Secretary's requirements under section 
        498A(b)(3).'';
            (7) in subsection (k), by striking ``1998'' and inserting 
        ``2004''; and
            (8) by repealing subsection (l).

SEC. 490C. REGIONAL MEETINGS AND NEGOTIATED RULEMAKING.

    Section 492 (20 U.S.C. 1098a) is amended--
            (1) in subsection (a)--
                    (A) in paragraph (1)--
                            (i) by inserting ``D,'' after ``B,''; and
                            (ii) by striking ``Such meetings shall 
                        include'' and inserting ``The Secretary shall 
                        obtain the advice of and recommendations 
                        from''; and
                    (B) in paragraph (2)--
                            (i) by striking ``During such meetings 
                        the'' and inserting ``The'';
                            (ii) by inserting ``D,'' after ``B,''; and
                            (iii) by striking ``1992'' and inserting 
                        ``1998 through such mechanisms as regional 
                        meetings and electronic exchanges of 
                        information''; and
            (2) in subsection (b)--
                    (A) by striking ``After'' and inserting the 
                following:
            ``(1) In general.--After'';
                    (B) in paragraph (1) (as redesignated by 
                subparagraph (A))--
                            (i) by striking ``holding regional 
                        meetings'' and inserting ``obtaining the advice 
                        and recommendations described in subsection 
                        (a)(1)'';
                            (ii) by inserting ``D,'' after ``B,'';
                            (iii) by striking ``1992'' and inserting 
                        ``1998''; and
                            (iv) by striking ``The Secretary shall 
                        follow the guidance provided in sections 
                        305.82-4 and 305.85-5 of chapter 1, Code of 
                        Federal Regulations, and any successor 
                        recommendation, regulation, or law.''; and
                    (C) by adding at the end the following:
            ``(2) Expansion of negotiated rulemaking in student loan 
        programs.--All regulations pertaining to the student assistance 
        programs in parts B, D, G, and H, that are promulgated after 
        the date of enactment of this paragraph, shall be subject to 
        the negotiated rulemaking process, unless the Secretary 
        determines that exceptional circumstances exist making 
        negotiated rulemaking unnecessary or inadvisable with respect 
        to given regulations and publishes the basis for such 
        determination in the Federal Register at the same time as the 
        proposed regulations in questions are first published. All 
        published proposed regulations shall conform, unless 
        impracticable, to agreements resulting from such negotiated 
        rulemaking. Such negotiated rulemaking shall be conducted in 
        accordance with the provisions of paragraph (1).''.

SEC. 490D. PROCEDURES FOR CANCELLATIONS AND DEFERMENTS FOR ELIGIBLE 
              DISABLED VETERANS.

    Part G of title IV (20 U.S.C. 1088 et seq.) is amended by adding at 
the end the following:

``SEC. 493A. PROCEDURES FOR CANCELLATIONS AND DEFERMENTS FOR ELIGIBLE 
              DISABLED VETERANS.

    ``The Secretary, in consultation with the Secretary of Veterans 
Affairs, shall develop and implement a procedure to permit Department 
of Veterans Affairs physicians to provide the certifications and 
affidavits needed to enable disabled veterans enrolled in the 
Department of Veterans Affairs health care system to document such 
veterans' eligibility for deferments or cancellations of student loans 
made, insured, or guaranteed under this title. Not later than 6 months 
after the date of enactment of the Higher Education Amendments of 1998, 
the Secretary and the Secretary of Veterans Affairs jointly shall 
report to Congress on the progress made in developing and implementing 
the procedure.''.

                    PART H--PROGRAM INTEGRITY TRIAD

SEC. 491. STATE ROLE AND RESPONSIBILITIES.

    Subpart 1 of part H of title IV (20 U.S.C. 1099a et seq.) is 
amended to read as follows:

                        ``Subpart 1--State Role

``SEC. 495. STATE RESPONSIBILITIES.

    ``(a) State Responsibilities.--As part of the integrity program 
authorized by this part, each State, through 1 State agency or several 
State agencies selected by the State, shall--
            ``(1) furnish the Secretary, upon request, information with 
        respect to the process for licensing or other authorization for 
        institutions of higher education to operate within the State;
            ``(2) notify the Secretary promptly whenever the State 
        revokes a license or other authority to operate an institution 
        of higher education; and
            ``(3) notify the Secretary promptly whenever the State has 
        credible evidence that an institution of higher education 
        within the State--
                    ``(A) has committed fraud in the administration of 
                the student assistance programs authorized by this 
                title; or
                    ``(B) has substantially violated a provision of 
                this title.
    ``(b) Institutional Responsibility.--Each institution of higher 
education shall provide evidence to the Secretary that the institution 
has authority to operate within a State at the time the institution is 
certified under subpart 3.''.

SEC. 492. ACCREDITING AGENCY RECOGNITION.

    (a) Amendments to Headings.--Subpart 2 of part H of title IV (20 
U.S.C. 1099b et seq.) is amended--
            (1) in the subpart heading, by striking ``Approval'' and 
        inserting ``Recognition''; and
            (2) in the heading for section 496, by striking 
        ``approval'' and inserting ``recognition''.
    (b) Recognition of Accrediting Agency or Association.--Section 496 
(20 U.S.C. 1099b) is amended--
            (1) in the heading for subsection (a), by striking 
        ``Standards'' and inserting ``Criteria'';
            (2) in subsection (a)--
                    (A) in the matter preceding paragraph (1), by 
                striking ``standards'' each place the term appears and 
                inserting ``criteria'';
                    (B) in paragraph (4)--
                            (i) by striking ``at the institution'' and 
                        inserting ``offered by the institution''; and
                            (ii) by inserting ``, including distance 
                        education courses or programs,'' after ``higher 
                        education''; and
                    (C) in paragraph (5)--
                            (i) by striking subparagraph (I);
                            (ii) by redesignating subparagraphs (A) 
                        through (H) as subparagraphs (B) through (I), 
                        respectively;
                            (iii) by inserting before subparagraph (B) 
                        the following:
                    ``(A) success with respect to student achievement 
                in relation to the institution's mission, including, as 
                appropriate, consideration of course completion, State 
                licensing examination, and job placement rates;'';
                            (iv) in subparagraph (I) (as redesignated 
                        by clause (ii)), by striking ``in clock hours 
                        or credit hours''; and
                            (v) in subparagraph (L)--
                                    (I) by inserting ``record of'' 
                                before ``compliance'';
                                    (II) by striking ``Act, including 
                                any'' and inserting ``Act based on 
                                the'';
                                    (III) by inserting ``any'' after 
                                ``reviews, and''; and
                                    (IV) in the matter following 
                                subparagraph (L), by striking ``(G),'';
            (3) by amending paragraph (1) of subsection (l) to read as 
        follows: ``(1)(A)(i) If the Secretary determines that an 
        accrediting agency or association has failed to apply 
        effectively the standards in this section, or is otherwise not 
        in compliance with the requirements of this section, the 
        Secretary shall--
                    ``(I) after notice and opportunity for a hearing, 
                limit, suspend, or terminate the approval of the agency 
                or association; or
                    ``(II) require the agency or association to take 
                appropriate action to bring the agency or association 
                into compliance with such requirements within a 
                timeframe specified by the Secretary, except that--
                            ``(aa) such timeframe shall not exceed 12 
                        months unless the Secretary extends such period 
                        for good cause; and
                            ``(bb) if the agency or association fails 
                        to bring the agency or association into 
                        compliance within such timeframe, the Secretary 
                        shall, after notice and opportunity for a 
                        hearing, limit, suspend, or terminate the 
                        approval of the agency or association.''; and
            (4) in subsection (n)(3), by adding at the end the 
        following: ``When the Secretary decides to recognize an 
        accrediting agency or association, the Secretary shall 
        determine the agency or association's scope of recognition. If 
        the agency or association reviews institutions offering 
        distance education courses or programs and the Secretary 
        determines that the agency or association meets the 
        requirements of this section, then the agency shall be 
        recognized and the scope of recognition shall include 
        accreditation of institutions offering distance education 
        courses or programs.''.

SEC. 493. ELIGIBILITY AND CERTIFICATION PROCEDURES.

    (a) Single Application Form.--Section 498(b) (20 U.S.C. 1099c(b)) 
is amended--
            (1) in paragraph (1), by striking ``and capability'' and 
        inserting ``financial responsibility, and administrative 
        capability'';
            (2) by amending paragraph (3) to read as follows:
            ``(3) requires--
                    ``(A) a description of the third party servicers of 
                an institution of higher education; and
                    ``(B) the institution to maintain a copy of any 
                contract with a financial aid service provider or loan 
                servicer, and provide a copy of any such contract to 
                the Secretary upon request;'';
            (3) in paragraph (4), by striking the period and inserting 
        ``; and''; and
            (4) by adding at the end the following:
            ``(5) provides, at the option of the institution, for 
        participation in 1 or more of the programs under part B or 
        D.''.
    (b) Financial Responsibility Standards.--Section 498(c) (20 U.S.C. 
1099c(c)) is amended--
            (1) in paragraph (2), by striking ``with respect to 
        operating losses, net worth, asset to liabilities ratios, or 
        operating fund deficits'' and inserting ``regarding ratios that 
        demonstrate financial responsibility,'';
            (2) in paragraph (3)(A), by striking ``Secretary third 
        party'' and all that follows through ``payable to the 
        Secretary'' and inserting ``Secretary any third party 
        guarantees, which the Secretary determines are reasonable, 
        that''; and
            (3) in paragraph (4)--
                    (A) in the matter preceding subparagraph (A), by 
                striking ``ratio of current assets to current 
                liabilities'' and inserting ``criteria''; and
                    (B) in subparagraph (C), by striking ``current 
                operating ratio requirement'' and inserting 
                ``criteria''.
    (c) Financial Guarantees From Owners.--Section 498(e) (20 U.S.C. 
1099c(e)) is amended--
            (1) in the subsection heading, by inserting ``of For-Profit 
        Institutions'' after ``Owners'';
            (2) in paragraph (1)(A), by striking ``from an'' and 
        inserting ``from a for-profit'';
            (3) in paragraph (2)--
                    (A) in the matter preceding clause (i) of 
                subparagraph (A), by inserting ``for-profit'' after 
                ``or more'';
                    (B) in subparagraph (B), by inserting ``for-
                profit'' after ``or more'';
            (4) in paragraph (3), by striking ``operation of, an 
        institution or'' and inserting ``operation of, a for-profit 
        institution or the''; and
            (5) by adding at the end the following:
            ``(6) Notwithstanding any other provision of law, any 
        individual, whom the Secretary determines, in accordance with 
        paragraph (2), exercises substantial control over an 
        institution participating in, or seeking to participate in, a 
        program under this title, required to pay, on behalf of a 
        student or borrower, a refund of unearned institutional charges 
        to a lender, or to the Secretary, who willfully fails to pay 
        such refund or willfully attempts in any manner to evade 
        payment of such refund, shall, in addition to other penalties 
        provided by law, be liable to the Secretary for the amount of 
        the refund not paid, to the same extent with respect to such 
        refund that such an individual would be liable as a responsible 
        person for a penalty under section 6672(a) of Internal Revenue 
        Code of 1986 with respect to the nonpayment of taxes.''.
    (d) Applications and Site Visits.--Section 498(f) (20 U.S.C. 
1099c(f)) is amended--
            (1) in the subsection heading by striking ``; Site Visits 
        and Fees'' and inserting ``and Site Visits'';
            (2) in the second sentence, by striking ``shall'' and 
        inserting ``may'';
            (3) in the third sentence, strike ``may'' and insert 
        ``shall''; and
            (4) by striking the fourth sentence.
    (e) Time Limitations on, and Renewal of, Eligibility.--Subsection 
(g) of section 498 (20 U.S.C. 1099c) is amended to read as follows:
    ``(g) Time Limitations on, and Renewal of, Eligibility.--
            ``(1) General rule.--After the expiration of the 
        certification of any institution under the schedule prescribed 
        under this section (as in effect prior to the enactment of the 
        Higher Education Act Amendments of 1998), or upon request for 
        initial certification from an institution not previously 
        certified, the Secretary may certify the eligibility for the 
        purposes of any program authorized under this title of each 
        such institution for a period not to exceed 6 years.
            ``(2) Notification.--The Secretary shall notify each 
        institution of higher education not later than 6 months prior 
        to the date of the expiration of the institution's 
        certification.
            ``(3) Institutions outside the united states.--The 
        Secretary shall promulgate regulations regarding the 
        recertification requirements applicable to an institution of 
        higher education outside of the United States that meets the 
        requirements of section 481(a)(1)(C) and received less than 
        $500,000 in funds under part B for the most recent year for 
        which data are available.''.
    (f) Provisional Certification.--Section 498(h) (20 U.S.C. 1099c(h)) 
is amended--
            (1) in paragraph (1)(B)(ii), by striking ``an eligible'' 
        and inserting ``a for-profit eligible''; and
            (2) in paragraph (2), by striking ``the approval'' and 
        inserting ``the recognition''.
    (g) Treatment of Changes of Ownership.--Section 498(i) (20 U.S.C. 
1099c(i)) is amended--
            (1) in the subsection heading, by inserting ``of For-Profit 
        Institutions'' after ``Ownership''; and
            (2) in paragraph (2)--
                    (A) in subparagraph (A), by inserting ``for-
                profit'' before ``institution'';
                    (B) in subparagraph (C), by striking ``two'' and 
                inserting ``a for-profit institution with one'';
                    (C) in subparagraph (D), by inserting ``for-
                profit'' before ``institutions'';
                    (D) in subparagraph (E), by inserting ``for-
                profit'' before ``institutions''; and
                    (E) in subparagraph (F), by inserting ``for-
                profit'' before ``institution''.
    (h) Treatment of Branches.--The second sentence of section 
498(j)(1) (20 U.S.C. 1099c(j)(1)) is amended by inserting ``after the 
branch is certified by the Secretary as a branch campus participating 
in a program under title IV,'' after ``2 years''.

SEC. 494. PROGRAM REVIEW AND DATA.

    Section 498A (20 U.S.C. 1099c-1) is amended--
            (1) in subsection (a)--
                    (A) in paragraph (2)--
                            (i) in the matter preceding subparagraph 
                        (A), by striking ``may'' and inserting 
                        ``shall'';
                            (ii) by amending subparagraph (C) to read 
                        as follows:
                    ``(C) institutions with a significant fluctuation 
                in Federal Stafford Loan volume, Federal Direct 
                Stafford/Ford Loan volume, or Federal Pell Grant award 
                volume, or any combination thereof, in the year for 
                which the determination is made, compared to the year 
                prior to such year, that are not accounted for by 
                changes in the Federal Stafford Loan program, the 
                Federal Direct Stafford/Ford Loan program, or the Pell 
                Grant program, or any combination thereof;'';
                            (iii) by amending subparagraph (D) to read 
                        as follows:
                    ``(D) institutions reported to have deficiencies or 
                financial aid problems by the State licensing or 
                authorizing agency, or by the appropriate accrediting 
                agency or association;'';
                            (iv) in subparagraph (E), by inserting 
                        ``and'' after the semicolon; and
                            (v) by striking subparagraphs (F) and (G), 
                        and inserting the following:
                    ``(F) such other institutions that the Secretary 
                determines may pose a significant risk of failure to 
                comply with the administrative capability or financial 
                responsibility provisions of this title; and''; and
                    (B) in paragraph (3)(A), by inserting ``relevant'' 
                after ``all''; and
            (2) by amending subsection (b) to read as follows:
    ``(b) Special Administrative Rules.--
            ``(1) In general.--In carrying out paragraphs (1) and (2) 
        of subsection (a) and any other relevant provisions of this 
        title, the Secretary shall--
                    ``(A) establish guidelines designed to ensure 
                uniformity of practice in the conduct of program 
                reviews of institutions of higher education;
                    ``(B) make available to each institution 
                participating in programs authorized under this title 
                complete copies of all review guidelines and procedures 
                used in program reviews;
                    ``(C) permit the institution to correct or cure an 
                administrative, accounting, or recordkeeping error if 
                the error is not part of a pattern of error and there 
                is no evidence of fraud or misconduct related to the 
                error;
                    ``(D) base any civil penalty assessed against an 
                institution of higher education resulting from a 
                program review or audit on the gravity of the 
                violation, failure, or misrepresentation; and
                    ``(E) inform the appropriate State and accrediting 
                agency or association whenever the Secretary takes 
                action against an institution of higher education under 
                this section, section 498, or section 432.
            ``(2) Uniformity of application of regulations.--The 
        Secretary shall review the regulations of the Department and 
        the application of such regulations to ensure the uniformity of 
        interpretation and application of the regulations.
            ``(3) Nonduplication and coordination.--The Secretary shall 
        establish a process for ensuring that eligibility and 
        compliance issues, such as institutional audit, program review, 
        and recertification, are considered simultaneously, and shall 
        establish a process for identifying unnecessary duplication of 
        reporting and related regulatory requirements. In developing 
        such processes, the Secretary shall consult with relevant 
        representatives of institutions participating in the programs 
        authorized by this title.''.

  PART I--ADMINISTRATIVE PROVISIONS FOR DELIVERY OF STUDENT FINANCIAL 
                               ASSISTANCE

SEC. 495. PERFORMANCE-BASED ORGANIZATION FOR THE DELIVERY OF FEDERAL 
              STUDENT FINANCIAL ASSISTANCE.

    Title IV (20 U.S.C. 1070 et seq.) is amended by adding at the end 
the following:

 ``PART I--ADMINISTRATIVE PROVISIONS FOR DELIVERY OF STUDENT FINANCIAL 
                               ASSISTANCE

``SEC. 499. PERFORMANCE-BASED ORGANIZATION FOR THE DELIVERY OF FEDERAL 
              STUDENT FINANCIAL ASSISTANCE.

    ``(a) Establishment.--The Secretary shall establish in the 
Department a performance-based organization (hereafter in this part 
referred to as the `PBO') to administer various functions relating to 
student financial assistance programs authorized under this title.
    ``(b) Oversight and Authority.--
            ``(1) Policy oversight and direction.--The Secretary shall 
        maintain responsibility for the policy relating to functions 
        managed by the PBO, and the PBO shall remain subject to the 
        Secretary's oversight and direction.
            ``(2) Audits and review.--The PBO shall be subject to the 
        usual and customary Federal audit procedures and to review by 
        the Inspector General of the Department.
            ``(3) Changes.--
                    ``(A) In general.--The Secretary and the Chief 
                Operating Officer shall consult concerning the effects 
                of policy, market, or other changes on the ability of 
                the PBO to achieve the goals and objectives established 
                in the performance plan described in subsection (e).
                    ``(B) Revisions to agreement.--The Secretary and 
                the Chief Operating Officer may revise the annual 
                performance agreement described in subsection (f)(2) in 
                light of policy, market, or other changes that occur 
                after the Secretary and the Chief Operating Officer 
                enter into the agreement.
    ``(c) Purposes of PBO.--The purposes of the PBO are--
            ``(1) to improve service to students and other participants 
        in the student financial assistance programs authorized under 
        this title, including making those programs more understandable 
        to students and their parents;
            ``(2) to reduce the costs of administering those programs;
            ``(3) to increase the accountability of the officials 
        responsible for administering those programs;
            ``(4) to provide greater flexibility in the administration 
        of those programs;
            ``(5) to improve and integrate the information and delivery 
        systems that support those programs; and
            ``(6) to develop and maintain a student financial 
        assistance system that contains complete, accurate, and timely 
        data to ensure program integrity.
    ``(d) Functions.--
            ``(1) In general.--Subject to subsection (b) of this 
        section, the PBO shall be responsible for administration of the 
        information and financial systems that support student 
        financial assistance programs authorized under this title, 
        including--
                    ``(A) collecting, processing, and transmitting 
                applicant data to students, institutions, and 
                authorized third parties, as provided for in section 
                483;
                    ``(B) contracting for the information and financial 
                systems supporting student financial assistance 
                programs under this title;
                    ``(C) developing technical specifications for 
                software and systems that support those programs; and
                    ``(D) providing all customer service, training, and 
                user support related to systems that support those 
                programs.
            ``(2) Additional functions.--The Secretary may allocate to 
        the PBO such additional functions as the Secretary determines 
        necessary or appropriate to achieve the purposes of the PBO.
    ``(e) Performance Plan and Report.--
            ``(1) Performance plan.--
                    ``(A) In general.--Each year, the Secretary and 
                Chief Operating Officer shall agree on, and make 
                available to the public, a performance plan for the PBO 
                for the succeeding 5 years that establishes measurable 
                goals and objectives for the organization.
                    ``(B) Consultation.--In developing the 5-year 
                performance plan and any revision to the plan, the 
                Secretary and the Chief Operating Officer shall consult 
                with students, institutions of higher education, 
                Congress, lenders, and other interested parties not 
                less than 30 days prior to the implementation of the 
                performance plan or revision.
                    ``(C) Areas.--The plan shall address the PBO's 
                responsibilities in the following areas:
                            ``(i) Improving service.--Improving service 
                        to students and other participants in student 
                        financial aid programs authorized under this 
                        title, including making those programs more 
                        understandable to students and their parents.
                            ``(ii) Reducing costs.--Reducing the costs 
                        of administering those programs.
                            ``(iii) Improvement and integration of 
                        support systems.--Improving and integrating the 
                        information and delivery systems that support 
                        those programs.
                            ``(iv) Delivery and information system.--
                        Developing an open, common, and integrated 
                        delivery and information system for programs 
                        authorized under this title.
                            ``(v) Other areas.--Any other areas 
                        identified by the Secretary.
            ``(2) Annual report.--(A) In general.--Each year, the Chief 
        Operating Officer shall prepare and submit to Congress, through 
        the Secretary, an annual report on the performance of the PBO, 
        including an evaluation of the extent to which the PBO met the 
        goals and objectives contained in the 5-year performance plan 
        described in paragraph (1) for the preceding year.
            ``(B) Consultation with stakeholders.--The Chief Operating 
        Officer, in preparing the report described in subparagraph (A), 
        shall establish appropriate means to consult with borrowers, 
        institutions, lenders, guaranty agencies, secondary markets, 
        and others involved in the delivery system of student aid under 
        this title--
                    ``(i) regarding the degree of satisfaction with the 
                delivery system; and
                    ``(ii) to seek suggestions on means to improve the 
                delivery system.
    ``(f) Chief Operating Officer.--
            ``(1) Appointment.--
                    ``(A) In general.--The management of the PBO shall 
                be vested in a Chief Operating Officer who shall be 
                appointed by the Secretary to a term of not less than 3 
                and not more than 5 years and compensated without 
                regard to chapters 33, 51, and 53 of title 5, United 
                States Code.
                    ``(B) Basis.--The appointment shall be made on the 
                basis of demonstrated ability in management and 
                experience in information technology or financial 
                services.
                    ``(C) Reappointment.--The Secretary may reappoint 
                the Chief Operating Officer to subsequent terms of not 
                less than 3 and not more than 5 years, so long as the 
                performance of the Chief Operating Officer, as set 
                forth in the performance agreement described in 
                paragraph (2), is satisfactory.
            ``(2) Performance agreement.--
                    ``(A) In general.--Each year, the Secretary and the 
                Chief Operating Officer shall enter into an annual 
                performance agreement, that shall set forth measurable 
                organization and individual goals for the Chief 
                Operating Officer.
                    ``(B) Transmittal.--The final agreement, and any 
                revision to the final agreement, shall be transmitted 
                to the Committee on Education and the Workforce of the 
                House of Representatives and the Committee on Labor and 
                Human Resources of the Senate, and made publicly 
                available.
            ``(3) Compensation.--
                    ``(A) In general.--The Chief Operating Officer is 
                authorized to be paid at an annual rate of basic pay 
                not to exceed the maximum rate of basic pay for the 
                Senior Executive Service under section 5382 of title 5, 
                United States Code, including any applicable locality-
                based comparability payment that may be authorized 
                under section 5304(h)(2)(C) of such title.
                    ``(B) Bonus.--In addition, the Chief Operating 
                Officer may receive a bonus in an amount that does not 
                exceed 50 percent of such annual rate of basic pay, 
                based upon the Secretary's evaluation of the Chief 
                Operating Officer's performance in relation to the 
                goals set forth in the performance agreement described 
                in paragraph (2).
                    ``(C) Payment.--Payment of a bonus under this 
                subparagraph (B) may be made to the Chief Operating 
                Officer only to the extent that such payment does not 
                cause the Chief Operating Officer's total aggregate 
                compensation in a calendar year to equal or exceed the 
                amount of the President's salary under section 102 of 
                title 3, United States Code.
            ``(4) Removal.--The Chief Operating Officer shall be 
        removable--
                    ``(A) by the President; or
                    ``(B) by the Secretary for misconduct or failure to 
                meet the goals set forth in the performance agreement 
                described in paragraph (2).
    ``(g) Senior Management.--
            ``(1) Appointment.--
                    ``(A) In general.--The Chief Operating Officer may 
                appoint such senior managers as that officer determines 
                necessary without regard to the provisions of title 5, 
                United States Code, governing appointments in the 
                competitive service.
                    ``(B) Compensation.--The senior managers described 
                in subparagraph (A) may be paid without regard to the 
                provisions of chapter 51 and subchapter III of chapter 
                53 of such title relating to classification and General 
                Schedule pay rates.
            ``(2) Performance agreement.--Each year, the Chief 
        Operating Officer and each senior manager appointed under this 
        subsection shall enter into an annual performance agreement 
        that sets forth measurable organization and individual goals.
            ``(3) Compensation.--
                    ``(A) In general.--A senior manager appointed under 
                this subsection may be paid at an annual rate of basic 
                pay of not more than the maximum rate of basic pay for 
                the Senior Executive Service under section 5382 of 
                title 5, United States Code, including any applicable 
                locality-based comparability payment that may be 
                authorized under section 5304(h)(2)(C) of such title 5.
                    ``(B) Bonus.--In addition, a senior manager may 
                receive a bonus in an amount such that the manager's 
                total annual compensation does not exceed 125 percent 
                of the maximum rate of basic pay for the Senior 
                Executive Service, including any applicable locality-
                based comparability payment, based upon the Chief 
                Operating Officer's evaluation of the manager's 
                performance in relation to the goals set forth in the 
                performance agreement described in paragraph (2).
            ``(4) Removal.--A senior manager shall be removable by the 
        Secretary or by the Chief Operating Officer.
    ``(h) Report.--The Secretary and the Chief Operating Officer, not 
later than 180 days after the date of enactment of the Higher Education 
Amendments of 1998, shall report to Congress on the proposed budget and 
sources of funding for the operation of the PBO.
    ``(i) Authorization of Appropriations.--The Secretary shall 
allocate from funds made available under section 458 such funds as are 
appropriate to the functions assumed by the PBO. In addition, there are 
authorized to be appropriated such sums as may be necessary to carry 
out the purposes of this part, including transition costs.

``SEC. 499A. PERSONNEL FLEXIBILITIES.

    ``(a) General Provisions.--
            ``(1) Certain limitations not applicable.--The PBO shall 
        not be subject to any limitation related to the number or grade 
        of its employees.
            ``(2) Applicable provisions of title 5.--
                    ``(A) Provisions.--Any flexibilities provided under 
                this section shall be exercised in a manner consistent 
                with the following provisions of title 5, United States 
                Code:
                            ``(i) Chapter 23, relating to merit system 
                        principles and prohibited personnel practices.
                            ``(ii) Provisions relating to preference 
                        eligibles.
                            ``(iii) Section 5307, relating to the 
                        aggregate limitation on pay.
                            ``(iv) Chapter 71, relating to labor-
                        management relations, except to the extent 
                        provided by paragraph (3).
                    ``(B) Exercise of authority.--The exercise of any 
                authorities provided under this section shall be 
                subject to subsections (b) and (c) of section 1104 of 
                title 5, United States Code, as though such authorities 
                were delegated to the PBO under subsection (a)(2) of 
                such section. The PBO shall provide the Office of 
                Personnel Management with any information the Office 
                requires in carrying out its responsibilities under 
                this subsection.
            ``(3) Labor organization agreements.--Employees within a 
        unit to which a labor organization is accorded exclusive 
        recognition under chapter 71 of title 5, United States Code, 
        shall not be subject to any flexibility provided under this 
        section unless the exclusive representative and PBO have 
        entered into a written agreement which specifically provides 
        for the exercise of that flexibility. A written agreement may 
        not be imposed by the Federal Services Impasses Panel under 
        section 7119 of title 5, United States Code.
            ``(4) Flexibilities.--
                    ``(A) Prior approval.--The PBO may exercise any of 
                the flexibilities provided under subsections (b), 
                (c)(1), and (d) without prior approval of the Office of 
                Personnel Management.
                    ``(B) Plan and approval.--The PBO may exercise the 
                flexibilities described in subsection (c)(2) only after 
                a specific plan for implementation of those 
                flexibilities is submitted to and approved by the 
                Director of the Office of Personnel Management.
            ``(5) Demonstration projects.--
                    ``(A) In general.--The exercise of any 
                flexibilities under this section shall not affect the 
                authority of the PBO to implement a demonstration 
                project subject to chapter 47 of title 5, United States 
                Code, and as provided in subparagraph (B).
                    ``(B) Application of title 5.--In applying section 
                4703 of title 5, United States Code, to a project 
                described in subparagraph (A)--
                            ``(i) section 4703(b)(1) shall be deemed to 
                        read as follows:
            ```(1) develop a plan for such project which describes its 
        purpose, the employees to be covered, the project itself, its 
        anticipated outcomes, and the method of evaluating the 
        project;';
                            ``(ii) section 4703(b)(3) shall not apply;
                            ``(iii) the 180-day notification period in 
                        section 4703(b)(4) shall be deemed to be a 30-
                        day notification period;
                            ``(iv) section 4703(b)(6) shall be deemed 
                        to read as follows:
            ```(6) provide each House of Congress with the final 
        version of the plan.';
                            ``(v) section 4703(c)(1) shall be deemed to 
                        read as follows:
            ```(1) subchapter V of chapter 63 or subpart G of part III 
        of this title;';
                            ``(vi) section 4703(d) shall not apply; and
                            ``(vii) section 4703(f) shall not apply, 
                        and, in lieu thereof, paragraph (3) of this 
                        subsection shall apply as though the 
                        demonstration project were a flexibility 
                        authority provided under this subsection.
    ``(b) Performance Management.--
            ``(1) In general.--The PBO shall establish a performance 
        management system that--
                    ``(A) maintains individual accountability by--
                            ``(i) establishing 1 or more retention 
                        standards for each employee related to the work 
                        of the employee and expressed in terms of 
                        individual performance, and communicating such 
                        retention standards to employees;
                            ``(ii) making periodic determinations of 
                        whether each employee meets or does not meet 
                        the employee's established retention standards; 
                        and
                            ``(iii) taking actions, in accordance with 
                        applicable laws and regulations, with respect 
                        to any employee whose performance does not meet 
                        established retention standards, including 
                        denying any increase in basic pay, promotions, 
                        and credit for performance under section 3502 
                        of title 5, United States Code, and taking 1 or 
                        more of the following actions:
                                    ``(I) Reassignment;
                                    ``(II) An action under chapter 43 
                                or 75 of title 5, United States Code; 
                                or
                                    ``(III) Any other appropriate 
                                action to resolve the performance 
                                problem; and
                    ``(B) strengthens its effectiveness by providing 
                for--
                            ``(i) establishing goals or objectives for 
                        individual, group, or organizational 
                        performance (or any combination thereof), 
                        consistent with the annual performance 
                        agreement described in section 499(f)(2) and 
                        PBO performance planning procedures, including 
                        those established under the Government 
                        Performance and Results Act of 1993, and 
                        communicating such goals or objectives to 
                        employees;
                            ``(ii) using such goals and objectives to 
                        make performance distinctions among employees 
                        or groups of employees; and
                            ``(iii) using performance assessments as a 
                        basis for granting employee awards, adjusting 
                        an employee's rate of basic pay, and other 
                        appropriate personnel actions, in accordance 
                        with applicable provisions or law and 
                        regulation.
            ``(2) Performance.--
                    ``(A) Assessment.--For purposes of paragraph 
                (1)(B), the term `performance assessment' means a 
                determination of whether or not retention standards 
                established under paragraph (1)(A)(i) are met, and any 
                additional performance determination made on the basis 
                of performance goals and objectives established under 
                paragraph (1)(B)(i).
                    ``(B) Unacceptable performance.--For purposes of 
                title 5, United States Code, the term `unacceptable 
                performance' with respect to an employee of the PBO 
                means performance of the employee which fails to meet a 
                retention standard established under paragraph 
                (1)(A)(i).
            ``(3) Awards program.--
                    ``(A) In general.--The PBO may establish an awards 
                program designed to provide incentives for and 
                recognition of organizational, group, and individual 
                achievements by providing for granting awards to 
                employees who, as individuals or members of a group, 
                contribute to meeting the performance goals and 
                objectives established under this part by such means as 
                a superior individual or group accomplishment, a 
                documented productivity gain, or sustained superior 
                performance.
                    ``(B) Limitation.--Notwithstanding section 4502(b) 
                of title 5, United States Code, the PBO may grant a 
                cash award in an amount not exceeding $25,000, with the 
                approval of the Chief Operating Officer.
    ``(c) Classification and Pay Flexibilities.--
            ``(1) In general.--
                    ``(A) Definition.--For purposes of this section, 
                the term `broad-banded system' means a system for 
                grouping positions for pay, job evaluation, and other 
                purposes that is different from the system established 
                under chapter 51 and subchapter III of chapter 53 of 
                title 5, United States Code, as a result of combining 
                grades and related ranges of rates of pay in 1 or more 
                occupational series.
                    ``(B) Establishment.--The PBO may, subject to 
                criteria to be prescribed by the Office of Personnel 
                Management, establish 1 or more broad-banded systems 
                covering all or any portion of its workforce. The 
                Office may require the PBO to submit to the Office such 
                information relating to its broad-banded systems as the 
                Office may require. Laws and regulations pertaining to 
                General Schedule employees (other than chapter 52 and 
                subchapter II of chapter 53 of title 5, United States 
                Code) shall continue to be applicable to employees 
                under a broad-banded system.
                    ``(C) Criteria.--The criteria to be prescribed by 
                the Office of Personnel Management shall, at a 
                minimum--
                            ``(i) ensure that the structure of any 
                        broad-banded system maintains, through linkage 
                        to the General Schedule, the principle of equal 
                        pay for substantially equal work;
                            ``(ii) establish the minimum and maximum 
                        number of grades that may be combined into pay 
                        bands;
                            ``(iii) establish requirements for 
                        adjusting the pay of an employee within a pay 
                        band;
                            ``(iv) establish requirements for setting 
                        the pay of a supervisory employee whose 
                        position is in a pay band or who supervises 
                        employees whose positions are in pay bands; and
                            ``(v) establish requirements and 
                        methodologies for setting the pay of an 
                        employee upon conversion to a broad-banded 
                        system, initial appointment, change of position 
                        or type of appointment (including promotion, 
                        demotion, transfer, reassignment, 
                        reinstatement, placement in another pay band, 
                        or movement to a different geographic 
                        location), and movement between a broad-banded 
                        system and another pay system.
            ``(2) Alternative job evaluation systems flexibilities.--
                    ``(A) In general.--With the approval of the Office 
                of Personnel Management in accordance with subsection 
                (a)(4)(B), the PBO may establish 1 or more alternative 
                job evaluation systems that include any positions or 
                groups of positions that the PBO determines, for 
                reasons of effective administration--
                            ``(i) should not be classified under 
                        chapter 51 of title 5, United States Code, or 
                        paid under the General Schedule;
                            ``(ii) should not be classified or paid 
                        under subchapter IV of chapter 53 of such 
                        title; or
                            ``(iii) should not be paid under section 
                        5376 of such title.
                    ``(B) Pay.--
                            ``(i) General limitation.--An alternative 
                        job evaluation system established under this 
                        section that includes positions described in 
                        clause (i) or (ii), or both, of subparagraph 
                        (A) may not provide a rate of basic pay for any 
                        employee in excess of the maximum rate of pay 
                        under the General Schedule.
                            ``(ii) Specific limitation.--An alternative 
                        job evaluation system established under this 
                        section that includes positions described in 
                        clause (iii) of subparagraph (A) may not 
                        provide a rate of basic pay for any employee in 
                        excess of the annual rate of basic pay of the 
                        Chief Operating Officer under the first 
                        sentence of section 499(f)(3).
                    ``(C) Implementation.--An alternative job 
                evaluation system established under this section shall 
                be implemented in such a way as to ensure the 
                maintenance of the principle of equal pay for 
                substantially equal work.
                    ``(D) Applicability of laws.--Except as otherwise 
                provided under this part, employees under an 
                alternative job evaluation system shall continue to be 
                subject to the laws and regulations covering employees 
                under the pay system that would otherwise apply to 
                them. If the alternative job evaluation system combines 
                employees from different pay systems into a single 
                system, the plan submitted under subsection (a)(4)(B) 
                shall address the applicability of the laws and 
                regulations for the different pay systems.
    ``(d) Staffing Flexibilities.--
            ``(1) Appointment.--
                    ``(A) Conditions.--Except as otherwise provided 
                under this subsection, an employee of the PBO may be 
                selected for a permanent appointment in the competitive 
                service in the PBO through internal competitive 
                promotion procedures if--
                            ``(i) the employee has completed, in the 
                        competitive service, 2 years of current 
                        continuous service under a term appointment or 
                        any combination of term appointments;
                            ``(ii) such term appointment or 
                        appointments were made under competitive 
                        procedures prescribed for permanent 
                        appointments;
                            ``(iii) the employee's performance under 
                        such term appointment or appointments met 
                        established retention standards; and
                            ``(iv) the vacancy announcement for the 
                        term appointment from which the conversion is 
                        made stated that there was a potential for 
                        subsequent conversion to a permanent 
                        appointment.
                    ``(B) Similar appointment.--An appointment under 
                this section may be made only to a position in the same 
                line of work as a position to which the employee 
                received a term appointment under competitive 
                procedures.
            ``(2) Category rating systems.--
                    ``(A) In general.--Notwithstanding subchapter I of 
                chapter 33 of title 5, United States Code, the PBO may 
                establish category rating systems for evaluating job 
                applicants for positions in the competitive service. 
                Qualified candidates under such rating systems shall be 
                divided into 2 or more quality categories on the basis 
                of relative degrees of merit, rather than assigned 
                individual numerical ratings. Each applicant who meets 
                the minimum qualification requirements for the position 
                to be filled shall be assigned to an appropriate 
                category based on an evaluation of the applicant's 
                knowledge, skills, and abilities relative to those 
                needed for successful performance in the position to be 
                filled.
                    ``(B) Preference eligibles.--Within each quality 
                category established under subparagraph (A), preference 
                eligibles shall be listed ahead of individuals who are 
                not preference eligibles. For other than scientific and 
                professional positions at or higher than level GS-9 (or 
                equivalent), preference eligibles who have a 
                compensable service-connected disability of 10 percent 
                or more, and who meet the minimum qualification 
                standards, shall be listed in the highest quality 
                category.
                    ``(C) Selection.--An appointing authority may 
                select any applicant from the highest quality category 
                or, if fewer than 3 candidates have been assigned to 
                the highest quality category, from a merged category 
                consisting of the highest and second highest quality 
                categories. Notwithstanding the preceding sentence, the 
                appointing authority may not pass over a preference 
                eligible in the same or higher category from which 
                selection is made, unless the requirements of section 
                3317(b) or 3318(b) of title 5, United States Code, as 
                applicable, are satisfied.
            ``(3) Excepted service.--The Chief Operating Officer may 
        appoint, without regard to the provisions of title 5, United 
        States Code, governing appointments in the competitive service, 
        not more than 25 technical and professional employees to 
        administer the functions of the PBO. These employees may be 
        paid without regard to the provisions of chapter 51 and 
        subchapter III of chapter 53 of such title relating to 
        classification and General Schedule pay rates.
            ``(4) Rule of construction.--Notwithstanding paragraphs (1) 
        through (3), no provision of this subsection exempts the PBO 
        from--
                    ``(A) any employment priorities established under 
                direction of the President for the placement of surplus 
                or displaced employees; or
                    ``(B) its obligations under any court order or 
                decree relating to the employment practices of the PBO 
                or the Department of Education.

``SEC. 499B. PROCUREMENT FLEXIBILITY.

    ``(a) Procurement Authority.--Subject to the authority, direction, 
and control of the Secretary, the Chief Operating Officer of a PBO may 
exercise the authority of the Secretary to procure property and 
services in the performance of functions managed by the PBO. For the 
purposes of this section, the term `PBO' includes the Chief Operating 
Officer of the PBO and any employee of the PBO exercising procurement 
authority under the preceding sentence.
    ``(b) Applicability of Procurement Laws.--Except to the extent 
otherwise authorized in this section, a PBO shall comply with all laws 
and regulations that are generally applicable to procurements of 
property and services by the head of an executive agency of the Federal 
Government.
    ``(c) Use of Mutual Benefit Corporation.--The PBO may acquire 
services related to the title IV delivery system from any mutual 
benefit corporation that has the capability and capacity to meet the 
requirements for the system, as determined by the Chief Operating 
Officer of the PBO.
    ``(d) Two-Phase Source-Selection Procedures.--
            ``(1) In general.--The PBO may use a two-phase process for 
        selecting a source for a procurement of property or services.
            ``(2) First phase.--The procedures for the first phase of 
        the process for a procurement are as follows:
                    ``(A) Publication of notice.--The contracting 
                officer for the procurement shall publish a notice of 
                the procurement in accordance with section 18 of the 
                Office of Federal Procurement Policy Act (41 U.S.C. 
                416) and subsections (e), (f), and (g) of section 8 of 
                the Small Business Act (15 U.S.C. 637), except that the 
                notice shall include only the following:
                            ``(i) A general description of the scope or 
                        purpose of the procurement that provides 
                        sufficient information on the scope or purpose 
                        for sources to make informed business decisions 
                        regarding whether to participate in the 
                        procurement.
                            ``(ii) A description of the basis on which 
                        potential sources are to be selected to submit 
                        offers in the second phase.
                            ``(iii) A description of the information 
                        that is to be required under subparagraph (B).
                            ``(iv) Any additional information that the 
                        contracting officer determines appropriate.
                    ``(B) Information submitted by offerors.--Each 
                offeror for the procurement shall submit basic 
                information, such as information on the offeror's 
                qualifications, the proposed conceptual approach, costs 
                likely to be associated with the proposed conceptual 
                approach, and past performance of the offeror on 
                Federal Government contracts, together with any 
                additional information that is requested by the 
                contracting officer.
                    ``(C) Selection for second phase.--The contracting 
                officer shall select the offerors that are to be 
                eligible to participate in the second phase of the 
                process. The contracting officer shall limit the number 
                of the selected offerors to the number of sources that 
                the contracting officer determines is appropriate and 
                in the best interests of the Federal Government.
            ``(3) Second phase.--
                    ``(A) In general.--The contracting officer shall 
                conduct the second phase of the source selection 
                process in accordance with sections 303A and 303B of 
                the Federal Property and Administrative Services Act of 
                1949 (41 U.S.C. 253a and 253b).
                    ``(B) Eligible participants.--Only the sources 
                selected in the first phase of the process shall be 
                eligible to participate in the second phase.
                    ``(C) Single or multiple procurements.--The second 
                phase may include a single procurement or multiple 
                procurements within the scope, or for the purpose, 
                described in the notice pursuant to paragraph (2)(A).
            ``(4) Procedures considered competitive.--The procedures 
        used for selecting a source for a procurement under this 
        subsection shall be considered competitive procedures for all 
        purposes.
    ``(e) Use of Simplified Procedures for Commercial Items.--Whenever 
the PBO anticipates that commercial items will be offered for a 
procurement, the PBO may use (consistent with the special rules for 
commercial items) the special simplified procedures for the procurement 
without regard to--
            ``(1) any dollar limitation otherwise applicable to the use 
        of those procedures; and
            ``(2) the expiration of the authority to use special 
        simplified procedures under section 4202(e) of the Clinger-
        Cohen Act of 1996 (110 Stat. 654; 10 U.S.C. 2304 note).
    ``(f) Flexible Wait Periods and Deadlines for Submission of Offers 
of Noncommercial Items.--
            ``(1) Authority.--In carrying out a procurement, the PBO 
        may--
                    ``(A) apply a shorter waiting period for the 
                issuance of a solicitation after the publication of a 
                notice under section 18 Office of Federal Procurement 
                Policy Act (41 U.S.C. 416) than is required under 
                subsection (a)(3)(A) of such section; and
                    ``(B) notwithstanding subsection (a)(3) of such 
                section, establish any deadline for the submission of 
                bids or proposals that affords potential offerors a 
                reasonable opportunity to respond to the solicitation.
            ``(2) Inapplicability to commercial items.--Paragraph (1) 
        does not apply to a procurement of a commercial item.
            ``(3) Consistency with applicable international 
        agreements.--If an international agreement is applicable to the 
        procurement, any exercise of authority under paragraph (1) 
        shall be consistent with the international agreement.
    ``(g) Modular Contracting.--
            ``(1) In general.--The PBO may satisfy the requirements of 
        the PBO for a system incrementally by carrying out successive 
        procurements of modules of the system. In doing so, the PBO may 
        use procedures authorized under this subsection to procure any 
        such module after the first module.
            ``(2) Utility requirement.--A module may not be procured 
        for a system under this subsection unless the module is useful 
        independently of the other modules or useful in combination 
        with another module previously procured for the system.
            ``(3) Conditions for use of authority.--The PBO may use 
        procedures authorized under paragraph (4) for the procurement 
        of an additional module for a system if--
                    ``(A) competitive procedures were used for awarding 
                the contract for the procurement of the first module 
                for the system; and
                    ``(B) the solicitation for the first module 
                included--
                            ``(i) a general description of the entire 
                        system that was sufficient to provide potential 
                        offerors with reasonable notice of the general 
                        scope of future modules;
                            ``(ii) other information sufficient for 
                        potential offerors to make informed business 
                        judgments regarding whether to submit offers 
                        for the contract for the first module; and
                            ``(iii) a statement that procedures 
                        authorized under this subsection could be used 
                        for awarding subsequent contracts for the 
                        procurement of additional modules for the 
                        system.
            ``(4) Procedures.--If the procurement of the first module 
        for a system meets the requirements set forth in paragraph (3), 
        the PBO may award a contract for the procurement of an 
        additional module for the system using any of the following 
        procedures:
                    ``(A) Sole source.--Award of the contract on a 
                sole-source basis to a contractor who was awarded a 
                contract for a module previously procured for the 
                system under competitive procedures or procedures 
                authorized under subparagraph (B).
                    ``(B) Adequate competition.--Award of the contract 
                on the basis of offers made by--
                            ``(i) a contractor who was awarded a 
                        contract for a module previously procured for 
                        the system after having been selected for award 
                        of the contract under this subparagraph or 
                        other competitive procedures; and
                            ``(ii) at least one other offeror that 
                        submitted an offer for a module previously 
                        procured for the system and is expected, on the 
                        basis of the offer for the previously procured 
                        module, to submit a competitive offer for the 
                        additional module.
                    ``(C) Other.--Award of the contract under any other 
                procedure authorized by law.
            ``(5) Notice requirement.--
                    ``(A) Publication.--Not less than 30 days before 
                issuing a solicitation for offers for a contract for a 
                module for a system under procedures authorized under 
                subparagraph (A) or (B) of paragraph (4), the PBO shall 
                publish in the Commerce Business Daily a notice of the 
                intent to use such procedures to enter into the 
                contract.
                    ``(B) Exception.--Publication of a notice is not 
                required under this paragraph with respect to a use of 
                procedures authorized under paragraph (4) if the 
                contractor referred to in that subparagraph (who is to 
                be solicited to submit an offer) has previously 
                provided a module for the system under a contract that 
                contained cost, schedule, and performance goals and the 
                contractor met those goals.
                    ``(C) Content of notice.--A notice published under 
                subparagraph (A) with respect to a use of procedures 
                described in paragraph (4) shall contain the 
                information required under section 18(b) of the Office 
                of Federal Procurement Policy Act (41 U.S.C. 416(b)), 
                other than paragraph (4) of such section, and shall 
                invite the submission of any assertion that the use of 
                the procedures for the procurement involved is not in 
                the best interest of the Federal Government together 
                with information supporting the assertion.
            ``(6) Documentation.--The basis for an award of a contract 
        under this subsection shall be documented. However, a 
        justification pursuant to section 303(f) of the Federal 
        Property and Administrative Services Act of 1949 (41 U.S.C. 
        253(f)) or section 8(h) of the Small Business Act (15 U.S.C. 
        637(h)) is not required.
            ``(7) Simplified source-selection procedures.--The PBO may 
        award a contract under any other simplified procedures 
        prescribed by the PBO for the selection of sources for the 
        procurement of modules for a system, after the first module, 
        that are not to be procured under a contract awarded on a sole-
        source basis.
    ``(h) Use of Simplified Procedures for Small Business Set-Asides 
for Services Other Than Commercial Items.--
            ``(1) Authority.--The PBO may use special simplified 
        procedures for a procurement of services that are not 
        commercial items if--
                    ``(A) the procurement is in an amount not greater 
                than $1,000,000;
                    ``(B) the procurement is conducted as a small 
                business set-aside pursuant to section 15(a) of the 
                Small Business Act (15 U.S.C. 644(a)); and
                    ``(C) the price charged for supplies associated 
                with the services procured are items of supply expected 
                to be less than 20 percent of the total contract price.
            ``(2) Inapplicability to ce